* gdb.texinfo (Set Catchpoints): Add documentation for the new
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
66 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
67 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
68 development.''
69 @end ifinfo
70
71 @titlepage
72 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
73 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
74 @sp 1
75 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
76 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
77 @page
78 @tex
79 {\parskip=0pt
80 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
81 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
82 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
83 }
84 @end tex
85
86 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
87 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
88 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
89 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90 @sp 2
91 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
92 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
93 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
94 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
95
96 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
97 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
98 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
99 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
100 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
101 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
102
103 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
104 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
105 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
106 development.''
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
118 @value{GDBVN}.
119
120 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
121
122 @menu
123 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
124 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
125
126 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
127 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
128 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
129 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
130 * Stack:: Examining the stack
131 * Source:: Examining source files
132 * Data:: Examining data
133 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
134 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
135 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
136
137 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
138
139 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
140 * Altering:: Altering execution
141 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
142 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
143 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
144 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
145 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
146 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
147 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
148 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
149 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
151 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
152
153 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
162 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
163 how you can copy and share GDB
164 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
165 * Index:: Index
166 @end menu
167
168 @end ifnottex
169
170 @contents
171
172 @node Summary
173 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
174
175 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
176 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
177 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
178
179 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
180 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
181
182 @itemize @bullet
183 @item
184 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
185
186 @item
187 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
188
189 @item
190 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
191
192 @item
193 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
194 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
195 @end itemize
196
197 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
198 For more information, see @ref{Supported languages,,Supported languages}.
199 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
200
201 @cindex Modula-2
202 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
203 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
204
205 @cindex Pascal
206 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
207 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
208 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
209 syntax.
210
211 @cindex Fortran
212 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
213 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
214 underscore.
215
216 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
217 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
218
219 @menu
220 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
221 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
222 @end menu
223
224 @node Free Software
225 @unnumberedsec Free software
226
227 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
228 General Public License
229 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
230 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
231 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
232 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
233 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
234 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
235
236 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
237 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
238 from anyone else.
239
240 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
241
242 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
243 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
244 include with the free software. Many of our most important
245 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
246 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
247 when an important free software package does not come with a free
248 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
249 gaps today.
250
251 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
252 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
253 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
254 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
255 them from the free software world.
256
257 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
258 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
259 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
260 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
261 contract to make it non-free.
262
263 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
264 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
265 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
266 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
267 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
268 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
269 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
270
271 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
272 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
273 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
274 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
275
276 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
277 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
278 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
279 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
280 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
281 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
282 community.
283
284 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
285 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
286 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
287 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
288 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
289 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
290 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
291 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
292 of the manual.
293
294 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
295 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
296 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
297 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
298 manual to replace it.
299
300 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
301 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
302 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
303 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
304 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
305 the free software community.
306
307 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
308 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
309 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
310 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
311 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
312 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
313 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
314 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
315 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
316
317 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
318 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
319 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
320 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
321 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
322 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
323 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
324 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
325
326 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
327 published by other publishers, at
328 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
329
330 @node Contributors
331 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
332
333 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
334 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
335 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
336 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
337 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
338 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
339 blow-by-blow account.
340
341 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
342
343 @quotation
344 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
345 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
346 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
347 @end quotation
348
349 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
350 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
351 releases:
352 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
353 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
354 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
355 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
356 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
357 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
358 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
359 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
360 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
361
362 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
363 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
364
365 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
366 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
367 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
368 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
369 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
370
371 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
372 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
373 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
374
375 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
376 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
377
378 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
379
380 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
381 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
382 support.
383 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
384 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
385 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
386 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
387 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
388 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
389 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
390 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
391 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
392 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
393 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
394 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
395 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
396 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
397 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
398 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
399
400 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
401
402 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
403 libraries.
404
405 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
406 about several machine instruction sets.
407
408 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
409 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
410 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
411 and RDI targets, respectively.
412
413 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
414 command-line editing and command history.
415
416 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
417 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
418
419 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
420 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
421 symbols.
422
423 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
424 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
425
426 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
427
428 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
429 processors.
430
431 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
432
433 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
434
435 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
436
437 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
438 watchpoints.
439
440 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
441
442 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
443
444 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
445 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
446
447 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
448 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
449 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
450 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
451 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
452 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
453 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
454
455 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
456 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
457
458 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
459 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
460 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
461 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
462 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
463 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
464 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
465 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
466 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
467 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
468 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
469 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
470 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
471 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
472 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
473
474 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
475 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
476
477 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
478 Hat.
479
480 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
481 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
482 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
483 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
484 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
485 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
486
487 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
488 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
489 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
490 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
491 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
492 trad unwinders. The architecture specific changes, each involving a
493 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
494 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
495 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
496 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
497 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
498 Weigand.
499
500 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
501 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
502 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
503 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
504
505 @node Sample Session
506 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
507
508 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
509 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
510 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
511
512 @iftex
513 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
514 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
515 @end iftex
516
517 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
518 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
519
520 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
521 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
522 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
523 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
524 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
525 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
526 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
527 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
528 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
529
530 @smallexample
531 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
532 $ @b{./m4}
533 @b{define(foo,0000)}
534
535 @b{foo}
536 0000
537 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
538
539 @b{bar}
540 0000
541 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
542
543 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
544 @b{baz}
545 @b{Ctrl-d}
546 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
547 @end smallexample
548
549 @noindent
550 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
551
552 @smallexample
553 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
554 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
555 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
556 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
557 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
558 the conditions.
559 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
560 for details.
561
562 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
563 (@value{GDBP})
564 @end smallexample
565
566 @noindent
567 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
568 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
569 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
570 that examples fit in this manual.
571
572 @smallexample
573 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
574 @end smallexample
575
576 @noindent
577 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
578 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
579 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
580 @code{break} command.
581
582 @smallexample
583 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
584 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
585 @end smallexample
586
587 @noindent
588 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
589 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
590 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
591
592 @smallexample
593 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
594 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
595 @b{define(foo,0000)}
596
597 @b{foo}
598 0000
599 @end smallexample
600
601 @noindent
602 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
603 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
604 context where it stops.
605
606 @smallexample
607 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
608
609 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
610 at builtin.c:879
611 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
612 @end smallexample
613
614 @noindent
615 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
616 the next line of the current function.
617
618 @smallexample
619 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
620 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
621 : nil,
622 @end smallexample
623
624 @noindent
625 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
626 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
627 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
628 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
629
630 @smallexample
631 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
632 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
633 at input.c:530
634 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
635 @end smallexample
636
637 @noindent
638 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
639 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
640 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
641 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
642 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
643 stack frame for each active subroutine.
644
645 @smallexample
646 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
647 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
648 at input.c:530
649 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
650 at builtin.c:882
651 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
652 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
653 at macro.c:71
654 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
655 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
660 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
661 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
662
663 @smallexample
664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
665 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
667 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
668 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
669 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
670 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
671 : xstrdup(rq);
672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
673 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
678 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
679 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
680 (@code{print}) to see their values.
681
682 @smallexample
683 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
684 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
686 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
687 @end smallexample
688
689 @noindent
690 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
691 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
692 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
693
694 @smallexample
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
696 533 xfree(rquote);
697 534
698 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
699 : xstrdup (lq);
700 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
701 : xstrdup (rq);
702 537
703 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
704 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
705 540 @}
706 541
707 542 void
708 @end smallexample
709
710 @noindent
711 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
712 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
713
714 @smallexample
715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
716 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
718 540 @}
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
720 $3 = 9
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
722 $4 = 7
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
727 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
728 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
729 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
730 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
731 assignments.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
735 $5 = 7
736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
737 $6 = 9
738 @end smallexample
739
740 @noindent
741 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
742 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
743 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
744 example that caused trouble initially:
745
746 @smallexample
747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
748 Continuing.
749
750 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
751
752 baz
753 0000
754 @end smallexample
755
756 @noindent
757 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
758 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
759 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
760
761 @smallexample
762 @b{Ctrl-d}
763 Program exited normally.
764 @end smallexample
765
766 @noindent
767 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
768 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
769 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
770
771 @smallexample
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
773 @end smallexample
774
775 @node Invocation
776 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
777
778 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
779 The essentials are:
780 @itemize @bullet
781 @item
782 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
783 @item
784 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
785 @end itemize
786
787 @menu
788 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
789 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
790 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
791 * Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
792 @end menu
793
794 @node Invoking GDB
795 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
796
797 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
798 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
799
800 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
801 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
802
803 The command-line options described here are designed
804 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
805 options may effectively be unavailable.
806
807 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
808 specifying an executable program:
809
810 @smallexample
811 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @noindent
815 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
816 specified:
817
818 @smallexample
819 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
820 @end smallexample
821
822 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
823 to debug a running process:
824
825 @smallexample
826 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
827 @end smallexample
828
829 @noindent
830 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
831 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
832
833 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
834 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
835 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
836 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
837 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
838
839 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
840 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
841 option processing.
842 @smallexample
843 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
844 @end smallexample
845 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
846 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
847
848 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
849 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
850
851 @smallexample
852 @value{GDBP} -silent
853 @end smallexample
854
855 @noindent
856 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
857 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
858
859 @noindent
860 Type
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} -help
864 @end smallexample
865
866 @noindent
867 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
868 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
869
870 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
871 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
872 @samp{-x} option is used.
873
874
875 @menu
876 * File Options:: Choosing files
877 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
878 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
879 @end menu
880
881 @node File Options
882 @subsection Choosing files
883
884 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
885 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
886 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
887 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
888 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
889 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
890 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
891 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
892 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
893 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
894 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
895 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
896 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
897
898 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
899 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
900 argument and ignore it.
901
902 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
903 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
904 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
905 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
906 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
907
908 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
909 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
910 @c it.
911
912 @table @code
913 @item -symbols @var{file}
914 @itemx -s @var{file}
915 @cindex @code{--symbols}
916 @cindex @code{-s}
917 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
918
919 @item -exec @var{file}
920 @itemx -e @var{file}
921 @cindex @code{--exec}
922 @cindex @code{-e}
923 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
924 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
925
926 @item -se @var{file}
927 @cindex @code{--se}
928 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
929 file.
930
931 @item -core @var{file}
932 @itemx -c @var{file}
933 @cindex @code{--core}
934 @cindex @code{-c}
935 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
936
937 @item -c @var{number}
938 @item -pid @var{number}
939 @itemx -p @var{number}
940 @cindex @code{--pid}
941 @cindex @code{-p}
942 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
943 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
944 file named @var{number}.
945
946 @item -command @var{file}
947 @itemx -x @var{file}
948 @cindex @code{--command}
949 @cindex @code{-x}
950 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
951 Files,, Command files}.
952
953 @item -eval-command @var{command}
954 @itemx -ex @var{command}
955 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
956 @cindex @code{-ex}
957 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
958
959 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
960 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
961
962 @smallexample
963 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
964 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
965 @end smallexample
966
967 @item -directory @var{directory}
968 @itemx -d @var{directory}
969 @cindex @code{--directory}
970 @cindex @code{-d}
971 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
972
973 @item -r
974 @itemx -readnow
975 @cindex @code{--readnow}
976 @cindex @code{-r}
977 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
978 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
979 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
980
981 @end table
982
983 @node Mode Options
984 @subsection Choosing modes
985
986 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
987 batch mode or quiet mode.
988
989 @table @code
990 @item -nx
991 @itemx -n
992 @cindex @code{--nx}
993 @cindex @code{-n}
994 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
995 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
996 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
997 files}.
998
999 @item -quiet
1000 @itemx -silent
1001 @itemx -q
1002 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1003 @cindex @code{--silent}
1004 @cindex @code{-q}
1005 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1006 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1007
1008 @item -batch
1009 @cindex @code{--batch}
1010 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1011 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1012 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1013 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1014 in the command files.
1015
1016 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1017 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1018 make this more useful, the message
1019
1020 @smallexample
1021 Program exited normally.
1022 @end smallexample
1023
1024 @noindent
1025 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1026 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1027 mode.
1028
1029 @item -batch-silent
1030 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1031 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1032 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1033 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1034 for an interactive session.
1035
1036 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1037 messages, for example.
1038
1039 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1040 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1041
1042 @item -return-child-result
1043 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1044 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1045 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1046
1047 @itemize @bullet
1048 @item
1049 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1050 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1051 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1052 @item
1053 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1054 @item
1055 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1056 the exit code will be -1.
1057 @end itemize
1058
1059 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1060 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1061 interface.
1062
1063 @item -nowindows
1064 @itemx -nw
1065 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1066 @cindex @code{-nw}
1067 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1068 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1069 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1070
1071 @item -windows
1072 @itemx -w
1073 @cindex @code{--windows}
1074 @cindex @code{-w}
1075 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1076 used if possible.
1077
1078 @item -cd @var{directory}
1079 @cindex @code{--cd}
1080 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1081 instead of the current directory.
1082
1083 @item -fullname
1084 @itemx -f
1085 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1086 @cindex @code{-f}
1087 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1088 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1089 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1090 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1091 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1092 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1093 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1094 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1095 frame.
1096
1097 @item -epoch
1098 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1099 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1100 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1101 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1102 separate window.
1103
1104 @item -annotate @var{level}
1105 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1106 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1107 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1108 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1109 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1110 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1111 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1112 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1113 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1114
1115 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1116 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1117
1118 @item --args
1119 @cindex @code{--args}
1120 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1121 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1122 This option stops option processing.
1123
1124 @item -baud @var{bps}
1125 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1126 @cindex @code{--baud}
1127 @cindex @code{-b}
1128 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1129 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1130
1131 @item -l @var{timeout}
1132 @cindex @code{-l}
1133 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1134 for remote debugging.
1135
1136 @item -tty @var{device}
1137 @itemx -t @var{device}
1138 @cindex @code{--tty}
1139 @cindex @code{-t}
1140 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1141 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1142
1143 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1144 @item -tui
1145 @cindex @code{--tui}
1146 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1147 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1148 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1149 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1150 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1151 @samp{gdbtui}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1152 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1153
1154 @c @item -xdb
1155 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1156 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1157 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1158 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1159 @c systems.
1160
1161 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1162 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1163 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1164 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1165 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1166 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1167
1168 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1169 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1170 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1171 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1172 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1173 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1174
1175 @item -write
1176 @cindex @code{--write}
1177 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1178 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1179 (@pxref{Patching}).
1180
1181 @item -statistics
1182 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1183 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1184 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1185
1186 @item -version
1187 @cindex @code{--version}
1188 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1189 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1190
1191 @end table
1192
1193 @node Startup
1194 @subsection What @value{GDBN} does during startup
1195 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1196
1197 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1198
1199 @enumerate
1200 @item
1201 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1202 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1203
1204 @item
1205 @cindex init file
1206 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1207 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1208 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1209 that file.
1210
1211 @item
1212 Processes command line options and operands.
1213
1214 @item
1215 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1216 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1217 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1218 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1219 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1220 @value{GDBN}.
1221
1222 @item
1223 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1224 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1225
1226 @item
1227 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1228 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1229 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1230 @end enumerate
1231
1232 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1233 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1234 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1235 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1236 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1237 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
1238
1239 @cindex init file name
1240 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1241 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1242 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
1243 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
1244 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
1245 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
1246 environments with special init file names:
1247
1248 @itemize @bullet
1249 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1250 @item
1251 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1252 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1253 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1254 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1255 the file to the standard name.
1256
1257 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
1258 @item
1259 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
1260
1261 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
1262 @item
1263 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
1264
1265 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
1266 @item
1267 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
1268
1269 @item
1270 CISCO 68k: @file{.cisco-gdbinit}
1271 @end itemize
1272
1273
1274 @node Quitting GDB
1275 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1276 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1277 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1278
1279 @table @code
1280 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1281 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1282 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1283 @itemx q
1284 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1285 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1286 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1287 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1288 error code.
1289 @end table
1290
1291 @cindex interrupt
1292 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1293 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1294 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1295 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1296 until a time when it is safe.
1297
1298 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1299 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1300 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1301
1302 @node Shell Commands
1303 @section Shell commands
1304
1305 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1306 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1307 just use the @code{shell} command.
1308
1309 @table @code
1310 @kindex shell
1311 @cindex shell escape
1312 @item shell @var{command string}
1313 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1314 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1315 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1316 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1317 @end table
1318
1319 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1320 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1321 @value{GDBN}:
1322
1323 @table @code
1324 @kindex make
1325 @cindex calling make
1326 @item make @var{make-args}
1327 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1328 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1329 @end table
1330
1331 @node Logging output
1332 @section Logging output
1333 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1334 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1335
1336 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1337 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1338
1339 @table @code
1340 @kindex set logging
1341 @item set logging on
1342 Enable logging.
1343 @item set logging off
1344 Disable logging.
1345 @cindex logging file name
1346 @item set logging file @var{file}
1347 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1348 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1349 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1350 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1351 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1352 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1353 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1354 @kindex show logging
1355 @item show logging
1356 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1357 @end table
1358
1359 @node Commands
1360 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1361
1362 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1363 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1364 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1365 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1366 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1367
1368 @menu
1369 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1370 * Completion:: Command completion
1371 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1372 @end menu
1373
1374 @node Command Syntax
1375 @section Command syntax
1376
1377 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1378 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1379 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1380 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1381 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1382 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1383
1384 @cindex abbreviation
1385 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1386 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1387 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1388 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1389 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1390 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1391 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1392
1393 @cindex repeating commands
1394 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1395 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1396 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1397 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1398 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1399 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1400 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1401
1402 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1403 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1404 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1405
1406 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1407 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1408 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1409 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1410 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1411
1412 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1413 @cindex comment
1414 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1415 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1416 Files,,Command files}).
1417
1418 @cindex repeating command sequences
1419 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1420 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1421 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1422 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1423 for editing.
1424
1425 @node Completion
1426 @section Command completion
1427
1428 @cindex completion
1429 @cindex word completion
1430 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1431 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1432 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1433 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1434
1435 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1436 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1437 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1438 enter it). For example, if you type
1439
1440 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1441 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1442 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1443 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1444 @smallexample
1445 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1446 @end smallexample
1447
1448 @noindent
1449 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1450 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1451
1452 @smallexample
1453 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1454 @end smallexample
1455
1456 @noindent
1457 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1458 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1459 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1460 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1461 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1462 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1463
1464 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1465 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1466 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1467 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1468 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1469 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1470 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1471 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1472 example:
1473
1474 @smallexample
1475 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1476 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1477 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1478 make_abs_section make_function_type
1479 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1480 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1481 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1482 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1483 @end smallexample
1484
1485 @noindent
1486 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1487 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1488 command.
1489
1490 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1491 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1492 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1493 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1494 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1495
1496 @cindex quotes in commands
1497 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1498 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1499 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1500 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1501 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1502 @value{GDBN} commands.
1503
1504 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1505 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1506 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1507 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1508 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1509 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1510 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1511 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1512 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1513 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1514 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1515
1516 @smallexample
1517 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1518 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1519 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1520 @end smallexample
1521
1522 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1523 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1524 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1525 place:
1526
1527 @smallexample
1528 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1529 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1530 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1531 @end smallexample
1532
1533 @noindent
1534 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1535 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1536 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1537
1538 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1539 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1540 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1541 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1542
1543
1544 @node Help
1545 @section Getting help
1546 @cindex online documentation
1547 @kindex help
1548
1549 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1550 using the command @code{help}.
1551
1552 @table @code
1553 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1554 @item help
1555 @itemx h
1556 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1557 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1558
1559 @smallexample
1560 (@value{GDBP}) help
1561 List of classes of commands:
1562
1563 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1564 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1565 data -- Examining data
1566 files -- Specifying and examining files
1567 internals -- Maintenance commands
1568 obscure -- Obscure features
1569 running -- Running the program
1570 stack -- Examining the stack
1571 status -- Status inquiries
1572 support -- Support facilities
1573 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1574 stopping the program
1575 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1576
1577 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1578 commands in that class.
1579 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1580 documentation.
1581 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1582 (@value{GDBP})
1583 @end smallexample
1584 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1585
1586 @item help @var{class}
1587 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1588 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1589 help display for the class @code{status}:
1590
1591 @smallexample
1592 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1593 Status inquiries.
1594
1595 List of commands:
1596
1597 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1598 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1599 info -- Generic command for showing things
1600 about the program being debugged
1601 show -- Generic command for showing things
1602 about the debugger
1603
1604 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1605 documentation.
1606 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1607 (@value{GDBP})
1608 @end smallexample
1609
1610 @item help @var{command}
1611 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1612 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1613
1614 @kindex apropos
1615 @item apropos @var{args}
1616 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1617 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1618 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 apropos reload
1622 @end smallexample
1623
1624 @noindent
1625 results in:
1626
1627 @smallexample
1628 @c @group
1629 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1630 multiple times in one run
1631 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1632 multiple times in one run
1633 @c @end group
1634 @end smallexample
1635
1636 @kindex complete
1637 @item complete @var{args}
1638 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1639 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1640 command you want completed. For example:
1641
1642 @smallexample
1643 complete i
1644 @end smallexample
1645
1646 @noindent results in:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 @group
1650 if
1651 ignore
1652 info
1653 inspect
1654 @end group
1655 @end smallexample
1656
1657 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1658 @end table
1659
1660 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1661 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1662 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1663 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1664 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1665 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1666
1667 @c @group
1668 @table @code
1669 @kindex info
1670 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1671 @item info
1672 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1673 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1674 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1675 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1676 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1677 @w{@code{help info}}.
1678
1679 @kindex set
1680 @item set
1681 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1682 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1683 @code{set prompt $}.
1684
1685 @kindex show
1686 @item show
1687 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1688 @value{GDBN} itself.
1689 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1690 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1691 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1692 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1693
1694 @kindex info set
1695 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1696 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1697 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1698 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1699 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1700 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1701 @end table
1702 @c @end group
1703
1704 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1705 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1706
1707 @table @code
1708 @kindex show version
1709 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1710 @item show version
1711 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1712 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1713 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1714 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1715 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1716 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1717 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1718 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1719 @value{GDBN}.
1720
1721 @kindex show copying
1722 @kindex info copying
1723 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1724 @item show copying
1725 @itemx info copying
1726 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1727
1728 @kindex show warranty
1729 @kindex info warranty
1730 @item show warranty
1731 @itemx info warranty
1732 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1733 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1734
1735 @end table
1736
1737 @node Running
1738 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1739
1740 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1741 debugging information when you compile it.
1742
1743 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1744 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1745 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1746 kill a child process.
1747
1748 @menu
1749 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1750 * Starting:: Starting your program
1751 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1752 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1753
1754 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1755 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1756 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1757 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1758
1759 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1760 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1761 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1762 @end menu
1763
1764 @node Compilation
1765 @section Compiling for debugging
1766
1767 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1768 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1769 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1770 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1771 and addresses in the executable code.
1772
1773 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1774 the compiler.
1775
1776 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1777 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1778 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1779 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1780 executables containing debugging information.
1781
1782 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1783 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1784 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1785 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1786 in pushing your luck.
1787
1788 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1789 @cindex debugging optimized code
1790 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1791 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1792 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1793 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1794 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1795 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1796
1797 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1798 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1799 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1800 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1801 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1802
1803 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1804 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1805 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1806
1807 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1808 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1809 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1810 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1811 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1812 provides macro information if you specify the options
1813 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1814 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1815 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1816 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1817 @option{-g} alone.
1818
1819 @need 2000
1820 @node Starting
1821 @section Starting your program
1822 @cindex starting
1823 @cindex running
1824
1825 @table @code
1826 @kindex run
1827 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1828 @item run
1829 @itemx r
1830 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1831 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1832 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1833 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1834 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1835
1836 @end table
1837
1838 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1839 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1840 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1841 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1842
1843 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1844 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1845 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1846 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1847 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1848 divided into four categories:
1849
1850 @table @asis
1851 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1852 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1853 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1854 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1855 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1856 the arguments.
1857 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1858 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1859 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1860
1861 @item The @emph{environment.}
1862 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1863 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1864 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1865 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1866
1867 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1868 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1869 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1870 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1871
1872 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1873 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1874 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1875 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1876 set a different device for your program.
1877 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1878
1879 @cindex pipes
1880 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1881 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1882 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1883 wrong program.
1884 @end table
1885
1886 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1887 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1888 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1889 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1890 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1891
1892 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1893 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1894 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1895 your current breakpoints.
1896
1897 @table @code
1898 @kindex start
1899 @item start
1900 @cindex run to main procedure
1901 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1902 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1903 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1904 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1905 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1906 procedure, depending on the language used.
1907
1908 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1909 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1910 the @samp{run} command.
1911
1912 @cindex elaboration phase
1913 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1914 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1915 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1916 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1917 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1918 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1919 will remain to halt execution.
1920
1921 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1922 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1923 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1924 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1925 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1926
1927 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1928 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1929 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1930 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1931 elaboration code before running your program.
1932 @end table
1933
1934 @node Arguments
1935 @section Your program's arguments
1936
1937 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1938 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1939 @code{run} command.
1940 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1941 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1942 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1943 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1944 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1945
1946 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1947 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1948 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1949 the program, not by the shell.
1950
1951 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1952 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1953
1954 @table @code
1955 @kindex set args
1956 @item set args
1957 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1958 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1959 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1960 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1961 it again without arguments.
1962
1963 @kindex show args
1964 @item show args
1965 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1966 @end table
1967
1968 @node Environment
1969 @section Your program's environment
1970
1971 @cindex environment (of your program)
1972 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1973 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1974 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1975 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1976 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1977 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1978 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1979
1980 @table @code
1981 @kindex path
1982 @item path @var{directory}
1983 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1984 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1985 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1986 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1987 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1988 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1989 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1990
1991 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1992 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1993 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1994 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1995 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1996 @var{directory} to the search path.
1997 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1998 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1999
2000 @kindex show paths
2001 @item show paths
2002 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2003 environment variable).
2004
2005 @kindex show environment
2006 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2007 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2008 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2009 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2010 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2011
2012 @kindex set environment
2013 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2014 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2015 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2016 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2017 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2018 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2019 null value.
2020 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2021 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2022
2023 For example, this command:
2024
2025 @smallexample
2026 set env USER = foo
2027 @end smallexample
2028
2029 @noindent
2030 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2031 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2032 are not actually required.)
2033
2034 @kindex unset environment
2035 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2036 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2037 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2038 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2039 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2040 @end table
2041
2042 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2043 the shell indicated
2044 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2045 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2046 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2047 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2048 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2049 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2050 @file{.profile}.
2051
2052 @node Working Directory
2053 @section Your program's working directory
2054
2055 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2056 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2057 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2058 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2059 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2060 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2061
2062 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2063 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2064 specify files}.
2065
2066 @table @code
2067 @kindex cd
2068 @cindex change working directory
2069 @item cd @var{directory}
2070 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2071
2072 @kindex pwd
2073 @item pwd
2074 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2075 @end table
2076
2077 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2078 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2079 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2080 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2081 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2082 current working directory of the debuggee.
2083
2084 @node Input/Output
2085 @section Your program's input and output
2086
2087 @cindex redirection
2088 @cindex i/o
2089 @cindex terminal
2090 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2091 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2092 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2093 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2094 running your program.
2095
2096 @table @code
2097 @kindex info terminal
2098 @item info terminal
2099 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2100 program is using.
2101 @end table
2102
2103 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2104 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2105
2106 @smallexample
2107 run > outfile
2108 @end smallexample
2109
2110 @noindent
2111 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2112
2113 @kindex tty
2114 @cindex controlling terminal
2115 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2116 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2117 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2118 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2119 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2120
2121 @smallexample
2122 tty /dev/ttyb
2123 @end smallexample
2124
2125 @noindent
2126 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2127 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2128 that as their controlling terminal.
2129
2130 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2131 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2132 terminal.
2133
2134 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2135 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2136 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2137 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2138
2139 @cindex inferior tty
2140 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2141 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2142 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2143 program.
2144
2145 @table @code
2146 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2147 @kindex set inferior-tty
2148 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2149
2150 @item show inferior-tty
2151 @kindex show inferior-tty
2152 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2153 @end table
2154
2155 @node Attach
2156 @section Debugging an already-running process
2157 @kindex attach
2158 @cindex attach
2159
2160 @table @code
2161 @item attach @var{process-id}
2162 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2163 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2164 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2165 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2166 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2167
2168 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2169 executing the command.
2170 @end table
2171
2172 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2173 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2174 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2175 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2176
2177 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2178 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2179 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2180 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
2181 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2182 Specify Files}.
2183
2184 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2185 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2186 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2187 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2188 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2189 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2190 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2191
2192 @table @code
2193 @kindex detach
2194 @item detach
2195 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2196 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2197 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2198 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2199 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2200 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2201 executing the command.
2202 @end table
2203
2204 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2205 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2206 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2207 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2208 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2209 messages}).
2210
2211 @node Kill Process
2212 @section Killing the child process
2213
2214 @table @code
2215 @kindex kill
2216 @item kill
2217 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2218 @end table
2219
2220 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2221 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2222 is running.
2223
2224 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2225 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2226 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2227 outside the debugger.
2228
2229 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2230 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2231 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2232 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2233 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2234 breakpoint settings).
2235
2236 @node Threads
2237 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2238
2239 @cindex threads of execution
2240 @cindex multiple threads
2241 @cindex switching threads
2242 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2243 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2244 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2245 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2246 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2247 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2248 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2249
2250 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2251 programs:
2252
2253 @itemize @bullet
2254 @item automatic notification of new threads
2255 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2256 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2257 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2258 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2259 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2260 @end itemize
2261
2262 @quotation
2263 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2264 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2265 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2266 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2267 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2268 like this:
2269
2270 @smallexample
2271 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2272 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2273 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2274 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2275 @end smallexample
2276 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2277 @c doesn't support threads"?
2278 @end quotation
2279
2280 @cindex focus of debugging
2281 @cindex current thread
2282 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2283 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2284 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2285 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2286 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2287
2288 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2289 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2290 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2291 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2292 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2293 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2294 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2295 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2296 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2297 LynxOS, you might see
2298
2299 @smallexample
2300 [New process 35 thread 27]
2301 @end smallexample
2302
2303 @noindent
2304 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2305 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2306 further qualifier.
2307
2308 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2309 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2310 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2311 @c program?
2312 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2313 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2314 @c threads ab initio?
2315
2316 @cindex thread number
2317 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2318 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2319 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2320
2321 @table @code
2322 @kindex info threads
2323 @item info threads
2324 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2325 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2326
2327 @enumerate
2328 @item
2329 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2330
2331 @item
2332 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2333
2334 @item
2335 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2336 @end enumerate
2337
2338 @noindent
2339 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2340 indicates the current thread.
2341
2342 For example,
2343 @end table
2344 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2345
2346 @smallexample
2347 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2348 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2349 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2350 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2351 at threadtest.c:68
2352 @end smallexample
2353
2354 On HP-UX systems:
2355
2356 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2357 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2358 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2359 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2360 thread in your program.
2361
2362 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2363 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2364 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2365 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2366 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2367 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2368 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2369 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2370 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2371 HP-UX, you see
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2379
2380 @table @code
2381 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2382 @item info threads
2383 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2384 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2385
2386 @enumerate
2387 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2388
2389 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2390
2391 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2392 @end enumerate
2393
2394 @noindent
2395 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2396 indicates the current thread.
2397
2398 For example,
2399 @end table
2400 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2401
2402 @smallexample
2403 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2404 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2405 at quicksort.c:137
2406 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2407 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2408 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2409 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2410 @end smallexample
2411
2412 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2413 Solaris-specific command:
2414
2415 @table @code
2416 @item maint info sol-threads
2417 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2418 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2419 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2420 @end table
2421
2422 @table @code
2423 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2424 @item thread @var{threadno}
2425 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2426 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2427 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2428 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2429 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2430
2431 @smallexample
2432 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2433 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2434 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2435 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2436 @end smallexample
2437
2438 @noindent
2439 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2440 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2441 threads.
2442
2443 @kindex thread apply
2444 @cindex apply command to several threads
2445 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2446 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2447 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2448 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2449 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2450 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2451 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2452 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2453 @end table
2454
2455 @cindex automatic thread selection
2456 @cindex switching threads automatically
2457 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2458 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2459 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2460 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2461 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2462 thread.
2463
2464 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2465 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2466 programs with multiple threads.
2467
2468 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2469 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2470
2471 @node Processes
2472 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2473
2474 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2475 @cindex multiple processes
2476 @cindex processes, multiple
2477 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2478 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2479 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2480 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2481 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2482 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2483 will cause it to terminate.
2484
2485 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2486 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2487 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2488 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2489 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2490 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2491 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2492 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2493 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2494 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2495
2496 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2497 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2498 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2499 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2500
2501 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2502 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2503
2504 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2505 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2506
2507 @table @code
2508 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2509 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2510 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2511 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2512 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2513
2514 @table @code
2515 @item parent
2516 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2517 unimpeded. This is the default.
2518
2519 @item child
2520 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2521 unimpeded.
2522
2523 @end table
2524
2525 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2526 @item show follow-fork-mode
2527 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2528 @end table
2529
2530 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2531 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2532 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2533
2534 @table @code
2535 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2536 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2537 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2538 retain debugger control over them both.
2539
2540 @table @code
2541 @item on
2542 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2543 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2544 independently. This is the default.
2545
2546 @item off
2547 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2548 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2549 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2550 is held suspended.
2551
2552 @end table
2553
2554 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2555 @item show detach-on-follow
2556 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2557 @end table
2558
2559 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2560 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2561 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2562 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2563 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2564
2565 @table @code
2566 @kindex info forks
2567 @item info forks
2568 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2569 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2570 position (program counter) of the process.
2571
2572
2573 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2574 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2575 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2576 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2577 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2578
2579 @end table
2580
2581 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2582 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2583 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2584 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2585
2586 @table @code
2587 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2588 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2589 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2590 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2591 allowed to run independently.
2592
2593 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2594 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2595 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2596 and remove it from the fork list.
2597
2598 @end table
2599
2600 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2601 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2602 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2603 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2604 the child process's @code{main}.
2605
2606 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2607 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2608
2609 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2610 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2611 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2612 argument.
2613
2614 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2615 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2616 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2617
2618 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2619 @section Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
2620
2621 @cindex checkpoint
2622 @cindex restart
2623 @cindex bookmark
2624 @cindex snapshot of a process
2625 @cindex rewind program state
2626
2627 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2628 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2629 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2630 later.
2631
2632 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2633 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2634 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2635 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2636 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2637
2638 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2639 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2640 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2641 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2642 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2643 start again from there.
2644
2645 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2646 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2647
2648 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2649
2650 @table @code
2651 @kindex checkpoint
2652 @item checkpoint
2653 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2654 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2655 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2656
2657 @kindex info checkpoints
2658 @item info checkpoints
2659 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2660 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2661 listed:
2662
2663 @table @code
2664 @item Checkpoint ID
2665 @item Process ID
2666 @item Code Address
2667 @item Source line, or label
2668 @end table
2669
2670 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2671 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2672 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2673 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2674 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2675 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2676 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2677
2678 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2679 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2680 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2681 the debugger.
2682
2683 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2684 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2685 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2686
2687 @end table
2688
2689 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2690 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2691 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2692 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2693 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2694 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2695 previously read data can be read again.
2696
2697 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2698 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2699 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2700 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2701 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2702 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2703
2704 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2705 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2706 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2707 different execution path this time.
2708
2709 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2710 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2711 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2712 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2713 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2714 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2715 potentially pose a problem.
2716
2717 @subsection A non-obvious benefit of using checkpoints
2718
2719 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2720 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2721 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2722 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2723 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2724 next.
2725
2726 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2727 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2728 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2729 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2730 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2731
2732 @node Stopping
2733 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2734
2735 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2736 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2737 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2738
2739 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2740 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2741 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2742 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2743 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2744 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2745 explicitly request this information at any time.
2746
2747 @table @code
2748 @kindex info program
2749 @item info program
2750 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2751 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2752 @end table
2753
2754 @menu
2755 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2756 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2757 * Signals:: Signals
2758 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2759 @end menu
2760
2761 @node Breakpoints
2762 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2763
2764 @cindex breakpoints
2765 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2766 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2767 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2768 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2769 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2770 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2771 program.
2772
2773 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2774 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2775 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2776 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2777 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2778 call).
2779
2780 @cindex watchpoints
2781 @cindex data breakpoints
2782 @cindex memory tracing
2783 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2784 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2785 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2786 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2787 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2788 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2789 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2790 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting watchpoints}), but aside
2791 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2792 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2793 same commands.
2794
2795 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2796 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2797 Automatic display}.
2798
2799 @cindex catchpoints
2800 @cindex breakpoint on events
2801 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2802 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2803 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2804 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2805 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2806 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2807 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2808
2809 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2810 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2811 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2812 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2813 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2814 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2815 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2816 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2817 enable it again.
2818
2819 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2820 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2821 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2822 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2823 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2824 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2825 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2826
2827 @menu
2828 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2829 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2830 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2831 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2832 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2833 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2834 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2835 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2836 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2837 * Breakpoint related warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2838 @end menu
2839
2840 @node Set Breaks
2841 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2842
2843 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2844 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2845 @c
2846 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2847
2848 @kindex break
2849 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2850 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2851 @cindex latest breakpoint
2852 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2853 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2854 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2855 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2856 convenience variables.
2857
2858 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2859
2860 @table @code
2861 @item break @var{function}
2862 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2863 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2864 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2865 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2866
2867 @item break +@var{offset}
2868 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2869 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2870 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2871 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2872
2873 @item break @var{linenum}
2874 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2875 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2876 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2877 code on that line.
2878
2879 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2880 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2881
2882 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2883 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2884 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2885 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2886 functions.
2887
2888 @item break *@var{address}
2889 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2890 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2891 information or source files.
2892
2893 @item break
2894 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2895 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2896 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2897 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2898 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2899 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2900 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2901 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2902 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2903 inside loops.
2904
2905 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2906 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2907 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2908 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2909 existed when your program stopped.
2910
2911 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2912 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2913 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2914 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2915 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2916 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2917 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2918
2919 @kindex tbreak
2920 @item tbreak @var{args}
2921 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2922 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2923 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2924 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2925
2926 @kindex hbreak
2927 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2928 @item hbreak @var{args}
2929 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2930 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2931 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2932 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2933 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2934 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2935 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2936 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2937 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2938 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2939 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2940 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2941 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2942 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2943 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2944 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2945 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2946
2947
2948 @kindex thbreak
2949 @item thbreak @var{args}
2950 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2951 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2952 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2953 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2954 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2955 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2956 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2957 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2958
2959 @kindex rbreak
2960 @cindex regular expression
2961 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2962 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2963 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2964 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2965 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2966 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2967 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2968 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2969 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2970
2971 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2972 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2973 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2974 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2975 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2976 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2977
2978 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2979 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2980 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2981 classes.
2982
2983 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2984 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2985 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2986
2987 @smallexample
2988 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2989 @end smallexample
2990
2991 @kindex info breakpoints
2992 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2993 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2994 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2995 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2996 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2997 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
2998 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
2999 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3000
3001 @table @emph
3002 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3003 @item Type
3004 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3005 @item Disposition
3006 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3007 @item Enabled or Disabled
3008 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3009 that are not enabled.
3010 @item Address
3011 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
3012 breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
3013 will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
3014 @item What
3015 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3016 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3017 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3018 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3019 @end table
3020
3021 @noindent
3022 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3023 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3024 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3025 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3026 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3027 valid location.
3028
3029 @noindent
3030 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3031 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3032 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3033 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3034 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
3035
3036 @noindent
3037 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3038 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3039 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3040 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3041 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3042 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3043 @end table
3044
3045 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3046 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3047 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3048 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3049
3050 @cindex pending breakpoints
3051 If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
3052 that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
3053 a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
3054 a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
3055 attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
3056 gets loaded.
3057
3058 Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
3059 @value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
3060 later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
3061 a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
3062 If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
3063 a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
3064
3065 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
3066 breakpoint support:
3067
3068 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3069 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3070 @table @code
3071 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3072 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3073 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3074
3075 @item set breakpoint pending on
3076 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3077 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3078
3079 @item set breakpoint pending off
3080 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3081 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3082 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3083
3084 @item show breakpoint pending
3085 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3086 @end table
3087
3088 @cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
3089 Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
3090 specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
3091 breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
3092 the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
3093 the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
3094 pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
3095 tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
3096 shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
3097 @value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
3098 This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
3099 occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
3100 of these loads could resolve the location.
3101
3102 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3103 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3104 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3105 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3106 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3107 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3108 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3109 breakpoints.
3110
3111 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3112
3113 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3114 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3115 @table @code
3116 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3117 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3118 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3119 breakpoint must be used.
3120
3121 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3122 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3123 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3124 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3125 @end table
3126
3127
3128 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3129 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3130 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3131 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3132 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3133 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3134 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3135 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3136
3137
3138 @node Set Watchpoints
3139 @subsection Setting watchpoints
3140
3141 @cindex setting watchpoints
3142 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3143 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3144 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3145 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3146 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3147
3148 @itemize @bullet
3149 @item
3150 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3151
3152 @item
3153 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3154 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3155 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3156
3157 @item
3158 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3159 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3160 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3161 @end itemize
3162
3163 @cindex software watchpoints
3164 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3165 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3166 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3167 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3168 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3169 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3170 culprit.)
3171
3172 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3173 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3174 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3175
3176 @table @code
3177 @kindex watch
3178 @item watch @var{expr}
3179 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3180 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3181 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3182 to watch the value of a single variable:
3183
3184 @smallexample
3185 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3186 @end smallexample
3187
3188 @kindex rwatch
3189 @item rwatch @var{expr}
3190 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3191 by the program.
3192
3193 @kindex awatch
3194 @item awatch @var{expr}
3195 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3196 or written into by the program.
3197
3198 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3199 @item info watchpoints
3200 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3201 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3202 @end table
3203
3204 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3205 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3206 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3207 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3208 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3209 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3210
3211 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3212 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3213 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3214 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3215 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3216 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3217 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3218 mechanism of watching expressiion values.)
3219
3220 @table @code
3221 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3222 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3223 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3224
3225 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3226 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3227 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3228 @end table
3229
3230 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3231 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3232 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3233
3234 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3235
3236 @smallexample
3237 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3238 @end smallexample
3239
3240 @noindent
3241 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3242
3243 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3244 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3245 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3246 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3247 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3248 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3249 will print a message like this:
3250
3251 @smallexample
3252 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3253 @end smallexample
3254
3255 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3256 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3257 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3258 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3259 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3260 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3261 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3262 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3263
3264 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3265 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3266 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3267 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3268 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3269 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3270
3271 @smallexample
3272 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3273 @end smallexample
3274
3275 @noindent
3276 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3277
3278 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3279 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3280 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3281 expression with separately allocated resources.
3282
3283 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3284 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3285 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3286 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3287 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3288 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3289 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3290 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3291 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3292 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3293
3294 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3295 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3296 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3297
3298 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3299 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3300 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3301 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3302 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3303 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3304 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3305 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3306 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3307
3308 @quotation
3309 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3310 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3311 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
3312 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
3313 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
3314 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
3315 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
3316 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
3317 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
3318 the expression.
3319
3320 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
3321 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
3322 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3323 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3324 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3325 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3326 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3327 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3328 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3329 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3330 @end quotation
3331
3332 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3333
3334 @node Set Catchpoints
3335 @subsection Setting catchpoints
3336 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3337 @cindex exception handlers
3338 @cindex event handling
3339
3340 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3341 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3342 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3343
3344 @table @code
3345 @kindex catch
3346 @item catch @var{event}
3347 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3348 @table @code
3349 @item throw
3350 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3351 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3352
3353 @item catch
3354 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3355
3356 @item exception
3357 @cindex Ada exception catching
3358 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3359 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3360 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3361 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3362 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3363
3364 @item exception unhandled
3365 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3366
3367 @item assert
3368 A failed Ada assertion.
3369
3370 @item exec
3371 @cindex break on fork/exec
3372 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3373
3374 @item fork
3375 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3376
3377 @item vfork
3378 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3379
3380 @item load
3381 @itemx load @var{libname}
3382 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3383 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3384 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3385
3386 @item unload
3387 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3388 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3389 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3390 @end table
3391
3392 @item tcatch @var{event}
3393 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3394 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3395
3396 @end table
3397
3398 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3399
3400 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3401 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3402
3403 @itemize @bullet
3404 @item
3405 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3406 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3407 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3408 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3409 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3410 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3411 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3412 disabled within interactive calls.
3413
3414 @item
3415 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3416
3417 @item
3418 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3419 @end itemize
3420
3421 @cindex raise exceptions
3422 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3423 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3424 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3425 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3426 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3427 out where the exception was raised.
3428
3429 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3430 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3431 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3432 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3433
3434 @smallexample
3435 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3436 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3437 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3438 @end smallexample
3439
3440 @noindent
3441 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3442 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3443 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
3444
3445 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
3446 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3447 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3448 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3449 raised.
3450
3451
3452 @node Delete Breaks
3453 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
3454
3455 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3456 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3457 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3458 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3459 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3460 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3461
3462 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3463 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3464 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3465 their breakpoint numbers.
3466
3467 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3468 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3469 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3470
3471 @table @code
3472 @kindex clear
3473 @item clear
3474 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3475 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
3476 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3477 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3478
3479 @item clear @var{function}
3480 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3481 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3482
3483 @item clear @var{linenum}
3484 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3485 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3486 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3487
3488 @cindex delete breakpoints
3489 @kindex delete
3490 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3491 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3492 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3493 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3494 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3495 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3496 @end table
3497
3498 @node Disabling
3499 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
3500
3501 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3502 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3503 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3504 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3505 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3506
3507 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3508 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3509 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3510 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3511 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3512
3513 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3514 states of enablement:
3515
3516 @itemize @bullet
3517 @item
3518 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3519 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3520 @item
3521 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3522 @item
3523 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3524 disabled.
3525 @item
3526 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3527 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3528 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3529 @end itemize
3530
3531 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3532 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3533
3534 @table @code
3535 @kindex disable
3536 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3537 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3538 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3539 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3540 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3541 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3542 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3543
3544 @kindex enable
3545 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3546 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3547 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3548
3549 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3550 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3551 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3552
3553 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3554 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3555 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3556 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3557 @end table
3558
3559 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3560 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3561 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3562 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3563 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3564 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3565 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3566 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3567 stepping}.)
3568
3569 @node Conditions
3570 @subsection Break conditions
3571 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3572 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3573
3574 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3575 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3576 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3577 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3578 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3579 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3580 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3581 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3582
3583 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3584 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3585 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3586 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3587 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3588
3589 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3590 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3591 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3592 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3593 one.
3594
3595 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3596 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3597 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3598 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3599 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3600 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3601 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3602 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3603 conditions for the
3604 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3605 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3606
3607 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3608 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3609 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3610 with the @code{condition} command.
3611
3612 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3613 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3614 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3615 catchpoint.
3616
3617 @table @code
3618 @kindex condition
3619 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3620 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3621 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3622 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3623 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3624 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3625 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3626 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3627 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3628 prints an error message:
3629
3630 @smallexample
3631 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3632 @end smallexample
3633
3634 @noindent
3635 @value{GDBN} does
3636 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3637 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3638 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3639
3640 @item condition @var{bnum}
3641 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3642 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3643 @end table
3644
3645 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3646 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3647 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3648 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3649 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3650 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3651 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3652 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3653 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3654 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3655 your program reaches it.
3656
3657 @table @code
3658 @kindex ignore
3659 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3660 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3661 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3662 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3663 takes no action.
3664
3665 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3666 a count of zero.
3667
3668 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3669 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3670 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3671 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3672
3673 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3674 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3675 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3676
3677 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3678 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3679 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3680 variables}.
3681 @end table
3682
3683 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3684
3685
3686 @node Break Commands
3687 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3688
3689 @cindex breakpoint commands
3690 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3691 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3692 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3693 enable other breakpoints.
3694
3695 @table @code
3696 @kindex commands
3697 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3698 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3699 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3700 @itemx end
3701 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3702 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3703 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3704
3705 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3706 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3707
3708 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3709 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3710 recently encountered).
3711 @end table
3712
3713 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3714 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3715
3716 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3717 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3718 that resumes execution.
3719
3720 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3721 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3722 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3723 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3724 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3725
3726 @kindex silent
3727 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3728 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3729 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3730 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3731 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3732 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3733
3734 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3735 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3736 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3737
3738 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3739 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3740
3741 @smallexample
3742 break foo if x>0
3743 commands
3744 silent
3745 printf "x is %d\n",x
3746 cont
3747 end
3748 @end smallexample
3749
3750 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3751 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3752 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3753 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3754 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3755 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3756 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3757
3758 @smallexample
3759 break 403
3760 commands
3761 silent
3762 set x = y + 4
3763 cont
3764 end
3765 @end smallexample
3766
3767 @node Breakpoint Menus
3768 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3769 @cindex overloading
3770 @cindex symbol overloading
3771
3772 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3773 single function name
3774 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3775 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3776 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3777 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3778 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3779 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3780 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3781 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3782 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3783 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3784 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3785 breakpoints.
3786
3787 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3788 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3789 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3790
3791 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3792 @smallexample
3793 @group
3794 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3795 [0] cancel
3796 [1] all
3797 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3798 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3799 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3800 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3801 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3802 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3803 > 2 4 6
3804 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3805 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3806 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3807 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3808 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3809 breakpoints.
3810 (@value{GDBP})
3811 @end group
3812 @end smallexample
3813
3814 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3815 @node Error in Breakpoints
3816 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3817 @c
3818 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3819 @c
3820 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3821 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3822 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3823 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3824
3825 @smallexample
3826 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3827 The same program may be running in another process.
3828 @end smallexample
3829
3830 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3831
3832 @enumerate
3833 @item
3834 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3835
3836 @item
3837 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3838 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3839 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3840 Then start your program again.
3841
3842 @item
3843 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3844 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3845 to nonsharable executables.
3846 @end enumerate
3847 @c @end ifclear
3848
3849 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3850 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3851
3852 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3853 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3854 @smallexample
3855 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3856 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3857 @end smallexample
3858
3859 @noindent
3860 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3861 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3862 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3863
3864 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3865 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3866
3867 @node Breakpoint related warnings
3868 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3869 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3870
3871 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3872 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3873 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3874 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3875
3876 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3877 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3878 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3879 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3880 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3881 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3882 first in the bundle.
3883
3884 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3885 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3886 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3887 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3888 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3889 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3890 is hit.
3891
3892 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3893 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3894
3895 @smallexample
3896 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3897 @end smallexample
3898
3899 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3900 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3901 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3902 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3903 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3904 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3905 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3906 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3907
3908 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3909 adjusted breakpoints:
3910
3911 @smallexample
3912 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3913 to 0x00010410.
3914 @end smallexample
3915
3916 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3917 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3918 frequently than expected.
3919
3920 @node Continuing and Stepping
3921 @section Continuing and stepping
3922
3923 @cindex stepping
3924 @cindex continuing
3925 @cindex resuming execution
3926 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3927 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3928 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3929 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3930 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3931 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3932 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3933 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3934
3935 @table @code
3936 @kindex continue
3937 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3938 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3939 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3940 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3941 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3942 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3943 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3944 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3945 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3946 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3947
3948 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3949 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3950 @code{continue} is ignored.
3951
3952 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3953 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3954 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3955 @code{continue}.
3956 @end table
3957
3958 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3959 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3960 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3961 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3962
3963 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3964 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3965 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3966 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3967 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3968 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3969
3970 @table @code
3971 @kindex step
3972 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3973 @item step
3974 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3975 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3976 abbreviated @code{s}.
3977
3978 @quotation
3979 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3980 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3981 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3982 @c distinction here.
3983 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3984 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3985 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3986 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3987 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3988 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3989 below.
3990 @end quotation
3991
3992 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3993 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3994 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3995 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3996 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3997 called within the line.
3998
3999 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4000 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4001 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4002 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4003 was any debugging information about the routine.
4004
4005 @item step @var{count}
4006 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4007 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4008 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4009
4010 @kindex next
4011 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4012 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4013 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4014 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4015 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4016 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4017 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4018 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4019
4020 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4021
4022
4023 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4024 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4025 @c
4026 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4027 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4028 @c function are executed without stopping.
4029
4030 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4031 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4032 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4033
4034 @kindex set step-mode
4035 @item set step-mode
4036 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4037 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4038 @itemx set step-mode on
4039 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4040 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4041 information rather than stepping over it.
4042
4043 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4044 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4045 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4046
4047 @item set step-mode off
4048 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4049 debug information. This is the default.
4050
4051 @item show step-mode
4052 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4053 source line debug information.
4054
4055 @kindex finish
4056 @item finish
4057 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4058 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4059
4060 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4061 ,Returning from a function}).
4062
4063 @kindex until
4064 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4065 @cindex run until specified location
4066 @item until
4067 @itemx u
4068 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4069 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4070 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4071 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4072 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4073 than the address of the jump.
4074
4075 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4076 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4077 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4078 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4079 through the next iteration.
4080
4081 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4082 stack frame.
4083
4084 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4085 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4086 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4087 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4088 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4089
4090 @smallexample
4091 (@value{GDBP}) f
4092 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4093 206 expand_input();
4094 (@value{GDBP}) until
4095 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4096 @end smallexample
4097
4098 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4099 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4100 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4101 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4102 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4103 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4104 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4105
4106 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4107 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4108 argument.
4109
4110 @item until @var{location}
4111 @itemx u @var{location}
4112 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4113 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4114 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4115 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4116 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4117 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4118 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4119 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4120 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4121 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
4122 invocations have returned.
4123
4124 @smallexample
4125 94 int factorial (int value)
4126 95 @{
4127 96 if (value > 1) @{
4128 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4129 98 @}
4130 99 return (value);
4131 100 @}
4132 @end smallexample
4133
4134
4135 @kindex advance @var{location}
4136 @itemx advance @var{location}
4137 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4138 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4139 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4140 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4141 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4142 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4143
4144
4145 @kindex stepi
4146 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4147 @item stepi
4148 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4149 @itemx si
4150 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4151
4152 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4153 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4154 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4155 Display,, Automatic display}.
4156
4157 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4158
4159 @need 750
4160 @kindex nexti
4161 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4162 @item nexti
4163 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4164 @itemx ni
4165 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4166 proceed until the function returns.
4167
4168 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4169 @end table
4170
4171 @node Signals
4172 @section Signals
4173 @cindex signals
4174
4175 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4176 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4177 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4178 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4179 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4180 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4181 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4182 requested an alarm).
4183
4184 @cindex fatal signals
4185 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4186 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4187 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4188 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4189 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4190 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4191
4192 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4193 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4194 signal.
4195
4196 @cindex handling signals
4197 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4198 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4199 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4200 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4201 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4202
4203 @table @code
4204 @kindex info signals
4205 @kindex info handle
4206 @item info signals
4207 @itemx info handle
4208 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4209 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4210 the defined types of signals.
4211
4212 @item info signals @var{sig}
4213 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4214
4215 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4216
4217 @kindex handle
4218 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4219 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4220 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4221 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4222 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4223 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4224 say what change to make.
4225 @end table
4226
4227 @c @group
4228 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4229 Their full names are:
4230
4231 @table @code
4232 @item nostop
4233 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4234 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4235
4236 @item stop
4237 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4238 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4239
4240 @item print
4241 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4242
4243 @item noprint
4244 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4245 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4246
4247 @item pass
4248 @itemx noignore
4249 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4250 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4251 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4252
4253 @item nopass
4254 @itemx ignore
4255 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4256 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4257 @end table
4258 @c @end group
4259
4260 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4261 program until you
4262 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4263 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4264 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4265 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4266 program sees that signal when you continue.
4267
4268 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4269 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4270 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4271 erroneous signals.
4272
4273 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4274 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4275 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4276 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4277 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4278 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4279 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4280 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4281 program a signal}.
4282
4283 @node Thread Stops
4284 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
4285
4286 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4287 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
4288 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4289
4290 @table @code
4291 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4292 @cindex thread breakpoints
4293 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4294 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4295 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4296 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4297 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4298
4299 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4300 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4301 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4302 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4303 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4304
4305 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4306 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4307 program.
4308
4309 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4310 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4311 breakpoint condition, like this:
4312
4313 @smallexample
4314 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4315 @end smallexample
4316
4317 @end table
4318
4319 @cindex stopped threads
4320 @cindex threads, stopped
4321 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4322 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4323 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4324 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4325 underfoot.
4326
4327 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4328 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4329 @cindex premature return from system calls
4330 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4331 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4332 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4333 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4334 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4335 stop execution.
4336
4337 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4338 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4339 style anyways.
4340
4341 For example, do not write code like this:
4342
4343 @smallexample
4344 sleep (10);
4345 @end smallexample
4346
4347 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4348 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4349
4350 Instead, write this:
4351
4352 @smallexample
4353 int unslept = 10;
4354 while (unslept > 0)
4355 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4356 @end smallexample
4357
4358 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4359 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4360 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4361 @value{GDBN}.
4362
4363 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4364 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4365 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4366 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4367
4368 @cindex continuing threads
4369 @cindex threads, continuing
4370 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4371 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4372 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4373
4374 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4375 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4376 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4377 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4378 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4379 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4380 stops.
4381
4382 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4383 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4384 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4385 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4386
4387 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4388 thread to run.
4389
4390 @table @code
4391 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4392 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4393 @cindex lock scheduler
4394 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4395 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4396 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4397 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4398 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4399 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4400 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4401 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4402 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4403 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4404 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4405
4406 @item show scheduler-locking
4407 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4408 @end table
4409
4410
4411 @node Stack
4412 @chapter Examining the Stack
4413
4414 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4415 stopped and how it got there.
4416
4417 @cindex call stack
4418 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4419 is generated.
4420 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4421 the arguments of the call,
4422 and the local variables of the function being called.
4423 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4424 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4425 stack}.
4426
4427 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4428 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4429
4430 @cindex selected frame
4431 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4432 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4433 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4434 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4435 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4436 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4437
4438 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4439 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4440 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
4441
4442 @menu
4443 * Frames:: Stack frames
4444 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4445 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4446 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4447
4448 @end menu
4449
4450 @node Frames
4451 @section Stack frames
4452
4453 @cindex frame, definition
4454 @cindex stack frame
4455 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4456 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4457 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4458 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4459 which the function is executing.
4460
4461 @cindex initial frame
4462 @cindex outermost frame
4463 @cindex innermost frame
4464 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4465 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4466 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4467 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4468 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4469 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4470 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4471 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4472
4473 @cindex frame pointer
4474 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4475 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4476 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4477 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4478 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4479 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4480
4481 @cindex frame number
4482 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4483 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4484 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4485 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4486 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4487
4488 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4489 @c underflow problems.
4490 @cindex frameless execution
4491 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4492 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
4493 @smallexample
4494 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4495 @end smallexample
4496 generates functions without a frame.)
4497 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4498 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4499 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4500 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4501 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4502 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4503 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4504
4505 @table @code
4506 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4507 @cindex current stack frame
4508 @item frame @var{args}
4509 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4510 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4511 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4512 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4513
4514 @kindex select-frame
4515 @cindex selecting frame silently
4516 @item select-frame
4517 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4518 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4519 @code{frame}.
4520 @end table
4521
4522 @node Backtrace
4523 @section Backtraces
4524
4525 @cindex traceback
4526 @cindex call stack traces
4527 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4528 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4529 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4530 stack.
4531
4532 @table @code
4533 @kindex backtrace
4534 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4535 @item backtrace
4536 @itemx bt
4537 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4538 frames in the stack.
4539
4540 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4541 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4542
4543 @item backtrace @var{n}
4544 @itemx bt @var{n}
4545 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4546
4547 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4548 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4549 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4550
4551 @item backtrace full
4552 @itemx bt full
4553 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4554 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4555 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4556 number of frames to print, as described above.
4557 @end table
4558
4559 @kindex where
4560 @kindex info stack
4561 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4562 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4563
4564 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4565 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4566 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4567 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4568 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4569 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4570 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4571 multi-threaded program.
4572
4573 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4574 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4575 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4576 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4577 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4578 line number.
4579
4580 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4581 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4582
4583 @smallexample
4584 @group
4585 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4586 at builtin.c:993
4587 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4588 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4589 at macro.c:71
4590 (More stack frames follow...)
4591 @end group
4592 @end smallexample
4593
4594 @noindent
4595 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4596 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4597 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4598
4599 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4600 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4601 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4602 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4603 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4604 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4605 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4606 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4607 such a backtrace might look like:
4608
4609 @smallexample
4610 @group
4611 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4612 at builtin.c:993
4613 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4614 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4615 at macro.c:71
4616 (More stack frames follow...)
4617 @end group
4618 @end smallexample
4619
4620 @noindent
4621 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4622 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4623
4624 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4625 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4626 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4627
4628 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4629 @cindex program entry point
4630 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4631 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4632 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4633 @code{main}@footnote{
4634 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4635 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4636 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4637 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4638 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4639 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4640
4641 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4642 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4643
4644 @table @code
4645 @item set backtrace past-main
4646 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4647 @kindex set backtrace
4648 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4649
4650 @item set backtrace past-main off
4651 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4652 default.
4653
4654 @item show backtrace past-main
4655 @kindex show backtrace
4656 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4657
4658 @item set backtrace past-entry
4659 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4660 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4661 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4662 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4663
4664 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4665 Backtraces will stop when they encouter the internal entry point of an
4666 application. This is the default.
4667
4668 @item show backtrace past-entry
4669 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4670
4671 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4672 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4673 @cindex backtrace limit
4674 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4675 unlimited.
4676
4677 @item show backtrace limit
4678 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4679 @end table
4680
4681 @node Selection
4682 @section Selecting a frame
4683
4684 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4685 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4686 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4687 of the stack frame just selected.
4688
4689 @table @code
4690 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4691 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4692 @item frame @var{n}
4693 @itemx f @var{n}
4694 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4695 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4696 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4697 @code{main}.
4698
4699 @item frame @var{addr}
4700 @itemx f @var{addr}
4701 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4702 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4703 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4704 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4705 switches between them.
4706
4707 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4708 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4709
4710 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4711 pointer and a program counter.
4712
4713 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4714 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4715
4716 @kindex up
4717 @item up @var{n}
4718 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4719 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4720 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4721
4722 @kindex down
4723 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4724 @item down @var{n}
4725 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4726 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4727 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4728 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4729 @end table
4730
4731 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4732 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4733 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4734 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4735
4736 @need 1000
4737 For example:
4738
4739 @smallexample
4740 @group
4741 (@value{GDBP}) up
4742 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4743 at env.c:10
4744 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4745 @end group
4746 @end smallexample
4747
4748 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4749 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4750 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4751 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4752 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4753 for details.
4754
4755 @table @code
4756 @kindex down-silently
4757 @kindex up-silently
4758 @item up-silently @var{n}
4759 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4760 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4761 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4762 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4763 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4764 distracting.
4765 @end table
4766
4767 @node Frame Info
4768 @section Information about a frame
4769
4770 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4771 stack frame.
4772
4773 @table @code
4774 @item frame
4775 @itemx f
4776 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4777 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4778 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4779 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4780 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4781
4782 @kindex info frame
4783 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4784 @item info frame
4785 @itemx info f
4786 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4787 including:
4788
4789 @itemize @bullet
4790 @item
4791 the address of the frame
4792 @item
4793 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4794 @item
4795 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4796 @item
4797 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4798 @item
4799 the address of the frame's arguments
4800 @item
4801 the address of the frame's local variables
4802 @item
4803 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4804 @item
4805 which registers were saved in the frame
4806 @end itemize
4807
4808 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4809 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4810 the usual conventions.
4811
4812 @item info frame @var{addr}
4813 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4814 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4815 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4816 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4817 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4818 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4819
4820 @kindex info args
4821 @item info args
4822 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4823
4824 @item info locals
4825 @kindex info locals
4826 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4827 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4828 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4829
4830 @kindex info catch
4831 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4832 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4833 @item info catch
4834 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4835 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4836 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4837 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4838 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4839
4840 @end table
4841
4842
4843 @node Source
4844 @chapter Examining Source Files
4845
4846 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4847 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4848 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4849 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4850 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4851 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4852 source files by explicit command.
4853
4854 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4855 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4856 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4857
4858 @menu
4859 * List:: Printing source lines
4860 * Edit:: Editing source files
4861 * Search:: Searching source files
4862 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4863 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4864 @end menu
4865
4866 @node List
4867 @section Printing source lines
4868
4869 @kindex list
4870 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4871 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4872 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4873 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4874
4875 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4876
4877 @table @code
4878 @item list @var{linenum}
4879 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4880 current source file.
4881
4882 @item list @var{function}
4883 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4884 @var{function}.
4885
4886 @item list
4887 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4888 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4889 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4890 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4891 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4892
4893 @item list -
4894 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4895 @end table
4896
4897 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4898 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4899 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4900
4901 @table @code
4902 @kindex set listsize
4903 @item set listsize @var{count}
4904 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4905 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4906
4907 @kindex show listsize
4908 @item show listsize
4909 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4910 @end table
4911
4912 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4913 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4914 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4915 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4916 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4917
4918 @cindex linespec
4919 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4920 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4921 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4922 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4923
4924 @table @code
4925 @item list @var{linespec}
4926 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4927
4928 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4929 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4930 linespecs.
4931
4932 @item list ,@var{last}
4933 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4934
4935 @item list @var{first},
4936 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4937
4938 @item list +
4939 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4940
4941 @item list -
4942 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4943
4944 @item list
4945 As described in the preceding table.
4946 @end table
4947
4948 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4949 kinds of linespec.
4950
4951 @table @code
4952 @item @var{number}
4953 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4954 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4955 the same source file as the first linespec.
4956
4957 @item +@var{offset}
4958 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4959 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4960 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4961 first linespec.
4962
4963 @item -@var{offset}
4964 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4965
4966 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4967 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4968
4969 @item @var{function}
4970 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4971 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4972
4973 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4974 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4975 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4976 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4977 identically named functions in different source files.
4978
4979 @item *@var{address}
4980 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4981 @var{address} may be any expression.
4982 @end table
4983
4984 @node Edit
4985 @section Editing source files
4986 @cindex editing source files
4987
4988 @kindex edit
4989 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4990 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4991 The editing program of your choice
4992 is invoked with the current line set to
4993 the active line in the program.
4994 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4995 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4996
4997 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4998
4999 @table @code
5000 @item edit
5001 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
5002
5003 @item edit @var{number}
5004 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5005
5006 @item edit @var{function}
5007 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5008
5009 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
5010 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
5011
5012 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
5013 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
5014 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
5015 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
5016 identically named functions in different source files.
5017
5018 @item edit *@var{address}
5019 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
5020 @var{address} may be any expression.
5021 @end table
5022
5023 @subsection Choosing your editor
5024 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5025 @footnote{
5026 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5027 following command-line syntax:
5028 @smallexample
5029 ex +@var{number} file
5030 @end smallexample
5031 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5032 the file where to start editing.}.
5033 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5034 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5035 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5036 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5037 @smallexample
5038 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5039 export EDITOR
5040 gdb @dots{}
5041 @end smallexample
5042 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5043 @smallexample
5044 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5045 gdb @dots{}
5046 @end smallexample
5047
5048 @node Search
5049 @section Searching source files
5050 @cindex searching source files
5051
5052 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5053 regular expression.
5054
5055 @table @code
5056 @kindex search
5057 @kindex forward-search
5058 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5059 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5060 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5061 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5062 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5063 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5064 @code{fo}.
5065
5066 @kindex reverse-search
5067 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5068 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5069 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5070 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5071 this command as @code{rev}.
5072 @end table
5073
5074 @node Source Path
5075 @section Specifying source directories
5076
5077 @cindex source path
5078 @cindex directories for source files
5079 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5080 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5081 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5082 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5083 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5084 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5085 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5086
5087 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5088 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5089 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5090 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5091 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5092 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5093 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5094 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5095 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5096 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5097 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5098
5099 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5100 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5101 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5102 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5103 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5104 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5105
5106 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5107 source files.
5108
5109 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5110 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5111 each line is in the file.
5112
5113 @kindex directory
5114 @kindex dir
5115 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5116 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5117 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5118
5119 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5120 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5121
5122 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5123 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5124 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5125 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5126 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5127 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5128 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5129 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5130 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5131 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5132 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5133 name to look up the sources.
5134
5135 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5136 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5137 GDB to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5138 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5139 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5140 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5141 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5142 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5143
5144 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5145 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5146 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5147 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5148 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5149 is applied only at the begining of the directory name, this rule will
5150 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5151
5152 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5153 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5154 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5155 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5156 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5157 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5158 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5159 command.
5160
5161 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5162 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5163 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5164 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5165 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5166 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5167 method available to point GDB at the new location.
5168
5169 @table @code
5170 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5171 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5172 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5173 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5174 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5175 part of absolute file names) or
5176 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5177 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5178
5179 @kindex cdir
5180 @kindex cwd
5181 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5182 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
5183 @cindex compilation directory
5184 @cindex current directory
5185 @cindex working directory
5186 @cindex directory, current
5187 @cindex directory, compilation
5188 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5189 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5190 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5191 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5192 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5193 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5194
5195 @item directory
5196 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5197
5198 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5199 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5200
5201 @item show directories
5202 @kindex show directories
5203 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5204
5205 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5206 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5207 @kindex set substitute-path
5208 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5209 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5210 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5211
5212 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5213 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5214
5215 @smallexample
5216 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5217 @end smallexample
5218
5219 @noindent
5220 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5221 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5222 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5223
5224 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5225 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5226 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5227 the substitution.
5228
5229 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5230
5231 @smallexample
5232 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5233 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5234 @end smallexample
5235
5236 @noindent
5237 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5238 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5239 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5240 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5241
5242
5243 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5244 @kindex unset substitute-path
5245 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5246 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5247 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5248
5249 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5250
5251 @item show substitute-path [path]
5252 @kindex show substitute-path
5253 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5254 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5255
5256 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5257 rules.
5258
5259 @end table
5260
5261 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5262 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5263 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5264
5265 @enumerate
5266 @item
5267 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5268
5269 @item
5270 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5271 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5272 directories in one command.
5273 @end enumerate
5274
5275 @node Machine Code
5276 @section Source and machine code
5277 @cindex source line and its code address
5278
5279 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5280 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5281 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5282 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5283 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5284 well as hex.
5285
5286 @table @code
5287 @kindex info line
5288 @item info line @var{linespec}
5289 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5290 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5291 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5292 source lines}).
5293 @end table
5294
5295 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5296 the object code for the first line of function
5297 @code{m4_changequote}:
5298
5299 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5300 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5301 @smallexample
5302 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5303 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5304 @end smallexample
5305
5306 @noindent
5307 @cindex code address and its source line
5308 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5309 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5310 @smallexample
5311 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5312 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5313 @end smallexample
5314
5315 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5316 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5317 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5318 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5319 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5320 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5321 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5322 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5323 variables}).
5324
5325 @table @code
5326 @kindex disassemble
5327 @cindex assembly instructions
5328 @cindex instructions, assembly
5329 @cindex machine instructions
5330 @cindex listing machine instructions
5331 @item disassemble
5332 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5333 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5334 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5335 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5336 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5337 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5338 @end table
5339
5340 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5341 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5342
5343 @smallexample
5344 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5345 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5346 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5347 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5348 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5349 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5350 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5351 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5352 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5353 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5354 End of assembler dump.
5355 @end smallexample
5356
5357 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5358 mnemonics or other syntax.
5359
5360 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5361 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5362 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5363 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5364 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5365
5366 @table @code
5367 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5368 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5369 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5370 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5371 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5372 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5373
5374 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5375 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5376 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5377 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5378
5379 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5380 @item show disassembly-flavor
5381 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5382 @end table
5383
5384
5385 @node Data
5386 @chapter Examining Data
5387
5388 @cindex printing data
5389 @cindex examining data
5390 @kindex print
5391 @kindex inspect
5392 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5393 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5394 @c different window or something like that.
5395 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5396 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5397 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5398 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5399 Different Languages}).
5400
5401 @table @code
5402 @item print @var{expr}
5403 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5404 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5405 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5406 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5407 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5408 formats}.
5409
5410 @item print
5411 @itemx print /@var{f}
5412 @cindex reprint the last value
5413 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5414 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
5415 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5416 @end table
5417
5418 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5419 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5420 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5421
5422 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5423 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5424 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5425 Table}.
5426
5427 @menu
5428 * Expressions:: Expressions
5429 * Variables:: Program variables
5430 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5431 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5432 * Memory:: Examining memory
5433 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5434 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5435 * Value History:: Value history
5436 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5437 * Registers:: Registers
5438 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5439 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5440 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5441 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5442 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5443 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5444 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5445 character set than GDB does
5446 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5447 @end menu
5448
5449 @node Expressions
5450 @section Expressions
5451
5452 @cindex expressions
5453 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5454 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5455 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5456 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5457 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5458 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5459 @ref{Compilation}.
5460
5461 @cindex arrays in expressions
5462 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5463 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5464 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5465 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5466
5467 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5468 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5469 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5470 languages.
5471
5472 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5473 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5474
5475 @cindex casts, in expressions
5476 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5477 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5478 at that address in memory.
5479 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5480
5481 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5482 to programming languages:
5483
5484 @table @code
5485 @item @@
5486 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5487 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
5488
5489 @item ::
5490 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5491 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
5492
5493 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5494 @cindex type casting memory
5495 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5496 @cindex casts, to view memory
5497 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5498 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5499 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5500 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5501 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5502 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5503 @end table
5504
5505 @node Variables
5506 @section Program variables
5507
5508 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5509 in your program.
5510
5511 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5512 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
5513
5514 @itemize @bullet
5515 @item
5516 global (or file-static)
5517 @end itemize
5518
5519 @noindent or
5520
5521 @itemize @bullet
5522 @item
5523 visible according to the scope rules of the
5524 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5525 @end itemize
5526
5527 @noindent This means that in the function
5528
5529 @smallexample
5530 foo (a)
5531 int a;
5532 @{
5533 bar (a);
5534 @{
5535 int b = test ();
5536 bar (b);
5537 @}
5538 @}
5539 @end smallexample
5540
5541 @noindent
5542 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5543 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5544 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5545 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5546
5547 @cindex variable name conflict
5548 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5549 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5550 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5551 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5552 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5553 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5554 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5555
5556 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5557 @iftex
5558 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5559 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5560 @end iftex
5561 @smallexample
5562 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5563 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5564 @end smallexample
5565
5566 @noindent
5567 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5568 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5569 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5570 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5571
5572 @smallexample
5573 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5574 @end smallexample
5575
5576 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5577 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5578 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5579 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5580 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5581 @c conflict?? --mew
5582
5583 @cindex wrong values
5584 @cindex variable values, wrong
5585 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5586 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5587 @quotation
5588 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5589 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5590 scope, and just before exit.
5591 @end quotation
5592 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5593 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5594 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5595 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5596 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5597 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5598 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5599 variable definitions may be gone.
5600
5601 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5602 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5603 when compiling.
5604
5605 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5606 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5607 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5608 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5609 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5610 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5611 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5612
5613 @smallexample
5614 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5615 @end smallexample
5616
5617 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5618 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5619 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5620 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5621 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5622 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5623 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5624 for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
5625 @xref{C, , Debugging C++}, for more info about debug info formats
5626 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5627
5628 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5629 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5630 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5631 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5632
5633 @node Arrays
5634 @section Artificial arrays
5635
5636 @cindex artificial array
5637 @cindex arrays
5638 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5639 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5640 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5641 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5642 program.
5643
5644 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5645 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5646 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5647 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5648 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5649 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5650 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5651 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5652 example. If a program says
5653
5654 @smallexample
5655 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5656 @end smallexample
5657
5658 @noindent
5659 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5660
5661 @smallexample
5662 p *array@@len
5663 @end smallexample
5664
5665 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5666 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5667 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5668 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5669 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
5670
5671 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5672 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5673 The value need not be in memory:
5674 @smallexample
5675 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5676 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5677 @end smallexample
5678
5679 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5680 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5681 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5682 @smallexample
5683 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5684 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5685 @end smallexample
5686
5687 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5688 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5689 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5690 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5691 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5692 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5693 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5694 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5695 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5696 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5697
5698 @smallexample
5699 set $i = 0
5700 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5701 @key{RET}
5702 @key{RET}
5703 @dots{}
5704 @end smallexample
5705
5706 @node Output Formats
5707 @section Output formats
5708
5709 @cindex formatted output
5710 @cindex output formats
5711 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5712 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5713 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5714 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5715 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5716
5717 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5718 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5719 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5720 letters supported are:
5721
5722 @table @code
5723 @item x
5724 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5725 hexadecimal.
5726
5727 @item d
5728 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5729
5730 @item u
5731 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5732
5733 @item o
5734 Print as integer in octal.
5735
5736 @item t
5737 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5738 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5739 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5740 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
5741
5742 @item a
5743 @cindex unknown address, locating
5744 @cindex locate address
5745 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5746 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5747 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5748
5749 @smallexample
5750 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5751 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5752 @end smallexample
5753
5754 @noindent
5755 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5756 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5757
5758 @item c
5759 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5760 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5761 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5762 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5763
5764 @item f
5765 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5766 using typical floating point syntax.
5767 @end table
5768
5769 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5770
5771 @smallexample
5772 p/x $pc
5773 @end smallexample
5774
5775 @noindent
5776 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5777 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5778
5779 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5780 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5781 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5782
5783 @node Memory
5784 @section Examining memory
5785
5786 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5787 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5788
5789 @cindex examining memory
5790 @table @code
5791 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5792 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5793 @itemx x @var{addr}
5794 @itemx x
5795 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5796 @end table
5797
5798 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5799 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5800 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5801 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5802 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5803
5804 @table @r
5805 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5806 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5807 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5808 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5809 @c 4.1.2.
5810
5811 @item @var{f}, the display format
5812 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5813 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5814 @samp{f}), and in addition @samp{s} (for null-terminated strings) and
5815 @samp{i} (for machine instructions). The default is @samp{x}
5816 (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes each time you use either
5817 @code{x} or @code{print}.
5818
5819 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5820 The unit size is any of
5821
5822 @table @code
5823 @item b
5824 Bytes.
5825 @item h
5826 Halfwords (two bytes).
5827 @item w
5828 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5829 @item g
5830 Giant words (eight bytes).
5831 @end table
5832
5833 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5834 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5835 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5836
5837 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5838 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5839 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5840 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5841 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5842 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5843 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5844 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5845 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5846 a value from memory).
5847 @end table
5848
5849 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5850 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5851 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5852 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5853 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5854
5855 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5856 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5857 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5858 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5859 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5860
5861 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5862 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5863 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5864 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
5865 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
5866 Code,,Source and machine code}.
5867
5868 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5869 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5870 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5871 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5872 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5873 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5874 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5875
5876 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5877 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5878 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5879 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5880 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5881 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5882 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5883 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5884 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5885
5886 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5887 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5888 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5889
5890 @cindex remote memory comparison
5891 @cindex verify remote memory image
5892 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5893 (@pxref{Remote}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5894 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5895 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5896 situations.
5897
5898 @table @code
5899 @kindex compare-sections
5900 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5901 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5902 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5903 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5904 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5905 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5906 remote request.
5907 @end table
5908
5909 @node Auto Display
5910 @section Automatic display
5911 @cindex automatic display
5912 @cindex display of expressions
5913
5914 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5915 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5916 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5917 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5918 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5919 The automatic display looks like this:
5920
5921 @smallexample
5922 2: foo = 38
5923 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5924 @end smallexample
5925
5926 @noindent
5927 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5928 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5929 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5930 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5931 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5932 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5933 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5934
5935 @table @code
5936 @kindex display
5937 @item display @var{expr}
5938 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5939 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5940
5941 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5942
5943 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5944 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5945 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5946 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5947 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5948
5949 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5950 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5951 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5952 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5953 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5954 @end table
5955
5956 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5957 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5958 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5959
5960 @table @code
5961 @kindex delete display
5962 @kindex undisplay
5963 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5964 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5965 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5966
5967 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5968 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5969
5970 @kindex disable display
5971 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5972 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5973 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5974 enabled again later.
5975
5976 @kindex enable display
5977 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5978 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5979 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5980
5981 @item display
5982 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5983 done when your program stops.
5984
5985 @kindex info display
5986 @item info display
5987 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5988 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5989 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5990 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5991 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5992 @end table
5993
5994 @cindex display disabled out of scope
5995 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5996 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5997 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5998 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5999 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6000 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6001 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6002 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6003 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6004 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6005
6006 @node Print Settings
6007 @section Print settings
6008
6009 @cindex format options
6010 @cindex print settings
6011 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6012 and symbols are printed.
6013
6014 @noindent
6015 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6016
6017 @table @code
6018 @kindex set print
6019 @item set print address
6020 @itemx set print address on
6021 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6022 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6023 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6024 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6025 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6026 @code{set print address on}:
6027
6028 @smallexample
6029 @group
6030 (@value{GDBP}) f
6031 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6032 at input.c:530
6033 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6034 @end group
6035 @end smallexample
6036
6037 @item set print address off
6038 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6039 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6040
6041 @smallexample
6042 @group
6043 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6044 (@value{GDBP}) f
6045 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6046 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6047 @end group
6048 @end smallexample
6049
6050 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6051 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6052 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6053 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6054
6055 @kindex show print
6056 @item show print address
6057 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6058 @end table
6059
6060 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6061 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6062 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6063 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6064 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6065 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6066 it prints a symbolic address:
6067
6068 @table @code
6069 @item set print symbol-filename on
6070 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6071 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6072 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6073 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6074
6075 @item set print symbol-filename off
6076 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6077 default.
6078
6079 @item show print symbol-filename
6080 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6081 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6082 @end table
6083
6084 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6085 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6086 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6087
6088 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6089 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6090
6091 @table @code
6092 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6093 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6094 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6095 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6096 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6097 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6098
6099 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6100 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6101 symbolic address.
6102 @end table
6103
6104 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6105 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6106 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6107 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6108 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6109 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6110 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6111 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6112
6113 @smallexample
6114 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6115 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6116 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6117 @end smallexample
6118
6119 @quotation
6120 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6121 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6122 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6123 @end quotation
6124
6125 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6126
6127 @table @code
6128 @item set print array
6129 @itemx set print array on
6130 @cindex pretty print arrays
6131 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6132 but uses more space. The default is off.
6133
6134 @item set print array off
6135 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6136
6137 @item show print array
6138 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6139 arrays.
6140
6141 @cindex print array indexes
6142 @item set print array-indexes
6143 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6144 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6145 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6146 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6147
6148 @item set print array-indexes off
6149 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6150
6151 @item show print array-indexes
6152 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6153 arrays.
6154
6155 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6156 @cindex number of array elements to print
6157 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6158 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6159 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6160 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6161 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6162 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6163 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6164
6165 @item show print elements
6166 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6167 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6168
6169 @item set print repeats
6170 @cindex repeated array elements
6171 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6172 elelments. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6173 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6174 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6175 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6176 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6177 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6178
6179 @item show print repeats
6180 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6181 elements.
6182
6183 @item set print null-stop
6184 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6185 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6186 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6187 contain only short strings.
6188 The default is off.
6189
6190 @item show print null-stop
6191 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6192 @sc{null} character.
6193
6194 @item set print pretty on
6195 @cindex print structures in indented form
6196 @cindex indentation in structure display
6197 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6198 per line, like this:
6199
6200 @smallexample
6201 @group
6202 $1 = @{
6203 next = 0x0,
6204 flags = @{
6205 sweet = 1,
6206 sour = 1
6207 @},
6208 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6209 @}
6210 @end group
6211 @end smallexample
6212
6213 @item set print pretty off
6214 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6215
6216 @smallexample
6217 @group
6218 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6219 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6220 @end group
6221 @end smallexample
6222
6223 @noindent
6224 This is the default format.
6225
6226 @item show print pretty
6227 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6228
6229 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6230 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6231 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6232 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6233 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6234 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6235 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6236 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6237
6238 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6239 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6240 international character sets, and is the default.
6241
6242 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6243 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6244
6245 @item set print union on
6246 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6247 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6248 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6249
6250 @item set print union off
6251 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6252 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6253 instead.
6254
6255 @item show print union
6256 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6257 structures and other unions.
6258
6259 For example, given the declarations
6260
6261 @smallexample
6262 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6263 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6264 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6265 Bug_forms;
6266
6267 struct thing @{
6268 Species it;
6269 union @{
6270 Tree_forms tree;
6271 Bug_forms bug;
6272 @} form;
6273 @};
6274
6275 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6276 @end smallexample
6277
6278 @noindent
6279 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6280
6281 @smallexample
6282 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6283 @end smallexample
6284
6285 @noindent
6286 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6287
6288 @smallexample
6289 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6290 @end smallexample
6291
6292 @noindent
6293 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6294 and in Pascal.
6295 @end table
6296
6297 @need 1000
6298 @noindent
6299 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6300
6301 @table @code
6302 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6303 @item set print demangle
6304 @itemx set print demangle on
6305 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6306 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6307 linkage. The default is on.
6308
6309 @item show print demangle
6310 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6311
6312 @item set print asm-demangle
6313 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6314 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6315 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6316 The default is off.
6317
6318 @item show print asm-demangle
6319 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6320 or demangled form.
6321
6322 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6323 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6324 @kindex set demangle-style
6325 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6326 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6327 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6328
6329 @table @code
6330 @item auto
6331 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6332
6333 @item gnu
6334 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6335 This is the default.
6336
6337 @item hp
6338 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6339
6340 @item lucid
6341 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6342
6343 @item arm
6344 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6345 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6346 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6347 require further enhancement to permit that.
6348
6349 @end table
6350 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6351
6352 @item show demangle-style
6353 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6354
6355 @item set print object
6356 @itemx set print object on
6357 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6358 @cindex display derived types
6359 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6360 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6361 the virtual function table.
6362
6363 @item set print object off
6364 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6365 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6366
6367 @item show print object
6368 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6369
6370 @item set print static-members
6371 @itemx set print static-members on
6372 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6373 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6374
6375 @item set print static-members off
6376 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6377
6378 @item show print static-members
6379 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6380
6381 @item set print pascal_static-members
6382 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6383 @cindex static members of Pacal objects
6384 @cindex Pacal objects, static members display
6385 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6386
6387 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6388 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6389
6390 @item show print pascal_static-members
6391 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6392
6393 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6394 @item set print vtbl
6395 @itemx set print vtbl on
6396 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6397 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6398 @cindex VTBL display
6399 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6400 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6401 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6402
6403 @item set print vtbl off
6404 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6405
6406 @item show print vtbl
6407 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6408 @end table
6409
6410 @node Value History
6411 @section Value history
6412
6413 @cindex value history
6414 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6415 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6416 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6417 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6418 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6419 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6420 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6421 symbol table.
6422
6423 @cindex @code{$}
6424 @cindex @code{$$}
6425 @cindex history number
6426 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6427 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6428 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6429 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6430 history number.
6431
6432 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6433 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6434 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6435 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6436 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6437 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6438 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6439
6440 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6441 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6442
6443 @smallexample
6444 p *$
6445 @end smallexample
6446
6447 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6448 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6449
6450 @smallexample
6451 p *$.next
6452 @end smallexample
6453
6454 @noindent
6455 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6456 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6457
6458 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6459 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6460
6461 @smallexample
6462 print x
6463 set x=5
6464 @end smallexample
6465
6466 @noindent
6467 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6468 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6469
6470 @table @code
6471 @kindex show values
6472 @item show values
6473 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6474 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6475 values} does not change the history.
6476
6477 @item show values @var{n}
6478 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6479
6480 @item show values +
6481 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6482 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6483 @end table
6484
6485 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6486 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6487
6488 @node Convenience Vars
6489 @section Convenience variables
6490
6491 @cindex convenience variables
6492 @cindex user-defined variables
6493 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6494 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6495 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6496 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6497 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6498
6499 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6500 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6501 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6502 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6503 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
6504
6505 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6506 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6507 For example:
6508
6509 @smallexample
6510 set $foo = *object_ptr
6511 @end smallexample
6512
6513 @noindent
6514 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6515 @code{object_ptr}.
6516
6517 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6518 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6519 value with another assignment at any time.
6520
6521 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6522 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6523 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6524 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6525
6526 @table @code
6527 @kindex show convenience
6528 @cindex show all user variables
6529 @item show convenience
6530 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6531 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6532
6533 @kindex init-if-undefined
6534 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6535 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6536 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6537 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6538 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6539 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6540 override default values used in a command script.
6541
6542 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6543 any side-effects do not occur.
6544 @end table
6545
6546 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6547 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6548 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6549
6550 @smallexample
6551 set $i = 0
6552 print bar[$i++]->contents
6553 @end smallexample
6554
6555 @noindent
6556 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6557
6558 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6559 values likely to be useful.
6560
6561 @table @code
6562 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6563 @item $_
6564 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6565 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
6566 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6567 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6568 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6569 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6570 to the type of @code{$__}.
6571
6572 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6573 @item $__
6574 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6575 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6576 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6577
6578 @item $_exitcode
6579 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6580 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6581 the program being debugged terminates.
6582 @end table
6583
6584 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6585 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6586 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6587
6588 @node Registers
6589 @section Registers
6590
6591 @cindex registers
6592 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6593 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6594 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6595 your machine.
6596
6597 @table @code
6598 @kindex info registers
6599 @item info registers
6600 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6601 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6602
6603 @kindex info all-registers
6604 @cindex floating point registers
6605 @item info all-registers
6606 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6607 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6608
6609 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6610 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6611 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6612 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6613 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6614 @end table
6615
6616 @cindex stack pointer register
6617 @cindex program counter register
6618 @cindex process status register
6619 @cindex frame pointer register
6620 @cindex standard registers
6621 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6622 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6623 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6624 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6625 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6626 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6627 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6628 you could print the program counter in hex with
6629
6630 @smallexample
6631 p/x $pc
6632 @end smallexample
6633
6634 @noindent
6635 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6636
6637 @smallexample
6638 x/i $pc
6639 @end smallexample
6640
6641 @noindent
6642 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6643 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6644 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6645 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6646 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6647 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6648 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
6649
6650 @smallexample
6651 set $sp += 4
6652 @end smallexample
6653
6654 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6655 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6656 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6657 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6658 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6659 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6660 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6661
6662 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6663 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6664 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6665 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6666 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6667 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6668 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6669
6670 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6671 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6672 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6673 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6674 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6675 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6676 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6677 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6678 prints the data in both formats.
6679
6680 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6681 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6682 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6683 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6684 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6685 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6686 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6687
6688 @smallexample
6689 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6690 $1 = @{
6691 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6692 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6693 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6694 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6695 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6696 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6697 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6698 @}
6699 @end smallexample
6700
6701 @noindent
6702 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6703 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6704 value to a @code{struct} member:
6705
6706 @smallexample
6707 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6708 @end smallexample
6709
6710 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6711 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
6712 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6713 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6714 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6715 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6716
6717 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6718 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6719 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6720 frame makes no difference.
6721
6722 @node Floating Point Hardware
6723 @section Floating point hardware
6724 @cindex floating point
6725
6726 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6727 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6728
6729 @table @code
6730 @kindex info float
6731 @item info float
6732 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6733 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6734 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6735 the ARM and x86 machines.
6736 @end table
6737
6738 @node Vector Unit
6739 @section Vector Unit
6740 @cindex vector unit
6741
6742 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6743 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6744
6745 @table @code
6746 @kindex info vector
6747 @item info vector
6748 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6749 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6750 @end table
6751
6752 @node OS Information
6753 @section Operating system auxiliary information
6754 @cindex OS information
6755
6756 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6757 you debug your program.
6758
6759 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6760 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6761 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6762 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6763 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6764 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6765 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6766 structure.
6767
6768 @table @code
6769 @item info udot
6770 @kindex info udot
6771 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6772 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6773 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6774 the @code{examine} command.
6775 @end table
6776
6777 @cindex auxiliary vector
6778 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6779 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6780 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6781 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6782 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6783 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6784 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6785 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6786 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6787 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6788 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6789 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6790
6791 @table @code
6792 @kindex info auxv
6793 @item info auxv
6794 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6795 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6796 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6797 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6798 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6799 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6800 an unrecognized tag.
6801 @end table
6802
6803
6804 @node Memory Region Attributes
6805 @section Memory region attributes
6806 @cindex memory region attributes
6807
6808 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6809 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6810 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6811 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6812 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6813 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6814 user can override the fetched regions.
6815
6816 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6817 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6818 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6819 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6820 all memory.
6821
6822 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6823 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6824
6825 @table @code
6826 @kindex mem
6827 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6828 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6829 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6830 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6831 case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
6832 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6833
6834 @item mem auto
6835 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
6836 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
6837
6838 @kindex delete mem
6839 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6840 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6841 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6842
6843 @kindex disable mem
6844 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6845 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6846 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6847 It may be enabled again later.
6848
6849 @kindex enable mem
6850 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6851 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6852
6853 @kindex info mem
6854 @item info mem
6855 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6856 for each region:
6857
6858 @table @emph
6859 @item Memory Region Number
6860 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6861 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6862 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6863
6864 @item Lo Address
6865 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6866
6867 @item Hi Address
6868 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6869
6870 @item Attributes
6871 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6872 @end table
6873 @end table
6874
6875
6876 @subsection Attributes
6877
6878 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6879 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6880 write accesses to a memory region.
6881
6882 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6883 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6884 etc.@: from accessing memory.
6885
6886 @table @code
6887 @item ro
6888 Memory is read only.
6889 @item wo
6890 Memory is write only.
6891 @item rw
6892 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6893 @end table
6894
6895 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
6896 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6897 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6898 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6899 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6900
6901 @table @code
6902 @item 8
6903 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6904 @item 16
6905 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6906 @item 32
6907 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6908 @item 64
6909 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6910 @end table
6911
6912 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6913 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6914 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6915 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6916 @c
6917 @c @table @code
6918 @c @item hwbreak
6919 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
6920 @c @item swbreak (default)
6921 @c @end table
6922
6923 @subsubsection Data Cache
6924 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6925 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6926 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6927 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6928 registers.
6929
6930 @table @code
6931 @item cache
6932 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6933 @item nocache
6934 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
6935 @end table
6936
6937 @subsection Memory Access Checking
6938 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
6939 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
6940 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
6941 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
6942
6943 @table @code
6944 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
6945 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
6946 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
6947 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
6948 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
6949 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
6950 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
6951 The default value is @code{off}.
6952 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
6953 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
6954 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
6955 @end table
6956
6957
6958 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
6959 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6960 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6961 @c
6962 @c @table @code
6963 @c @item verify
6964 @c @item noverify (default)
6965 @c @end table
6966
6967 @node Dump/Restore Files
6968 @section Copy between memory and a file
6969 @cindex dump/restore files
6970 @cindex append data to a file
6971 @cindex dump data to a file
6972 @cindex restore data from a file
6973
6974 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6975 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6976 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6977 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6978 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6979 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6980 files.
6981
6982 @table @code
6983
6984 @kindex dump
6985 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6986 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6987 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6988 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
6989
6990 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
6991 @table @code
6992 @item binary
6993 Raw binary form.
6994 @item ihex
6995 Intel hex format.
6996 @item srec
6997 Motorola S-record format.
6998 @item tekhex
6999 Tektronix Hex format.
7000 @end table
7001
7002 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7003 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7004 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7005 form.
7006
7007 @kindex append
7008 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7009 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7010 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7011 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7012 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7013
7014 @kindex restore
7015 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7016 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7017 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7018 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7019 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7020
7021 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7022 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7023 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7024 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7025 from that location.
7026
7027 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7028 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7029 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7030 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7031
7032 @end table
7033
7034 @node Core File Generation
7035 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7036 @cindex dump core from inferior
7037
7038 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7039 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7040 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7041 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7042 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7043 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7044 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7045
7046 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7047 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7048 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7049
7050 @table @code
7051 @kindex gcore
7052 @kindex generate-core-file
7053 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7054 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7055 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7056 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7057 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7058 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7059
7060 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7061 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7062 @end table
7063
7064 @node Character Sets
7065 @section Character Sets
7066 @cindex character sets
7067 @cindex charset
7068 @cindex translating between character sets
7069 @cindex host character set
7070 @cindex target character set
7071
7072 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7073 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7074 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7075 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7076 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7077 @dfn{target character set}.
7078
7079 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7080 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7081 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7082 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7083 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7084 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7085 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7086 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7087 character and string literals in expressions.
7088
7089 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7090 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7091 target-charset} command, described below.
7092
7093 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7094 support:
7095
7096 @table @code
7097 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7098 @kindex set target-charset
7099 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7100 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7101 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7102 list the target character sets it supports.
7103 @end table
7104
7105 @table @code
7106 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7107 @kindex set host-charset
7108 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7109
7110 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7111 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7112 @code{set host-charset} command.
7113
7114 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7115 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7116 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7117 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7118 list the host character sets it supports.
7119
7120 @item set charset @var{charset}
7121 @kindex set charset
7122 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7123 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7124 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7125 for both host and target.
7126
7127
7128 @item show charset
7129 @kindex show charset
7130 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7131
7132 @itemx show host-charset
7133 @kindex show host-charset
7134 Show the name of the current host charset.
7135
7136 @itemx show target-charset
7137 @kindex show target-charset
7138 Show the name of the current target charset.
7139
7140 @end table
7141
7142 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7143 sets:
7144
7145 @table @code
7146
7147 @item ASCII
7148 @cindex ASCII character set
7149 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7150 character set.
7151
7152 @item ISO-8859-1
7153 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7154 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7155 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7156 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7157 this as its host character set.
7158
7159 @item EBCDIC-US
7160 @itemx IBM1047
7161 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7162 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7163 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7164 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7165 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7166
7167 @end table
7168
7169 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7170 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7171 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7172
7173 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7174 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7175 @file{charset-test.c}:
7176
7177 @smallexample
7178 #include <stdio.h>
7179
7180 char ascii_hello[]
7181 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7182 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7183 char ibm1047_hello[]
7184 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7185 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7186
7187 main ()
7188 @{
7189 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7190 @}
7191 @end smallexample
7192
7193 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7194 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7195 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7196
7197 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7198
7199 @smallexample
7200 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7201 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7202 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7203 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7204 @dots{}
7205 (@value{GDBP})
7206 @end smallexample
7207
7208 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7209 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7210 strings:
7211
7212 @smallexample
7213 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7214 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7215 (@value{GDBP})
7216 @end smallexample
7217
7218 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7219 initial character set:
7220 @smallexample
7221 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7222 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7223 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7224 (@value{GDBP})
7225 @end smallexample
7226
7227 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7228 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7229 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7230 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7231 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7232
7233 @smallexample
7234 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7235 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7236 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7237 $2 = 72 'H'
7238 (@value{GDBP})
7239 @end smallexample
7240
7241 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7242 literals you use in expressions:
7243
7244 @smallexample
7245 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7246 $3 = 43 '+'
7247 (@value{GDBP})
7248 @end smallexample
7249
7250 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7251 character.
7252
7253 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7254 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7255 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7256
7257 @smallexample
7258 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7259 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7260 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7261 $5 = 200 '\310'
7262 (@value{GDBP})
7263 @end smallexample
7264
7265 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7266 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7267
7268 @smallexample
7269 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7270 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7271 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7272 @end smallexample
7273
7274 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7275 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7276 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7277 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7278 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7279
7280 @smallexample
7281 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7282 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7283 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7284 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7285 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7286 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7287 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7288 $7 = 72 '\110'
7289 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7290 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7291 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7292 $9 = 200 'H'
7293 (@value{GDBP})
7294 @end smallexample
7295
7296 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7297 string literals you use in expressions:
7298
7299 @smallexample
7300 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7301 $10 = 78 '+'
7302 (@value{GDBP})
7303 @end smallexample
7304
7305 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7306 character.
7307
7308 @node Caching Remote Data
7309 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7310 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7311
7312 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7313 remote target (@pxref{Remote}). Such caching generally improves
7314 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7315 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7316 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7317 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7318 volatile registers are in use.
7319
7320 @table @code
7321 @kindex set remotecache
7322 @item set remotecache on
7323 @itemx set remotecache off
7324 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7325 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7326
7327 @kindex show remotecache
7328 @item show remotecache
7329 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7330
7331 @kindex info dcache
7332 @item info dcache
7333 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7334 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7335 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7336 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7337 the data cache operation.
7338 @end table
7339
7340
7341 @node Macros
7342 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7343
7344 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7345 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7346 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7347 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7348 where it was defined.
7349
7350 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7351 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7352 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7353 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7354
7355 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7356 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7357 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7358 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7359 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7360 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7361 see @ref{List}.
7362
7363 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7364 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7365 variable-arity macros.
7366
7367 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7368 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7369 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7370
7371 @table @code
7372
7373 @kindex macro expand
7374 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7375 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7376 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7377 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7378 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7379 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7380 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7381 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7382 it can be any string of tokens.
7383
7384 @kindex macro exp1
7385 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7386 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7387 @cindex expand macro once
7388 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7389 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7390 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7391 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7392 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7393 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7394 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7395 can be any string of tokens.
7396
7397 @kindex info macro
7398 @cindex macro definition, showing
7399 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7400 @item info macro @var{macro}
7401 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7402 source location where that definition was established.
7403
7404 @kindex macro define
7405 @cindex user-defined macros
7406 @cindex defining macros interactively
7407 @cindex macros, user-defined
7408 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7409 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7410 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7411 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7412 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7413 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7414 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7415 given in @var{arglist}.
7416
7417 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7418 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7419 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7420 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7421 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7422
7423 @kindex macro undef
7424 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7425 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7426 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7427 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7428 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7429 debugged.
7430
7431 @kindex macro list
7432 @item macro list
7433 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7434 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7435 @end table
7436
7437 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7438 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7439 show our source files:
7440
7441 @smallexample
7442 $ cat sample.c
7443 #include <stdio.h>
7444 #include "sample.h"
7445
7446 #define M 42
7447 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7448
7449 main ()
7450 @{
7451 #define N 28
7452 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7453 #undef N
7454 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7455 #define N 1729
7456 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7457 @}
7458 $ cat sample.h
7459 #define Q <
7460 $
7461 @end smallexample
7462
7463 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7464 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7465 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7466 information.
7467
7468 @smallexample
7469 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7470 $
7471 @end smallexample
7472
7473 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7474
7475 @smallexample
7476 $ gdb -nw sample
7477 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7478 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7479 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7480 (@value{GDBP})
7481 @end smallexample
7482
7483 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7484 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7485 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7486
7487 @smallexample
7488 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7489 3
7490 4 #define M 42
7491 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7492 6
7493 7 main ()
7494 8 @{
7495 9 #define N 28
7496 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7497 11 #undef N
7498 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7499 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7500 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7501 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7502 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7503 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7504 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7505 #define Q <
7506 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7507 expands to: (42 + 1)
7508 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7509 expands to: once (M + 1)
7510 (@value{GDBP})
7511 @end smallexample
7512
7513 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7514 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7515 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7516 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7517
7518 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
7519 the source line of the current stack frame:
7520
7521 @smallexample
7522 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7523 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7524 (@value{GDBP}) run
7525 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7526
7527 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7528 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7529 (@value{GDBP})
7530 @end smallexample
7531
7532 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7533
7534 @smallexample
7535 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7536 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7537 #define N 28
7538 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7539 expands to: 28 < 42
7540 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7541 $1 = 1
7542 (@value{GDBP})
7543 @end smallexample
7544
7545 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7546 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7547 thereof) in force at each point:
7548
7549 @smallexample
7550 (@value{GDBP}) next
7551 Hello, world!
7552 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7553 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7554 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7555 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7556 (@value{GDBP}) next
7557 We're so creative.
7558 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7559 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7560 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7561 #define N 1729
7562 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7563 expands to: 1729 < 42
7564 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7565 $2 = 0
7566 (@value{GDBP})
7567 @end smallexample
7568
7569
7570 @node Tracepoints
7571 @chapter Tracepoints
7572 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7573 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7574
7575 @cindex tracepoints
7576 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7577 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7578 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7579 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7580 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7581 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7582 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7583
7584 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7585 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7586 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7587 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7588 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7589 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7590 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7591 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7592 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7593 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7594 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7595
7596 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7597 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7598 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7599 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7600 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7601 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7602 Packets}.
7603
7604 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7605
7606 @menu
7607 * Set Tracepoints::
7608 * Analyze Collected Data::
7609 * Tracepoint Variables::
7610 @end menu
7611
7612 @node Set Tracepoints
7613 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7614
7615 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7616 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7617 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7618 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7619 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7620 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7621 work on.
7622
7623 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7624 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7625 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7626 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7627 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7628 tracepoint was hit.
7629
7630 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7631 conditions and actions.
7632
7633 @menu
7634 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7635 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7636 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7637 * Tracepoint Actions::
7638 * Listing Tracepoints::
7639 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
7640 @end menu
7641
7642 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7643 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7644
7645 @table @code
7646 @cindex set tracepoint
7647 @kindex trace
7648 @item trace
7649 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7650 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7651 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7652 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7653 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7654 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7655 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7656 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7657 running.
7658
7659 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7660
7661 @smallexample
7662 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7663
7664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7665
7666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7667
7668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7669
7670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7671 @end smallexample
7672
7673 @noindent
7674 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7675
7676 @vindex $tpnum
7677 @cindex last tracepoint number
7678 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7679 @cindex tracepoint number
7680 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7681 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7682
7683 @kindex delete tracepoint
7684 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7685 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7686 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7687 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7688
7689 Examples:
7690
7691 @smallexample
7692 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7693
7694 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7695 @end smallexample
7696
7697 @noindent
7698 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7699 @end table
7700
7701 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7702 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7703
7704 @table @code
7705 @kindex disable tracepoint
7706 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7707 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7708 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7709 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7710 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7711
7712 @kindex enable tracepoint
7713 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7714 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7715 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7716 run.
7717 @end table
7718
7719 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7720 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7721
7722 @table @code
7723 @kindex passcount
7724 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7725 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7726 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7727 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7728 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7729 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7730 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7731 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7732 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7733 user.
7734
7735 Examples:
7736
7737 @smallexample
7738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7739 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7740
7741 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7742 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7743 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7748 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7749 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7750 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7751 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7752 @end smallexample
7753 @end table
7754
7755 @node Tracepoint Actions
7756 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7757
7758 @table @code
7759 @kindex actions
7760 @cindex tracepoint actions
7761 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7762 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7763 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7764 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7765 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7766 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7767 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7768 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7769 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7770 @code{while-stepping}.
7771
7772 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7773 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7774 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7775
7776 @smallexample
7777 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7778
7779 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7780
7781 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7782 @end smallexample
7783
7784 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7785 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7786 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7787 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7788 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7789 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7790 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7791 @code{end} command.
7792
7793 @smallexample
7794 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7795 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7796 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7797 > collect bar,baz
7798 > collect $regs
7799 > while-stepping 12
7800 > collect $fp, $sp
7801 > end
7802 end
7803 @end smallexample
7804
7805 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7806 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7807 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7808 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7809 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7810 special arguments are supported:
7811
7812 @table @code
7813 @item $regs
7814 collect all registers
7815
7816 @item $args
7817 collect all function arguments
7818
7819 @item $locals
7820 collect all local variables.
7821 @end table
7822
7823 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7824 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7825 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7826
7827 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7828 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7829
7830 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7831 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7832 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7833 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7834 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7835 its own @code{end} command):
7836
7837 @smallexample
7838 > while-stepping 12
7839 > collect $regs, myglobal
7840 > end
7841 >
7842 @end smallexample
7843
7844 @noindent
7845 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7846 @code{stepping}.
7847 @end table
7848
7849 @node Listing Tracepoints
7850 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7851
7852 @table @code
7853 @kindex info tracepoints
7854 @kindex info tp
7855 @cindex information about tracepoints
7856 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7857 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7858 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7859 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7860 shown:
7861
7862 @itemize @bullet
7863 @item
7864 its number
7865 @item
7866 whether it is enabled or disabled
7867 @item
7868 its address
7869 @item
7870 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7871 @item
7872 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7873 @item
7874 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7875 @item
7876 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7877 @end itemize
7878
7879 @smallexample
7880 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7881 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
7882 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
7883 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
7884 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7885 (@value{GDBP})
7886 @end smallexample
7887
7888 @noindent
7889 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7890 @end table
7891
7892 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7893 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7894
7895 @table @code
7896 @kindex tstart
7897 @cindex start a new trace experiment
7898 @cindex collected data discarded
7899 @item tstart
7900 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7901 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7902 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7903 experiment.
7904
7905 @kindex tstop
7906 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
7907 @item tstop
7908 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7909 stops collecting data.
7910
7911 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7912 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7913 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7914
7915 @kindex tstatus
7916 @cindex status of trace data collection
7917 @cindex trace experiment, status of
7918 @item tstatus
7919 This command displays the status of the current trace data
7920 collection.
7921 @end table
7922
7923 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7924
7925 @smallexample
7926 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7927 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7928 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7929 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
7930 > while-stepping 11
7931 > collect $regs
7932 > end
7933 > end
7934 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7935 [time passes @dots{}]
7936 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7937 @end smallexample
7938
7939
7940 @node Analyze Collected Data
7941 @section Using the collected data
7942
7943 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7944 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7945 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7946 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7947 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7948 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7949 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7950 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7951 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7952 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7953 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7954 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7955 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7956 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7957 the buffer will fail.
7958
7959 @menu
7960 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7961 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7962 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7963 @end menu
7964
7965 @node tfind
7966 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7967
7968 @kindex tfind
7969 @cindex select trace snapshot
7970 @cindex find trace snapshot
7971 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7972 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7973 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7974 snapshot is selected.
7975
7976 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
7977
7978 @table @code
7979 @item tfind start
7980 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
7981 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
7982
7983 @item tfind none
7984 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
7985
7986 @item tfind end
7987 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
7988
7989 @item tfind
7990 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
7991
7992 @item tfind -
7993 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
7994 retracing earlier steps.
7995
7996 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
7997 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
7998 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
7999 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8000 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8001
8002 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8003 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8004 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8005 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8006 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8007
8008 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8009 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8010 addresses.
8011
8012 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8013 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8014 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8015
8016 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8017 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8018 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8019 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8020 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8021 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8022 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8023 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8024 @end table
8025
8026 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8027 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8028 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8029 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8030 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8031 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8032 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8033 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8034 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8035 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8036 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8037 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8038 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8039 tracepoint as the current one.
8040
8041 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8042 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8043 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8044 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8045 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8046
8047 @smallexample
8048 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8049 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8050 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8051 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8052 > tfind
8053 > end
8054
8055 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8056 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8057 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8058 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8059 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8060 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8061 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8062 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8063 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8064 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8065 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8066 @end smallexample
8067
8068 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8069 the buffer:
8070
8071 @smallexample
8072 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8073 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8074 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8075 > tfind line
8076 > end
8077
8078 Frame 0, X = 1
8079 Frame 7, X = 2
8080 Frame 13, X = 255
8081 @end smallexample
8082
8083 @node tdump
8084 @subsection @code{tdump}
8085 @kindex tdump
8086 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8087 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8088
8089 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8090 the current trace snapshot.
8091
8092 @smallexample
8093 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8094 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8095 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8096 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8097 > end
8098
8099 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8100
8101 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8102 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8103 at gdb_test.c:444
8104 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8105
8106 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8107 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8108 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8109 d1 0x18 24
8110 d2 0x80 128
8111 d3 0x33 51
8112 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8113 d5 0x22 34
8114 d6 0xe0 224
8115 d7 0x380035 3670069
8116 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8117 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8118 a2 0x100 256
8119 a3 0x322000 3284992
8120 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8121 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8122 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8123 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8124 ps 0x0 0
8125 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8126 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8127 fpstatus 0x0 0
8128 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8129 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8130 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8131 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8132 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8133 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8134 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8135 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8136 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8137
8138 (@value{GDBP})
8139 @end smallexample
8140
8141 @node save-tracepoints
8142 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8143 @kindex save-tracepoints
8144 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8145
8146 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8147 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8148 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8149 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8150 Files}).
8151
8152 @node Tracepoint Variables
8153 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8154 @cindex tracepoint variables
8155 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8156
8157 @table @code
8158 @vindex $trace_frame
8159 @item (int) $trace_frame
8160 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8161 snapshot is selected.
8162
8163 @vindex $tracepoint
8164 @item (int) $tracepoint
8165 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8166
8167 @vindex $trace_line
8168 @item (int) $trace_line
8169 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8170
8171 @vindex $trace_file
8172 @item (char []) $trace_file
8173 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8174
8175 @vindex $trace_func
8176 @item (char []) $trace_func
8177 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8178 @end table
8179
8180 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8181 use @code{output} instead.
8182
8183 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8184 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8185 data.
8186
8187 @smallexample
8188 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8189
8190 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8191 > output $trace_file
8192 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8193 > tfind
8194 > end
8195 @end smallexample
8196
8197 @node Overlays
8198 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8199 @cindex overlays
8200
8201 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8202 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8203 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8204 use overlays.
8205
8206 @menu
8207 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8208 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8209 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8210 mapped by asking the inferior.
8211 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8212 @end menu
8213
8214 @node How Overlays Work
8215 @section How Overlays Work
8216 @cindex mapped overlays
8217 @cindex unmapped overlays
8218 @cindex load address, overlay's
8219 @cindex mapped address
8220 @cindex overlay area
8221
8222 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8223 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8224 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8225 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8226 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8227
8228 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8229 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8230 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8231 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8232 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8233 largest overlay as well.
8234
8235 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8236 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8237 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8238 there.
8239
8240 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8241 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8242 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8243
8244 @smallexample
8245 @group
8246 Data Instruction Larger
8247 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8248 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8249 | | | | | |
8250 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8251 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8252 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8253 | and heap | | | | | |
8254 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8255 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8256 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8257 | | | | | |
8258 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8259 address | | | | | |
8260 | overlay | <-' | | |
8261 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8262 | | <---. | | load address
8263 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8264 | | | |
8265 +-----------+ | |
8266 +-----------+
8267 | |
8268 +-----------+
8269
8270 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8271 @end group
8272 @end smallexample
8273
8274 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8275 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8276 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8277 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8278 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8279 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8280 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8281 program and the overlay area.
8282
8283 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8284 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8285 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8286 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8287 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8288 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8289 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8290
8291 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8292 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8293 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8294
8295 @itemize @bullet
8296
8297 @item
8298 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8299 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8300 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8301 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8302
8303 @item
8304 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8305 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8306 your program's performance.
8307
8308 @item
8309 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8310 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8311 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8312 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8313 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8314 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8315 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8316
8317 @item
8318 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8319 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8320 instruction and data spaces.
8321
8322 @end itemize
8323
8324 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8325 improved in many ways:
8326
8327 @itemize @bullet
8328
8329 @item
8330 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8331 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8332 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8333 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8334 area in the usual way.
8335
8336 @item
8337 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8338 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8339
8340 @item
8341 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8342 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8343 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8344 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8345 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8346 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8347 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8348
8349 @end itemize
8350
8351
8352 @node Overlay Commands
8353 @section Overlay Commands
8354
8355 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8356 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8357 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8358 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8359 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8360 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8361
8362 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8363 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8364
8365 @table @code
8366 @item overlay off
8367 @kindex overlay
8368 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8369 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8370 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8371 overlay support is disabled.
8372
8373 @item overlay manual
8374 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8375 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8376 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8377 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8378 commands described below.
8379
8380 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8381 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8382 @cindex map an overlay
8383 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8384 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8385 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8386 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8387 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8388 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8389
8390 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8391 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8392 @cindex unmap an overlay
8393 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8394 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8395 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8396 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8397
8398 @item overlay auto
8399 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8400 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8401 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8402 Overlay Debugging}.
8403
8404 @item overlay load-target
8405 @itemx overlay load
8406 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8407 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8408 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8409 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8410 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8411 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8412
8413 @item overlay list-overlays
8414 @itemx overlay list
8415 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8416 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8417 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8418
8419 @end table
8420
8421 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8422 of the function the address falls in:
8423
8424 @smallexample
8425 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8426 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8427 @end smallexample
8428 @noindent
8429 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8430 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8431 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8432 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8433
8434 @smallexample
8435 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8436 No sections are mapped.
8437 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8438 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8439 @end smallexample
8440 @noindent
8441 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8442 name normally:
8443
8444 @smallexample
8445 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8446 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8447 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8448 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8449 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8450 @end smallexample
8451
8452 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8453 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8454 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8455 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8456 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8457
8458 @itemize @bullet
8459 @item
8460 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8461 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8462 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8463 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8464 @item
8465 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8466 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8467 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8468 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8469 breakpoints properly.
8470 @end itemize
8471
8472
8473 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8474 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8475 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8476
8477 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8478 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8479 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8480 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8481 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8482 current state of the overlays.
8483
8484 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8485 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8486
8487 @table @asis
8488
8489 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8490 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8491
8492 @smallexample
8493 struct
8494 @{
8495 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8496 unsigned long vma;
8497
8498 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8499 unsigned long size;
8500
8501 /* The overlay's load address. */
8502 unsigned long lma;
8503
8504 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8505 zero otherwise. */
8506 unsigned long mapped;
8507 @}
8508 @end smallexample
8509
8510 @item @code{_novlys}:
8511 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8512 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8513
8514 @end table
8515
8516 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8517 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8518 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8519 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8520 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8521 currently mapped.
8522
8523 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8524 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8525 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8526 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8527 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8528 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8529 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8530 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8531 are not being executed.
8532
8533 @node Overlay Sample Program
8534 @section Overlay Sample Program
8535 @cindex overlay example program
8536
8537 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8538 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8539 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8540 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8541 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8542 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8543 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8544
8545 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8546 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8547 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8548 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8549
8550 @table @file
8551 @item overlays.c
8552 The main program file.
8553 @item ovlymgr.c
8554 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8555 @item foo.c
8556 @itemx bar.c
8557 @itemx baz.c
8558 @itemx grbx.c
8559 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8560 @item d10v.ld
8561 @itemx m32r.ld
8562 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8563 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8564 @end table
8565
8566 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8567 cross-compiler like this:
8568
8569 @smallexample
8570 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8571 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8572 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8573 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8574 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8575 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8576 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8577 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8578 @end smallexample
8579
8580 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8581 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8582 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8583
8584
8585 @node Languages
8586 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8587 @cindex languages
8588
8589 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8590 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8591 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8592 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8593 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8594 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8595
8596 @cindex working language
8597 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8598 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8599 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8600 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8601 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8602 language}.
8603
8604 @menu
8605 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8606 * Show:: Displaying the language
8607 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8608 * Supported languages:: Supported languages
8609 * Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
8610 @end menu
8611
8612 @node Setting
8613 @section Switching between source languages
8614
8615 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8616 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8617 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8618 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8619 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8620 are printed, etc.
8621
8622 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8623 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8624 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8625 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8626 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8627 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8628 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8629 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8630 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8631 Displaying the language}.
8632
8633 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8634 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8635 another language. In that case, make the
8636 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8637 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8638 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8639
8640 @menu
8641 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8642 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8643 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8644 @end menu
8645
8646 @node Filenames
8647 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
8648
8649 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8650 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8651
8652 @table @file
8653 @item .ada
8654 @itemx .ads
8655 @itemx .adb
8656 @itemx .a
8657 Ada source file.
8658
8659 @item .c
8660 C source file
8661
8662 @item .C
8663 @itemx .cc
8664 @itemx .cp
8665 @itemx .cpp
8666 @itemx .cxx
8667 @itemx .c++
8668 C@t{++} source file
8669
8670 @item .m
8671 Objective-C source file
8672
8673 @item .f
8674 @itemx .F
8675 Fortran source file
8676
8677 @item .mod
8678 Modula-2 source file
8679
8680 @item .s
8681 @itemx .S
8682 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8683 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8684 @end table
8685
8686 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8687 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
8688
8689 @node Manually
8690 @subsection Setting the working language
8691
8692 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8693 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8694 your program.
8695
8696 @kindex set language
8697 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8698 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8699 a language, such as
8700 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8701 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8702
8703 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8704 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8705 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8706 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8707 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8708 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8709 command such as:
8710
8711 @smallexample
8712 print a = b + c
8713 @end smallexample
8714
8715 @noindent
8716 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8717 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8718 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8719 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8720
8721 @node Automatically
8722 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8723
8724 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8725 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8726 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8727 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8728 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8729 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8730 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8731 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8732 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8733
8734 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8735 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8736 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8737 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8738 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8739
8740 @node Show
8741 @section Displaying the language
8742
8743 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8744 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8745
8746 @table @code
8747 @item show language
8748 @kindex show language
8749 Display the current working language. This is the
8750 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8751 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8752
8753 @item info frame
8754 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8755 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8756 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8757 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
8758 information listed here.
8759
8760 @item info source
8761 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8762 Display the source language of this source file.
8763 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8764 information listed here.
8765 @end table
8766
8767 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8768 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8769 with a language explicitly:
8770
8771 @table @code
8772 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8773 @kindex set extension-language
8774 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8775 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8776
8777 @item info extensions
8778 @kindex info extensions
8779 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8780 @end table
8781
8782 @node Checks
8783 @section Type and range checking
8784
8785 @quotation
8786 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8787 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8788 section documents the intended facilities.
8789 @end quotation
8790 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8791
8792 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8793 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8794 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8795 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8796 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8797 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8798 errors when your program is running.
8799
8800 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8801 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8802 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8803 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8804 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8805 automatically based on your program's source language.
8806 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default
8807 settings of supported languages.
8808
8809 @menu
8810 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8811 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8812 @end menu
8813
8814 @cindex type checking
8815 @cindex checks, type
8816 @node Type Checking
8817 @subsection An overview of type checking
8818
8819 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8820 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8821 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8822 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8823
8824 @smallexample
8825 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8826 @exdent but
8827 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8828 @end smallexample
8829
8830 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8831 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8832
8833 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8834 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8835 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8836 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8837 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8838 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8839 also issues a warning.
8840
8841 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8842 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8843 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8844 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8845 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8846 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8847
8848 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8849 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8850 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8851 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8852 operators. @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for further
8853 details on specific languages.
8854
8855 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8856
8857 @kindex set check type
8858 @kindex show check type
8859 @table @code
8860 @item set check type auto
8861 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8862 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8863 each language.
8864
8865 @item set check type on
8866 @itemx set check type off
8867 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8868 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8869 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8870 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8871 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8872
8873 @item set check type warn
8874 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8875 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8876 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8877 numbers and structures.
8878
8879 @item show type
8880 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8881 is setting it automatically.
8882 @end table
8883
8884 @cindex range checking
8885 @cindex checks, range
8886 @node Range Checking
8887 @subsection An overview of range checking
8888
8889 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8890 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8891 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8892 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8893 not exceed the bounds of the array.
8894
8895 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8896 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8897 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8898 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8899
8900 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8901 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8902 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8903 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8904 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8905 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8906
8907 @smallexample
8908 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8909 @end smallexample
8910
8911 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8912 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported languages, ,
8913 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8914
8915 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8916
8917 @kindex set check range
8918 @kindex show check range
8919 @table @code
8920 @item set check range auto
8921 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8922 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8923 each language.
8924
8925 @item set check range on
8926 @itemx set check range off
8927 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8928 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
8929 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8930 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
8931
8932 @item set check range warn
8933 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8934 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8935 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8936 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8937 systems).
8938
8939 @item show range
8940 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8941 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8942 @end table
8943
8944 @node Supported languages
8945 @section Supported languages
8946
8947 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
8948 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
8949 @c This is false ...
8950 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8951 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8952 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8953 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8954 language.
8955
8956 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8957 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8958 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8959 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8960 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8961 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8962 language reference or tutorial.
8963
8964 @menu
8965 * C:: C and C@t{++}
8966 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
8967 * Fortran:: Fortran
8968 * Pascal:: Pascal
8969 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
8970 * Ada:: Ada
8971 @end menu
8972
8973 @node C
8974 @subsection C and C@t{++}
8975
8976 @cindex C and C@t{++}
8977 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
8978
8979 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
8980 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
8981 together.
8982
8983 @cindex C@t{++}
8984 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
8985 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
8986 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
8987 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
8988 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
8989 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
8990 compiler (@code{aCC}).
8991
8992 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
8993 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
8994 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
8995 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
8996 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
8997 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
8998
8999 @menu
9000 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9001 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9002 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9003 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9004 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9005 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9006 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9007 @end menu
9008
9009 @node C Operators
9010 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
9011
9012 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9013
9014 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9015 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9016 often defined on groups of types.
9017
9018 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9019
9020 @itemize @bullet
9021
9022 @item
9023 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9024 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9025
9026 @item
9027 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9028 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9029
9030 @item
9031 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9032
9033 @item
9034 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9035
9036 @end itemize
9037
9038 @noindent
9039 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9040 in order of increasing precedence:
9041
9042 @table @code
9043 @item ,
9044 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9045 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9046 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9047
9048 @item =
9049 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9050 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9051
9052 @item @var{op}=
9053 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9054 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9055 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9056 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9057 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9058
9059 @item ?:
9060 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9061 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9062 integral type.
9063
9064 @item ||
9065 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9066
9067 @item &&
9068 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9069
9070 @item |
9071 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9072
9073 @item ^
9074 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9075
9076 @item &
9077 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9078
9079 @item ==@r{, }!=
9080 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9081 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9082
9083 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9084 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9085 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9086 and non-zero for true.
9087
9088 @item <<@r{, }>>
9089 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9090
9091 @item @@
9092 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9093
9094 @item +@r{, }-
9095 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9096 pointer types.
9097
9098 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9099 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9100 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9101 integral types.
9102
9103 @item ++@r{, }--
9104 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9105 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9106 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9107 operation takes place.
9108
9109 @item *
9110 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9111 @code{++}.
9112
9113 @item &
9114 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9115
9116 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9117 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9118 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
9119 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9120 stored.
9121
9122 @item -
9123 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9124 precedence as @code{++}.
9125
9126 @item !
9127 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9128 @code{++}.
9129
9130 @item ~
9131 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9132 @code{++}.
9133
9134
9135 @item .@r{, }->
9136 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9137 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9138 pointer based on the stored type information.
9139 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9140
9141 @item .*@r{, }->*
9142 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9143
9144 @item []
9145 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9146 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9147
9148 @item ()
9149 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9150
9151 @item ::
9152 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9153 and @code{class} types.
9154
9155 @item ::
9156 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9157 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9158 above.
9159 @end table
9160
9161 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9162 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9163 predefined meaning.
9164
9165 @menu
9166 * C Constants::
9167 @end menu
9168
9169 @node C Constants
9170 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
9171
9172 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9173
9174 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9175 following ways:
9176
9177 @itemize @bullet
9178 @item
9179 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9180 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9181 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9182 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9183 @code{long} value.
9184
9185 @item
9186 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9187 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9188 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9189 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9190 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9191 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9192 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9193 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9194 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9195 constant.
9196
9197 @item
9198 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9199 integral equivalents.
9200
9201 @item
9202 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9203 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9204 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9205 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9206 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9207 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9208 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9209 @samp{\n} for newline.
9210
9211 @item
9212 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9213 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9214 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9215 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9216 characters.
9217
9218 @item
9219 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9220 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9221
9222 @item
9223 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9224 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9225 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9226 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9227 @end itemize
9228
9229 @menu
9230 * C plus plus expressions::
9231 * C Defaults::
9232 * C Checks::
9233
9234 * Debugging C::
9235 @end menu
9236
9237 @node C plus plus expressions
9238 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
9239
9240 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9241 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9242
9243 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9244 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9245 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9246 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9247 @quotation
9248 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9249 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9250 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9251 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9252 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9253 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9254 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9255 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9256 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9257 C@t{++} code.
9258 @end quotation
9259
9260 @enumerate
9261
9262 @cindex member functions
9263 @item
9264 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9265
9266 @smallexample
9267 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9268 @end smallexample
9269
9270 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9271 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9272 @item
9273 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9274 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9275 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9276 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9277
9278 @cindex call overloaded functions
9279 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9280 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9281 @item
9282 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9283 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9284 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9285 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9286 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9287 default arguments.
9288
9289 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9290 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9291 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9292 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9293 number of function arguments.
9294
9295 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9296 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
9297 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
9298
9299 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9300 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9301 @smallexample
9302 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9303 @end smallexample
9304
9305 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9306 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
9307
9308 @cindex reference declarations
9309 @item
9310 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9311 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9312 dereferenced.
9313
9314 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9315 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9316 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9317 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9318 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9319
9320 @item
9321 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9322 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9323 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9324 necessary, for example in an expression like
9325 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9326 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9327 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
9328 @end enumerate
9329
9330 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9331 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9332 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9333 invoking user-defined operators.
9334
9335 @node C Defaults
9336 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
9337
9338 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9339
9340 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9341 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9342 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9343 selects the working language.
9344
9345 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9346 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9347 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9348 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9349 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
9350 for further details.
9351
9352 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9353 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9354 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9355
9356 @node C Checks
9357 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9358
9359 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9360
9361 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9362 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9363 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9364
9365 @itemize @bullet
9366 @item
9367 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9368 enumerated tag.
9369
9370 @item
9371 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9372 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9373
9374 @ignore
9375 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9376 @c FIXME--beers?
9377 @item
9378 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9379 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9380 compilers.)
9381 @end ignore
9382 @end itemize
9383
9384 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9385 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9386 that is not itself an array.
9387
9388 @node Debugging C
9389 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9390
9391 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9392 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9393 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9394 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9395
9396 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9397 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9398 ,Expressions}.
9399
9400 @menu
9401 * Debugging C plus plus::
9402 @end menu
9403
9404 @node Debugging C plus plus
9405 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9406
9407 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9408
9409 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9410 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9411
9412 @table @code
9413 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9414 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9415 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9416 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9417 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
9418
9419 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9420 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9421 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9422 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9423 classes.
9424 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
9425
9426 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9427 @item catch throw
9428 @itemx catch catch
9429 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9430 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
9431
9432 @cindex inheritance
9433 @item ptype @var{typename}
9434 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9435 @var{typename}.
9436 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9437
9438 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9439 @item set print demangle
9440 @itemx show print demangle
9441 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9442 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9443 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9444 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9445 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9446
9447 @item set print object
9448 @itemx show print object
9449 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9450 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9451
9452 @item set print vtbl
9453 @itemx show print vtbl
9454 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9455 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9456 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9457 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9458
9459 @kindex set overload-resolution
9460 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9461 @item set overload-resolution on
9462 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9463 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9464 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9465 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
9466 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
9467 message.
9468
9469 @item set overload-resolution off
9470 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9471 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9472 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9473 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9474 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9475 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9476 argument types.
9477
9478 @kindex show overload-resolution
9479 @item show overload-resolution
9480 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9481
9482 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9483 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9484 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9485 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9486 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9487 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9488 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
9489 @end table
9490
9491 @node Objective-C
9492 @subsection Objective-C
9493
9494 @cindex Objective-C
9495 This section provides information about some commands and command
9496 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9497 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9498 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9499
9500 @menu
9501 * Method Names in Commands::
9502 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9503 @end menu
9504
9505 @node Method Names in Commands, The Print Command with Objective-C, Objective-C, Objective-C
9506 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9507
9508 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9509 names as line specifications:
9510
9511 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9512 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9513 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9514 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9515 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9516 @itemize
9517 @item @code{clear}
9518 @item @code{break}
9519 @item @code{info line}
9520 @item @code{jump}
9521 @item @code{list}
9522 @end itemize
9523
9524 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9525
9526 @smallexample
9527 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9528 @end smallexample
9529
9530 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9531 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9532 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9533 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9534 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9535 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9536 debugged, enter:
9537
9538 @smallexample
9539 break -[Fruit create]
9540 @end smallexample
9541
9542 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9543 enter:
9544
9545 @smallexample
9546 list +[NSText initialize]
9547 @end smallexample
9548
9549 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9550 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9551 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9552 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9553
9554 @smallexample
9555 break create
9556 @end smallexample
9557
9558 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9559 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9560 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9561 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9562 none apply.
9563
9564 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9565 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9566
9567 @smallexample
9568 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9569 @end smallexample
9570
9571 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9572 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9573 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9574 @kindex print-object
9575 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9576
9577 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9578
9579 @smallexample
9580 print -[@var{object} hash]
9581 @end smallexample
9582
9583 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9584 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9585 @noindent
9586 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9587 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9588 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9589 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9590 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9591 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9592
9593 @node Fortran
9594 @subsection Fortran
9595 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9596
9597 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9598 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9599
9600 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9601 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9602 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9603 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9604 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9605 underscore.
9606
9607 @menu
9608 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9609 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9610 * Special Fortran commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9611 @end menu
9612
9613 @node Fortran Operators
9614 @subsubsection Fortran operators and expressions
9615
9616 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9617
9618 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9619 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9620 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9621
9622 @table @code
9623 @item **
9624 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9625 of the second one.
9626
9627 @item :
9628 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9629 represent a section of array.
9630 @end table
9631
9632 @node Fortran Defaults
9633 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9634
9635 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9636
9637 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9638 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9639 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9640 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9641
9642 @node Special Fortran commands
9643 @subsubsection Special Fortran commands
9644
9645 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9646
9647 @value{GDBN} had some commands to support Fortran specific feature,
9648 such as common block displaying.
9649
9650 @table @code
9651 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9652 @kindex info common
9653 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9654 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9655 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9656 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at current program location are
9657 printed.
9658 @end table
9659
9660 @node Pascal
9661 @subsection Pascal
9662
9663 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9664 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9665 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9666 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9667 syntax.
9668
9669 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9670 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9671 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9672
9673 @node Modula-2
9674 @subsection Modula-2
9675
9676 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9677
9678 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9679 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9680 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9681 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9682 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9683 table.
9684
9685 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9686 @menu
9687 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9688 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9689 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9690 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9691 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9692 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9693 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9694 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9695 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9696 @end menu
9697
9698 @node M2 Operators
9699 @subsubsection Operators
9700 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9701
9702 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9703 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9704 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9705 following definitions hold:
9706
9707 @itemize @bullet
9708
9709 @item
9710 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9711 their subranges.
9712
9713 @item
9714 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9715
9716 @item
9717 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9718
9719 @item
9720 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9721 @var{type}}.
9722
9723 @item
9724 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9725
9726 @item
9727 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9728
9729 @item
9730 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9731 @end itemize
9732
9733 @noindent
9734 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9735 increasing precedence:
9736
9737 @table @code
9738 @item ,
9739 Function argument or array index separator.
9740
9741 @item :=
9742 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9743 @var{value}.
9744
9745 @item <@r{, }>
9746 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9747 types.
9748
9749 @item <=@r{, }>=
9750 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9751 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9752 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9753
9754 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9755 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9756 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9757 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9758 comment character.
9759
9760 @item IN
9761 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9762 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9763
9764 @item OR
9765 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9766
9767 @item AND@r{, }&
9768 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9769
9770 @item @@
9771 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9772
9773 @item +@r{, }-
9774 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9775 and difference on set types.
9776
9777 @item *
9778 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9779 on set types.
9780
9781 @item /
9782 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9783 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9784
9785 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9786 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9787 precedence as @code{*}.
9788
9789 @item -
9790 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9791
9792 @item ^
9793 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9794
9795 @item NOT
9796 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9797 @code{^}.
9798
9799 @item .
9800 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9801 precedence as @code{^}.
9802
9803 @item []
9804 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9805
9806 @item ()
9807 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9808 as @code{^}.
9809
9810 @item ::@r{, }.
9811 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9812 @end table
9813
9814 @quotation
9815 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9816 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9817 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9818 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9819 @end quotation
9820
9821
9822 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9823 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
9824 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9825
9826 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9827 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9828
9829 @table @var
9830
9831 @item a
9832 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9833
9834 @item c
9835 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9836
9837 @item i
9838 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9839
9840 @item m
9841 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9842 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9843 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9844
9845 @item n
9846 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9847
9848 @item r
9849 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9850
9851 @item t
9852 represents a type.
9853
9854 @item v
9855 represents a variable.
9856
9857 @item x
9858 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9859 explanation of the function for details.
9860 @end table
9861
9862 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9863
9864 @table @code
9865 @item ABS(@var{n})
9866 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9867
9868 @item CAP(@var{c})
9869 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9870 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9871
9872 @item CHR(@var{i})
9873 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9874
9875 @item DEC(@var{v})
9876 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9877
9878 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9879 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9880 new value.
9881
9882 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9883 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9884 set.
9885
9886 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9887 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9888
9889 @item HIGH(@var{a})
9890 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9891
9892 @item INC(@var{v})
9893 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9894
9895 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9896 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9897 new value.
9898
9899 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9900 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9901 there. Returns the new set.
9902
9903 @item MAX(@var{t})
9904 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9905
9906 @item MIN(@var{t})
9907 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9908
9909 @item ODD(@var{i})
9910 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9911
9912 @item ORD(@var{x})
9913 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9914 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9915 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9916 integral, character and enumerated types.
9917
9918 @item SIZE(@var{x})
9919 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9920
9921 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
9922 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9923
9924 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9925 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9926 @end table
9927
9928 @quotation
9929 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9930 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9931 an error.
9932 @end quotation
9933
9934 @cindex Modula-2 constants
9935 @node M2 Constants
9936 @subsubsection Constants
9937
9938 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9939 ways:
9940
9941 @itemize @bullet
9942
9943 @item
9944 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
9945 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
9946 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
9947 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
9948
9949 @item
9950 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
9951 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
9952 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
9953 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
9954 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
9955 digits.
9956
9957 @item
9958 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
9959 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
9960 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
9961 followed by a @samp{C}.
9962
9963 @item
9964 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
9965 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
9966 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
9967 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
9968 sequences.
9969
9970 @item
9971 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
9972
9973 @item
9974 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
9975 @code{FALSE}.
9976
9977 @item
9978 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
9979
9980 @item
9981 Set constants are not yet supported.
9982 @end itemize
9983
9984 @node M2 Types
9985 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
9986 @cindex Modula-2 types
9987
9988 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
9989 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
9990 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
9991 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
9992 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
9993 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
9994
9995 The first example contains the following section of code:
9996
9997 @smallexample
9998 VAR
9999 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10000 r: [20..40] ;
10001 @end smallexample
10002
10003 @noindent
10004 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10005 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10006
10007 @smallexample
10008 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10009 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10010 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10011 SET OF CHAR
10012 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10013 21
10014 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10015 [20..40]
10016 @end smallexample
10017
10018 @noindent
10019 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10020
10021 @smallexample
10022 VAR
10023 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10024 @end smallexample
10025
10026 @noindent
10027 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10028
10029 @smallexample
10030 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10031 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10032 @end smallexample
10033
10034 @noindent
10035 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10036 expressions using the debugger.
10037
10038 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10039 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10040
10041 @smallexample
10042 VAR
10043 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10044 @end smallexample
10045
10046 @smallexample
10047 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10048 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10049 @end smallexample
10050
10051 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10052 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10053 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10054 above. Unbounded arrays are also not yet recognized in @value{GDBN}.
10055
10056 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10057
10058 @smallexample
10059 TYPE
10060 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10061 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10062 VAR
10063 s: t ;
10064 BEGIN
10065 s := blue ;
10066 @end smallexample
10067
10068 @noindent
10069 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10070 and value of a variable.
10071
10072 @smallexample
10073 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10074 $1 = blue
10075 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10076 type = [blue..yellow]
10077 @end smallexample
10078
10079 @noindent
10080 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10081 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10082 their @code{C} counterparts.
10083
10084 @smallexample
10085 VAR
10086 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10087 BEGIN
10088 s[1] := 1 ;
10089 @end smallexample
10090
10091 @smallexample
10092 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10093 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10094 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10095 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10096 @end smallexample
10097
10098 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10099 pointer types as shown in this example:
10100
10101 @smallexample
10102 VAR
10103 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10104 BEGIN
10105 NEW(s) ;
10106 s^[1] := 1 ;
10107 @end smallexample
10108
10109 @noindent
10110 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10111
10112 @smallexample
10113 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10114 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10115 @end smallexample
10116
10117 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10118 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10119 types:
10120
10121 @smallexample
10122 TYPE
10123 foo = RECORD
10124 f1: CARDINAL ;
10125 f2: CHAR ;
10126 f3: myarray ;
10127 END ;
10128
10129 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10130 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10131 VAR
10132 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10133 @end smallexample
10134
10135 @noindent
10136 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10137 below.
10138
10139 @smallexample
10140 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10141 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10142 f1 : CARDINAL;
10143 f2 : CHAR;
10144 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10145 END
10146 @end smallexample
10147
10148 @node M2 Defaults
10149 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
10150 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10151
10152 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10153 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10154 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10155 selected the working language.
10156
10157 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10158 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10159 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
10160 the language automatically}, for further details.
10161
10162 @node Deviations
10163 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
10164 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10165
10166 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10167 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10168
10169 @itemize @bullet
10170 @item
10171 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10172 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10173 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10174 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10175 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10176 returned a pointer.)
10177
10178 @item
10179 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10180 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10181 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10182 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10183
10184 @item
10185 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10186 argument.
10187
10188 @item
10189 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10190 @end itemize
10191
10192 @node M2 Checks
10193 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
10194 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10195
10196 @quotation
10197 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10198 range checking.
10199 @end quotation
10200 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10201
10202 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10203
10204 @itemize @bullet
10205 @item
10206 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10207 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10208
10209 @item
10210 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10211 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10212 @end itemize
10213
10214 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10215 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10216
10217 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10218 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10219
10220 @node M2 Scope
10221 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10222 @cindex scope
10223 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10224 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10225 @ifinfo
10226 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10227 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10228 @end ifinfo
10229 @iftex
10230 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10231 @end iftex
10232
10233 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10234 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10235 similar syntax:
10236
10237 @smallexample
10238
10239 @var{module} . @var{id}
10240 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10241 @end smallexample
10242
10243 @noindent
10244 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10245 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10246 identifier within your program, except another module.
10247
10248 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10249 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10250 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10251 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10252
10253 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10254 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10255 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10256 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10257 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10258 @var{module}.
10259
10260 @node GDB/M2
10261 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10262
10263 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10264 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10265 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10266 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10267 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10268 analogue in Modula-2.
10269
10270 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10271 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10272 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10273 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10274 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10275 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10276
10277 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10278 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10279 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10280
10281 @node Ada
10282 @subsection Ada
10283 @cindex Ada
10284
10285 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10286 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10287 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10288 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10289 to be difficult.
10290
10291
10292 @cindex expressions in Ada
10293 @menu
10294 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10295 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10296 in @value{GDBN}.
10297 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10298 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10299 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10300 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10301 @end menu
10302
10303 @node Ada Mode Intro
10304 @subsubsection Introduction
10305 @cindex Ada mode, general
10306
10307 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10308 syntax, with some extensions.
10309 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10310
10311 @itemize @bullet
10312 @item
10313 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10314 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10315 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10316 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10317
10318 @item
10319 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10320 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10321
10322 @item
10323 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10324 @end itemize
10325
10326 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10327 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10328 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10329 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10330 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10331
10332 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10333 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10334 was translated from an Ada source file.
10335
10336 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10337 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10338 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10339 middle (to allow based literals).
10340
10341 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10342 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10343 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10344 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10345 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10346 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10347
10348 @node Omissions from Ada
10349 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10350 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10351
10352 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10353
10354 @itemize @bullet
10355 @item
10356 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10357
10358 @itemize @minus
10359 @item
10360 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10361 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10362
10363 @item
10364 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10365
10366 @item
10367 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10368
10369 @item
10370 @t{'Tag}.
10371
10372 @item
10373 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10374 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10375
10376 @item
10377 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10378 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10379
10380 @item
10381 @t{'Address}.
10382 @end itemize
10383
10384 @item
10385 The names in
10386 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10387 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10388 not currently available.
10389
10390 @item
10391 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10392 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10393 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10394 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10395 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10396 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10397 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10398 indeterminate values.
10399
10400 @item
10401 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10402 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10403 are not implemented.
10404
10405 @item
10406 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10407 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10408 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10409 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10410 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10411
10412 @smallexample
10413 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10414 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10415 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10416 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10417 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10418 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10419 @end smallexample
10420
10421 Changing a
10422 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10423 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10424 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10425 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10426 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10427 declared to have a type such as:
10428
10429 @smallexample
10430 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10431 Id : Integer;
10432 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10433 end record;
10434 @end smallexample
10435
10436 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10437 assignments:
10438
10439 @smallexample
10440 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10441 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10442 @end smallexample
10443
10444 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10445 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10446 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10447 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10448 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10449 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10450 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10451 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10452
10453 @item
10454 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10455
10456 @item
10457 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10458 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in which a subexpression
10459 appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much looser in its rules for allowing
10460 type matches. As a result, some function calls will be ambiguous, and the user
10461 will be asked to choose the proper resolution.
10462
10463 @item
10464 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10465
10466 @item
10467 Entry calls are not implemented.
10468
10469 @item
10470 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10471 formats are not supported.
10472
10473 @item
10474 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10475 @end itemize
10476
10477 @node Additions to Ada
10478 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10479 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10480
10481 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10482 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10483
10484 @itemize @bullet
10485 @item
10486 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory
10487 (typically a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is
10488 a positive integer, then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of
10489 @var{E} and the @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array.
10490 In Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use
10491 is in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in Ada.
10492 However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs
10493 in which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10494
10495 @item
10496 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that appears
10497 in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name, you must typically
10498 surround it in single quotes.
10499
10500 @item
10501 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10502 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10503
10504 @item
10505 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10506 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10507 @end itemize
10508
10509 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright additions specific
10510 to Ada:
10511
10512 @itemize @bullet
10513 @item
10514 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10515 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10516
10517 @smallexample
10518 set x := y + 3
10519 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10520 @end smallexample
10521
10522 @item
10523 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10524 the value of its right-hand operand.
10525 This allows, for example,
10526 complex conditional breaks:
10527
10528 @smallexample
10529 break f
10530 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10531 @end smallexample
10532
10533 @item
10534 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10535 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10536 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10537 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10538 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10539 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10540 in strings. For example,
10541 @smallexample
10542 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10543 @end smallexample
10544 @noindent
10545 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF}) after each
10546 period.
10547
10548 @item
10549 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10550 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10551 to write
10552
10553 @smallexample
10554 print 'max(x, y)
10555 @end smallexample
10556
10557 @item
10558 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10559 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10560 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound of 3 might print as
10561
10562 @smallexample
10563 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10564 @end smallexample
10565
10566 @noindent
10567 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10568 clause.
10569
10570 @item
10571 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10572 multi-character subsequence of
10573 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10574 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10575 in place of @t{a'length}.
10576
10577 @item
10578 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10579 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10580 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10581 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10582 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10583 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10584 For example,
10585 @smallexample
10586 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10587 @end smallexample
10588
10589 @item
10590 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10591 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10592 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10593 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10594 object.
10595
10596 @end itemize
10597
10598 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10599 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10600
10601 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10602 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10603 before reaching the main procedure.
10604 As defined in the Ada Reference
10605 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10606 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10607 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10608 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10609
10610 @node Ada Glitches
10611 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10612 @cindex Ada, problems
10613
10614 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10615 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10616 @value{GDBN},
10617 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10618 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10619
10620 @itemize @bullet
10621 @item
10622 Currently, the debugger
10623 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10624 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10625 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10626 to get it printed properly.
10627
10628 @item
10629 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10630 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10631
10632 @item
10633 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10634 argument lists are treated as positional).
10635
10636 @item
10637 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10638
10639 @item
10640 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10641 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10642 the host machine.
10643
10644 @item
10645 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10646
10647 @item
10648 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10649 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10650 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10651 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10652 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10653 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10654 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10655 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10656 you can usually resolve the confusion
10657 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10658 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10659 @end itemize
10660
10661 @node Unsupported languages
10662 @section Unsupported languages
10663
10664 @cindex unsupported languages
10665 @cindex minimal language
10666 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10667 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10668 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10669 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10670 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10671 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10672
10673 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10674 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10675 language.
10676
10677 @node Symbols
10678 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10679
10680 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10681 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10682 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10683 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10684 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10685 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
10686 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10687
10688 @cindex symbol names
10689 @cindex names of symbols
10690 @cindex quoting names
10691 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10692 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10693 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10694 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
10695 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10696 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10697 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10698 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10699
10700 @smallexample
10701 p 'foo.c'::x
10702 @end smallexample
10703
10704 @noindent
10705 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10706
10707 @table @code
10708 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10709 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10710 @kindex set case-sensitive
10711 @item set case-sensitive on
10712 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10713 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10714 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10715 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10716 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10717 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10718 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10719 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10720 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10721 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10722 case-insensitive matches.
10723
10724 @kindex show case-sensitive
10725 @item show case-sensitive
10726 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10727 lookups.
10728
10729 @kindex info address
10730 @cindex address of a symbol
10731 @item info address @var{symbol}
10732 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10733 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10734 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10735 is always stored.
10736
10737 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10738 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10739 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10740
10741 @kindex info symbol
10742 @cindex symbol from address
10743 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10744 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10745 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10746 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10747 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10748
10749 @smallexample
10750 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10751 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10752 @end smallexample
10753
10754 @noindent
10755 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10756 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10757
10758 @kindex whatis
10759 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10760 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10761 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10762 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10763 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10764 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10765 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10766 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10767 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10768 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10769 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10770
10771 @kindex ptype
10772 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10773 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10774 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10775 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10776
10777 For example, for this variable declaration:
10778
10779 @smallexample
10780 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10781 @end smallexample
10782
10783 @noindent
10784 the two commands give this output:
10785
10786 @smallexample
10787 @group
10788 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10789 type = struct complex
10790 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10791 type = struct complex @{
10792 double real;
10793 double imag;
10794 @}
10795 @end group
10796 @end smallexample
10797
10798 @noindent
10799 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10800 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10801
10802 @cindex incomplete type
10803 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10804 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10805 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10806 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10807 given these declarations:
10808
10809 @smallexample
10810 struct foo;
10811 struct foo *fooptr;
10812 @end smallexample
10813
10814 @noindent
10815 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10816
10817 @smallexample
10818 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
10819 $1 = <incomplete type>
10820 @end smallexample
10821
10822 @noindent
10823 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10824 completely specified.
10825
10826 @kindex info types
10827 @item info types @var{regexp}
10828 @itemx info types
10829 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10830 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10831 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10832 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10833 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10834 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10835 name is @code{value}.
10836
10837 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10838 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10839 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10840
10841 @kindex info scope
10842 @cindex local variables
10843 @item info scope @var{location}
10844 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10845 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10846 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10847 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10848
10849 @smallexample
10850 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10851 Scope for command_line_handler:
10852 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10853 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10854 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10855 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10856 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10857 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10858 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10859 @end smallexample
10860
10861 @noindent
10862 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10863 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10864 collect}.
10865
10866 @kindex info source
10867 @item info source
10868 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10869 the function containing the current point of execution:
10870 @itemize @bullet
10871 @item
10872 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10873 @item
10874 the directory it was compiled in,
10875 @item
10876 its length, in lines,
10877 @item
10878 which programming language it is written in,
10879 @item
10880 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10881 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10882 @item
10883 whether the debugging information includes information about
10884 preprocessor macros.
10885 @end itemize
10886
10887
10888 @kindex info sources
10889 @item info sources
10890 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10891 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10892 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10893
10894 @kindex info functions
10895 @item info functions
10896 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10897
10898 @item info functions @var{regexp}
10899 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10900 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10901 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10902 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10903 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10904 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
10905 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10906
10907 @kindex info variables
10908 @item info variables
10909 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10910 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10911
10912 @item info variables @var{regexp}
10913 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10914 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10915 @var{regexp}.
10916
10917 @kindex info classes
10918 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10919 @item info classes
10920 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10921 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10922 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10923 expression.
10924
10925 @kindex info selectors
10926 @item info selectors
10927 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10928 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10929 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10930 expression.
10931
10932 @ignore
10933 This was never implemented.
10934 @kindex info methods
10935 @item info methods
10936 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10937 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10938 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10939 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
10940 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
10941 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
10942 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
10943 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
10944 @end ignore
10945
10946 @cindex reloading symbols
10947 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
10948 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
10949 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
10950 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
10951 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
10952
10953 @table @code
10954 @kindex set symbol-reloading
10955 @item set symbol-reloading on
10956 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
10957 object file with a particular name is seen again.
10958
10959 @item set symbol-reloading off
10960 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
10961 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
10962 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
10963 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
10964 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
10965 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
10966 name.
10967
10968 @kindex show symbol-reloading
10969 @item show symbol-reloading
10970 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
10971 @end table
10972
10973 @cindex opaque data types
10974 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
10975 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
10976 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
10977 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
10978 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
10979 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
10980 another source file. The default is on.
10981
10982 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
10983 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
10984
10985 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
10986 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
10987 is printed as follows:
10988 @smallexample
10989 @{<no data fields>@}
10990 @end smallexample
10991
10992 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
10993 @item show opaque-type-resolution
10994 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
10995
10996 @kindex maint print symbols
10997 @cindex symbol dump
10998 @kindex maint print psymbols
10999 @cindex partial symbol dump
11000 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11001 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11002 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11003 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11004 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11005 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11006 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11007 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11008 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11009 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11010 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11011 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11012 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11013 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11014 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11015 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
11016 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11017
11018 @kindex maint info symtabs
11019 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11020 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11021 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11022 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11023 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11024 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11025 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11026
11027 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11028 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11029 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11030 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11031 structure in more detail. For example:
11032
11033 @smallexample
11034 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11035 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11036 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11037 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11038 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11039 readin no
11040 fullname (null)
11041 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11042 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11043 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11044 dependencies (none)
11045 @}
11046 @}
11047 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11048 (@value{GDBP})
11049 @end smallexample
11050 @noindent
11051 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11052 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11053 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11054 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11055 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11056
11057 @smallexample
11058 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11059 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11060 line 1574.
11061 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11062 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11063 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11064 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11065 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11066 dirname (null)
11067 fullname (null)
11068 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11069 debugformat DWARF 2
11070 @}
11071 @}
11072 (@value{GDBP})
11073 @end smallexample
11074 @end table
11075
11076
11077 @node Altering
11078 @chapter Altering Execution
11079
11080 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11081 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11082 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11083 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11084 program.
11085
11086 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11087 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11088 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11089
11090 @menu
11091 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11092 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11093 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11094 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11095 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11096 * Patching:: Patching your program
11097 @end menu
11098
11099 @node Assignment
11100 @section Assignment to variables
11101
11102 @cindex assignment
11103 @cindex setting variables
11104 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11105 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11106
11107 @smallexample
11108 print x=4
11109 @end smallexample
11110
11111 @noindent
11112 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11113 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11114 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11115 information on operators in supported languages.
11116
11117 @kindex set variable
11118 @cindex variables, setting
11119 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11120 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11121 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11122 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11123 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11124
11125 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11126 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11127 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11128 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11129 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11130 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11131 command @code{set width}:
11132
11133 @smallexample
11134 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11135 type = double
11136 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11137 $4 = 13
11138 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11139 Invalid syntax in expression.
11140 @end smallexample
11141
11142 @noindent
11143 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11144 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11145
11146 @smallexample
11147 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11148 @end smallexample
11149
11150 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11151 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11152 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11153 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11154 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11155 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11156
11157 @smallexample
11158 @group
11159 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11160 type = double
11161 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11162 $1 = 1
11163 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11164 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11165 $2 = 1
11166 (@value{GDBP}) r
11167 The program being debugged has been started already.
11168 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11169 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11170 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11171 Invalid bfd target.
11172 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11173 The current BFD target is "=4".
11174 @end group
11175 @end smallexample
11176
11177 @noindent
11178 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11179 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11180 @code{g}, use
11181
11182 @smallexample
11183 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11184 @end smallexample
11185
11186 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11187 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11188 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11189 same length or shorter.
11190 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11191 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11192
11193 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11194 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11195 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11196 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11197 and representation in memory), and
11198
11199 @smallexample
11200 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11201 @end smallexample
11202
11203 @noindent
11204 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11205
11206 @node Jumping
11207 @section Continuing at a different address
11208
11209 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11210 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11211 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11212
11213 @table @code
11214 @kindex jump
11215 @item jump @var{linespec}
11216 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
11217 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
11218 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
11219 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
11220 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
11221 breakpoints}.
11222
11223 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11224 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11225 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11226 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11227 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11228 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11229 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11230 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11231 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11232
11233 @item jump *@var{address}
11234 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
11235 @end table
11236
11237 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11238 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11239 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11240 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11241 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11242 example,
11243
11244 @smallexample
11245 set $pc = 0x485
11246 @end smallexample
11247
11248 @noindent
11249 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11250 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11251 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
11252
11253 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11254 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11255 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11256 detail.
11257
11258 @c @group
11259 @node Signaling
11260 @section Giving your program a signal
11261 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11262
11263 @table @code
11264 @kindex signal
11265 @item signal @var{signal}
11266 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11267 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11268 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11269 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11270
11271 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11272 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11273 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11274 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11275 signal.
11276
11277 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11278 after executing the command.
11279 @end table
11280 @c @end group
11281
11282 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11283 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11284 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11285 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11286 passes the signal directly to your program.
11287
11288
11289 @node Returning
11290 @section Returning from a function
11291
11292 @table @code
11293 @cindex returning from a function
11294 @kindex return
11295 @item return
11296 @itemx return @var{expression}
11297 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11298 command. If you give an
11299 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11300 value.
11301 @end table
11302
11303 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11304 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11305 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11306 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11307
11308 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11309 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11310 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11311 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11312 of functions.
11313
11314 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11315 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11316 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11317 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
11318 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11319
11320 @node Calling
11321 @section Calling program functions
11322
11323 @table @code
11324 @cindex calling functions
11325 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11326 @item print @var{expr}
11327 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resuling value.
11328 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11329 debugged.
11330
11331 @kindex call
11332 @item call @var{expr}
11333 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11334 returned values.
11335
11336 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11337 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11338 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11339 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11340 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11341 value history.
11342 @end table
11343
11344 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11345 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11346 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11347 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11348
11349 @table @code
11350 @item set unwindonsignal
11351 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11352 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11353 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11354 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11355 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11356 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11357 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11358 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11359 received.
11360
11361 @item show unwindonsignal
11362 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11363 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11364 @value{GDBN}.
11365 @end table
11366
11367 @cindex weak alias functions
11368 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11369 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11370 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11371 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11372 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11373 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11374 function instead.
11375
11376 @node Patching
11377 @section Patching programs
11378
11379 @cindex patching binaries
11380 @cindex writing into executables
11381 @cindex writing into corefiles
11382
11383 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11384 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11385 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11386 patching your program's binary.
11387
11388 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11389 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11390 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11391 repairs.
11392
11393 @table @code
11394 @kindex set write
11395 @item set write on
11396 @itemx set write off
11397 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11398 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11399 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11400
11401 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11402 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11403 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11404
11405 @item show write
11406 @kindex show write
11407 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11408 as well as reading.
11409 @end table
11410
11411 @node GDB Files
11412 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11413
11414 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11415 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11416 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11417 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11418
11419 @menu
11420 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11421 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11422 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11423 @end menu
11424
11425 @node Files
11426 @section Commands to specify files
11427
11428 @cindex symbol table
11429 @cindex core dump file
11430
11431 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11432 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11433 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11434 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11435
11436 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11437 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11438 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11439 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file}). In these situations the
11440 @value{GDBN} commands to specify new files are useful.
11441
11442 @table @code
11443 @cindex executable file
11444 @kindex file
11445 @item file @var{filename}
11446 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11447 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11448 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11449 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11450 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11451 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11452 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11453 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11454
11455 @cindex unlinked object files
11456 @cindex patching object files
11457 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11458 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11459 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11460 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11461 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11462 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11463 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11464 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11465
11466 @item file
11467 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11468 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11469
11470 @kindex exec-file
11471 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11472 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11473 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11474 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11475 discard information on the executable file.
11476
11477 @kindex symbol-file
11478 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11479 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11480 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11481 table and program to run from the same file.
11482
11483 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11484 program's symbol table.
11485
11486 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11487 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11488 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11489 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11490 @value{GDBN}.
11491
11492 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11493 executing it once.
11494
11495 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11496 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11497 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11498 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11499 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11500 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11501 optimized code.
11502
11503 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11504 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11505 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11506 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11507 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11508
11509 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11510 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11511 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11512 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11513 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11514 warnings and messages}.)
11515
11516 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11517 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11518 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11519 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11520 in stabs format.
11521
11522 @kindex readnow
11523 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11524 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11525 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11526 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11527 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11528 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11529 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11530 entire symbol table available.
11531
11532 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11533 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11534 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11535 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11536 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11537 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11538 @c files.
11539
11540 @kindex core-file
11541 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11542 @itemx core
11543 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11544 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11545 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11546 executable file itself for other parts.
11547
11548 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11549 to be used.
11550
11551 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11552 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11553 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11554 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11555 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
11556
11557 @kindex add-symbol-file
11558 @cindex dynamic linking
11559 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11560 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11561 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11562 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11563 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11564 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11565 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11566 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11567 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11568 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11569 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11570 @var{address} as an expression.
11571
11572 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11573 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11574 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11575 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11576 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11577
11578 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11579 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11580 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11581 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11582 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11583 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11584 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11585 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11586 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11587
11588 @itemize @bullet
11589 @item
11590 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11591 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11592 @item
11593 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11594 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11595 @item
11596 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11597 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11598 @end itemize
11599
11600 @noindent
11601 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11602 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11603 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11604 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11605 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11606 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11607 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11608 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11609 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11610 way.
11611
11612 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11613
11614 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11615 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11616 @cindex load symbols from memory
11617 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11618 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11619 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11620 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11621 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11622 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11623 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11624 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11625 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11626
11627 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11628 @kindex assf
11629 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11630 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11631 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11632 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11633 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11634 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11635 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11636 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11637 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11638 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11639
11640 @kindex section
11641 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11642 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11643 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11644 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11645 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11646 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11647 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11648 their addresses.
11649
11650 @kindex info files
11651 @kindex info target
11652 @item info files
11653 @itemx info target
11654 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11655 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11656 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11657 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11658 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11659 current ones.
11660
11661 @kindex maint info sections
11662 @item maint info sections
11663 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11664 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11665 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11666 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11667 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11668 may be arbitrarily combined):
11669
11670 @table @code
11671 @item ALLOBJ
11672 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11673 @item @var{sections}
11674 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11675 @item @var{section-flags}
11676 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11677 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11678 @table @code
11679 @item ALLOC
11680 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11681 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11682 @item LOAD
11683 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11684 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11685 @item RELOC
11686 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11687 @item READONLY
11688 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11689 @item CODE
11690 Section contains executable code only.
11691 @item DATA
11692 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11693 @item ROM
11694 Section will reside in ROM.
11695 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11696 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11697 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11698 Section is not empty.
11699 @item NEVER_LOAD
11700 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11701 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11702 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11703 COFF shared library information.
11704 @item IS_COMMON
11705 Section contains common symbols.
11706 @end table
11707 @end table
11708 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11709 @cindex read-only sections
11710 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11711 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11712 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11713 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11714 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11715 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11716 enhancement to debugging performance.
11717
11718 The default is off.
11719
11720 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11721 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11722 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11723 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11724
11725 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11726 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11727 @end table
11728
11729 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11730 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11731 name and remembers it that way.
11732
11733 @cindex shared libraries
11734 @value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11735 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11736
11737 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11738 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11739 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11740 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11741 debugging a core file).
11742
11743 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11744 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11745
11746 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11747 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11748 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11749
11750 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11751 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11752 particularly large or there are many of them.
11753
11754 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11755 commands:
11756
11757 @table @code
11758 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11759 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11760 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11761 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11762 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11763 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11764 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11765 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11766
11767 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11768 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11769 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11770 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11771 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11772 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11773 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11774 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expresion that matches
11775 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11776
11777 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11778 @item show auto-solib-add
11779 Display the current autoloading mode.
11780 @end table
11781
11782 @cindex load shared library
11783 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11784 command:
11785
11786 @table @code
11787 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11788 @kindex info share
11789 @item info share
11790 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11791 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11792
11793 @kindex sharedlibrary
11794 @kindex share
11795 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11796 @itemx share @var{regex}
11797 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11798 Unix regular expression.
11799 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11800 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11801 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11802 loaded.
11803
11804 @item nosharedlibrary
11805 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11806 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11807 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11808 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11809 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11810 discarded.
11811 @end table
11812
11813 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11814 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11815 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11816
11817 @table @code
11818 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11819 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11820 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11821 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11822 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11823 shared library.
11824
11825 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11826 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11827 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11828 library events happen.
11829 @end table
11830
11831 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11832 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11833 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11834 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11835 not.
11836
11837 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11838 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11839 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11840 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11841 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11842
11843 @table @code
11844 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11845 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11846 @item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
11847 If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
11848 absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
11849 paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
11850 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
11851 out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
11852 @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
11853
11854 @cindex default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
11855 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11856 You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
11857 configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
11858
11859 @kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
11860 @item show solib-absolute-prefix
11861 Display the current shared library prefix.
11862
11863 @kindex set solib-search-path
11864 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11865 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
11866 to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
11867 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
11868 the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
11869 @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
11870 set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
11871 @value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
11872
11873 @kindex show solib-search-path
11874 @item show solib-search-path
11875 Display the current shared library search path.
11876 @end table
11877
11878
11879 @node Separate Debug Files
11880 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11881 @cindex separate debugging information files
11882 @cindex debugging information in separate files
11883 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11884 @cindex debugging information directory, global
11885 @cindex global debugging information directory
11886
11887 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11888 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11889 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11890 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
11891 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
11892 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11893 install only when they need to debug a problem.
11894
11895 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
11896 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
11897 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
11898 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
11899 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
11900 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
11901 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
11902 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
11903 places:
11904
11905 @itemize @bullet
11906 @item
11907 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
11908 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
11909 @item
11910 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
11911 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
11912 @item
11913 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
11914 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
11915 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
11916 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
11917 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
11918 @end itemize
11919 @noindent
11920 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
11921 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
11922 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
11923
11924 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
11925 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
11926 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
11927 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
11928 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
11929 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
11930
11931 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
11932 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
11933
11934 @table @code
11935
11936 @kindex set debug-file-directory
11937 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
11938 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11939 information files to @var{directory}.
11940
11941 @kindex show debug-file-directory
11942 @item show debug-file-directory
11943 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11944 information files.
11945
11946 @end table
11947
11948 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
11949 @cindex debug links
11950 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
11951 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
11952
11953 @itemize
11954 @item
11955 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
11956 a zero byte,
11957 @item
11958 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
11959 boundary within the section, and
11960 @item
11961 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
11962 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
11963 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
11964 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
11965 @end itemize
11966
11967 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
11968 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
11969 described above.
11970
11971 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
11972 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
11973 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
11974 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
11975 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
11976 in an ordinary executable.
11977
11978 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
11979 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
11980 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
11981 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
11982 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
11983 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
11984 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
11985
11986 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
11987 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
11988 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
11989 complete code for a function that computes it:
11990
11991 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
11992 @smallexample
11993 unsigned long
11994 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
11995 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
11996 @{
11997 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
11998 @{
11999 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12000 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12001 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12002 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12003 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12004 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12005 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12006 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12007 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12008 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12009 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12010 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12011 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12012 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12013 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12014 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12015 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12016 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12017 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12018 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12019 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12020 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12021 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12022 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12023 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12024 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12025 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12026 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12027 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12028 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12029 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12030 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12031 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12032 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12033 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12034 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12035 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12036 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12037 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12038 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12039 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12040 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12041 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12042 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12043 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12044 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12045 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12046 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12047 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12048 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12049 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12050 0x2d02ef8d
12051 @};
12052 unsigned char *end;
12053
12054 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12055 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12056 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12057 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12058 @}
12059 @end smallexample
12060
12061
12062 @node Symbol Errors
12063 @section Errors reading symbol files
12064
12065 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12066 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12067 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12068 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12069 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12070 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12071 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12072 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12073 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12074 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
12075 messages}).
12076
12077 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12078
12079 @table @code
12080 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12081
12082 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12083 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12084 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12085 in its outer scope blocks.
12086
12087 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12088 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12089 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12090 function.
12091
12092 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12093
12094 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12095 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12096 do so.
12097
12098 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12099 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12100 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12101 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
12102 messages}.)
12103
12104 @item bad block start address patched
12105
12106 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12107 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12108 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12109
12110 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12111 starting on the previous source line.
12112
12113 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12114
12115 @cindex foo
12116 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12117 larger than the size of the string table.
12118
12119 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12120 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12121 with this name.
12122
12123 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12124
12125 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12126 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12127 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12128
12129 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12130 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12131 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12132 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12133 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12134 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12135
12136 @item stub type has NULL name
12137
12138 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12139
12140 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12141 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12142 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12143 it.
12144
12145 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12146
12147 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12148
12149 @end table
12150
12151 @node Targets
12152 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12153
12154 @cindex debugging target
12155 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12156
12157 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12158 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12159 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12160 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12161 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12162 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12163 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12164 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
12165
12166 @cindex target architecture
12167 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12168 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12169 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12170 command.
12171
12172 @table @code
12173 @kindex set architecture
12174 @kindex show architecture
12175 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12176 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12177 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12178 supported architectures.
12179
12180 @item show architecture
12181 Show the current target architecture.
12182
12183 @item set processor
12184 @itemx processor
12185 @kindex set processor
12186 @kindex show processor
12187 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12188 and @code{show architecture}.
12189 @end table
12190
12191 @menu
12192 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12193 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12194 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12195 * Remote:: Remote debugging
12196
12197 @end menu
12198
12199 @node Active Targets
12200 @section Active targets
12201
12202 @cindex stacking targets
12203 @cindex active targets
12204 @cindex multiple targets
12205
12206 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12207 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12208 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12209 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12210 a core file.
12211
12212 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12213 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12214 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12215 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12216 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12217 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12218 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12219 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12220 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12221
12222 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12223 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12224 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12225 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12226 process target is active.
12227
12228 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12229 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
12230 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12231 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
12232 process}).
12233
12234 @node Target Commands
12235 @section Commands for managing targets
12236
12237 @table @code
12238 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12239 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12240 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12241 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12242 protocol of the target machine.
12243
12244 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12245 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12246 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12247
12248 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12249 after executing the command.
12250
12251 @kindex help target
12252 @item help target
12253 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12254 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12255 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
12256
12257 @item help target @var{name}
12258 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12259 select it.
12260
12261 @kindex set gnutarget
12262 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12263 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12264 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12265 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12266 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12267 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12268
12269 @quotation
12270 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12271 you must know the actual BFD name.
12272 @end quotation
12273
12274 @noindent
12275 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
12276
12277 @kindex show gnutarget
12278 @item show gnutarget
12279 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12280 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12281 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12282 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12283 @end table
12284
12285 @cindex common targets
12286 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12287 configuration):
12288
12289 @table @code
12290 @kindex target
12291 @item target exec @var{program}
12292 @cindex executable file target
12293 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12294 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12295
12296 @item target core @var{filename}
12297 @cindex core dump file target
12298 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12299 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12300
12301 @item target remote @var{medium}
12302 @cindex remote target
12303 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12304 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12305 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12306
12307 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12308 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12309
12310 @smallexample
12311 target remote /dev/ttya
12312 @end smallexample
12313
12314 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12315 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12316 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12317 clobbered by the download.
12318
12319 @item target sim
12320 @cindex built-in simulator target
12321 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12322 In general,
12323 @smallexample
12324 target sim
12325 load
12326 run
12327 @end smallexample
12328 @noindent
12329 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12330 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12331 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12332 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12333 Processors}.
12334
12335 @end table
12336
12337 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12338
12339 @table @code
12340
12341 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12342 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12343 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12344
12345 @end table
12346
12347 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12348 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12349
12350 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12351 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12352 various aspects of this process.
12353
12354 @table @code
12355
12356 @item set hash
12357 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12358 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12359 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12360 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12361 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12362 monitor.
12363
12364 @item show hash
12365 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12366 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12367
12368 @item set debug monitor
12369 @kindex set debug monitor
12370 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12371 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12372 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12373
12374 @item show debug monitor
12375 @kindex show debug monitor
12376 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12377 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12378 @end table
12379
12380 @table @code
12381
12382 @kindex load @var{filename}
12383 @item load @var{filename}
12384 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12385 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12386 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12387 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12388 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12389 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12390
12391 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12392 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12393 target is @dots{}}''
12394
12395 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12396 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12397 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12398 specifies a fixed address.
12399 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12400
12401 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12402 load programs into flash memory.
12403
12404 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12405 @end table
12406
12407 @node Byte Order
12408 @section Choosing target byte order
12409
12410 @cindex choosing target byte order
12411 @cindex target byte order
12412
12413 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12414 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12415 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12416 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12417 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12418 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12419
12420 @table @code
12421 @kindex set endian
12422 @item set endian big
12423 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12424
12425 @item set endian little
12426 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12427
12428 @item set endian auto
12429 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12430 executable.
12431
12432 @item show endian
12433 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12434
12435 @end table
12436
12437 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12438 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12439 target system.
12440
12441 @node Remote
12442 @section Remote debugging
12443 @cindex remote debugging
12444
12445 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12446 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12447 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12448 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12449 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12450
12451 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12452 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12453 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12454 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12455 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12456 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12457
12458 Other remote targets may be available in your
12459 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12460
12461 Once you've connected to the remote target, @value{GDBN} allows you to
12462 send arbitrary commands to the remote monitor:
12463
12464 @table @code
12465 @item remote @var{command}
12466 @kindex remote@r{, a command}
12467 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12468 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the remote monitor.
12469 @end table
12470
12471
12472 @node Remote Debugging
12473 @chapter Debugging remote programs
12474
12475 @menu
12476 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12477 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12478 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
12479 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12480 @end menu
12481
12482 @node Connecting
12483 @section Connecting to a remote target
12484
12485 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12486 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symobl and debugging information.
12487 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12488 program as the first argument.
12489
12490 @cindex @code{target remote}
12491 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12492 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12493 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12494 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12495 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12496 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12497
12498 @table @code
12499
12500 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12501 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12502 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12503 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12504
12505 @smallexample
12506 target remote /dev/ttyb
12507 @end smallexample
12508
12509 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12510 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12511 (@pxref{Remote configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12512 @code{target} command.
12513
12514 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12515 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12516 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12517 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12518 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12519 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12520 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12521 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12522 target.
12523
12524 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12525 @code{manyfarms}:
12526
12527 @smallexample
12528 target remote manyfarms:2828
12529 @end smallexample
12530
12531 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12532 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12533 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12534 port 1234 on your local machine:
12535
12536 @smallexample
12537 target remote :1234
12538 @end smallexample
12539 @noindent
12540
12541 Note that the colon is still required here.
12542
12543 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12544 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12545 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12546 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12547
12548 @smallexample
12549 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12550 @end smallexample
12551
12552 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12553 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12554 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12555 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12556
12557 @item target remote | @var{command}
12558 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12559 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12560 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12561 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12562 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12563 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12564 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12565 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12566
12567 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12568 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12569 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12570
12571 @end table
12572
12573 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12574 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12575 remote program.
12576
12577 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12578 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12579 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12580 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12581 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12582 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12583 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12584
12585 @smallexample
12586 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12587 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12588 @end smallexample
12589
12590 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12591 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12592 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12593 goes back to waiting.
12594
12595 @table @code
12596 @kindex detach (remote)
12597 @item detach
12598 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12599 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12600 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12601 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12602 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12603
12604 @kindex disconnect
12605 @item disconnect
12606 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12607 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12608 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12609 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12610 another target.
12611
12612 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12613 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12614 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12615 @kindex monitor
12616 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12617 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12618 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12619 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12620 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12621 and implement.
12622 @end table
12623
12624 @node Server
12625 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
12626
12627 @kindex gdbserver
12628 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12629 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12630 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12631 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12632
12633 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12634 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12635 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12636 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12637 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12638 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12639 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12640 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12641 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12642 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12643 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12644 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12645 choice for debugging.
12646
12647 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12648 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12649 protocol.
12650
12651 @table @emph
12652 @item On the target machine,
12653 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12654 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12655 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12656 system does all the symbol handling.
12657
12658 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12659 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12660 syntax is:
12661
12662 @smallexample
12663 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12664 @end smallexample
12665
12666 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12667 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12668 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12669 @file{/dev/com1}:
12670
12671 @smallexample
12672 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12673 @end smallexample
12674
12675 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12676 with it.
12677
12678 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12679
12680 @smallexample
12681 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12682 @end smallexample
12683
12684 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12685 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12686 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12687 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12688 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12689 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12690 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12691 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12692 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12693 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12694 @code{target remote} command.
12695
12696 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12697 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12698
12699 @smallexample
12700 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12701 @end smallexample
12702
12703 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12704 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12705
12706 @pindex pidof
12707 @cindex attach to a program by name
12708 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12709 @code{pidof} utility:
12710
12711 @smallexample
12712 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{PROGRAM}`
12713 @end smallexample
12714
12715 In case more than one copy of @var{PROGRAM} is running, or @var{PROGRAM}
12716 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12717 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12718
12719 @item On the host machine,
12720 connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
12721 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12722 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12723 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12724 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12725 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12726 already on the target. However, if you want to load the symbols (as
12727 you normally would), do that with the @code{file} command, and issue
12728 it @emph{before} connecting to the server; otherwise, you will get an
12729 error message saying @code{"Program is already running"}, since the
12730 program is considered running after the connection.
12731
12732 @end table
12733
12734 @node Remote configuration
12735 @section Remote configuration
12736
12737 @kindex set remote
12738 @kindex show remote
12739 This section documents the configuration options available when
12740 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12741 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
12742 system-call-allowed}.
12743
12744 @table @code
12745 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12746 @cindex adress size for remote targets
12747 @cindex bits in remote address
12748 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12749 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12750 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12751 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12752
12753 @item show remoteaddresssize
12754 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12755
12756 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12757 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12758 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12759 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12760 remote targets.
12761
12762 @item show remotebaud
12763 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12764
12765 @item set remotebreak
12766 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12767 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12768 @anchor{set remotebreak}
12769 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12770 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
12771 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
12772 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12773 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12774
12775 @item show remotebreak
12776 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12777 interrupt the remote program.
12778
12779 @item set remotedevice @var{device}
12780 @cindex serial port name
12781 Set the name of the serial port through which to communicate to the
12782 remote target to @var{device}. This is the device used by
12783 @value{GDBN} to open the serial communications line to the remote
12784 target. There's no default, so you must set a valid port name for the
12785 remote serial communications to work. (Some varieties of the
12786 @code{target} command accept the port name as part of their
12787 arguments.)
12788
12789 @item show remotedevice
12790 Show the current name of the serial port.
12791
12792 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12793 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12794 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12795 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12796 @code{ascii}.
12797
12798 @item show remotelogbase
12799 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12800 protocol.
12801
12802 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12803 @cindex record serial communications on file
12804 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12805 default is not to record at all.
12806
12807 @item show remotelogfile.
12808 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12809 serial communications.
12810
12811 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12812 @cindex timeout for serial communications
12813 @cindex remote timeout
12814 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12815 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12816
12817 @item show remotetimeout
12818 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12819 responses.
12820
12821 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12822 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12823 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12824 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12825 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12826 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12827 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12828 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12829 @end table
12830
12831 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
12832 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
12833 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
12834 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
12835 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
12836 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
12837 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
12838 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
12839 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
12840
12841 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
12842 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
12843 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
12844 @value{GDBN} developers.
12845
12846 The available settings are:
12847
12848 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.2 0.35
12849 @item Command Name
12850 @tab Remote Packet
12851 @tab Related Features
12852
12853 @item @code{fetch-register-packet}
12854 @tab @code{p}
12855 @tab @code{info registers}
12856
12857 @item @code{set-register-packet}
12858 @tab @code{P}
12859 @tab @code{set}
12860
12861 @item @code{binary-download-packet}
12862 @tab @code{X}
12863 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
12864
12865 @item @code{read-aux-vector-packet}
12866 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
12867 @tab @code{info auxv}
12868
12869 @item @code{symbol-lookup-packet}
12870 @tab @code{qSymbol}
12871 @tab Detecting multiple threads
12872
12873 @item @code{verbose-resume-packet}
12874 @tab @code{vCont}
12875 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
12876
12877 @item @code{software-breakpoint-packet}
12878 @tab @code{Z0}
12879 @tab @code{break}
12880
12881 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint-packet}
12882 @tab @code{Z1}
12883 @tab @code{hbreak}
12884
12885 @item @code{write-watchpoint-packet}
12886 @tab @code{Z2}
12887 @tab @code{watch}
12888
12889 @item @code{read-watchpoint-packet}
12890 @tab @code{Z3}
12891 @tab @code{rwatch}
12892
12893 @item @code{access-watchpoint-packet}
12894 @tab @code{Z4}
12895 @tab @code{awatch}
12896
12897 @item @code{get-thread-local-storage-address-packet}
12898 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
12899 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
12900
12901 @item @code{supported-packets}
12902 @tab @code{qSupported}
12903 @tab Remote communications parameters
12904
12905 @item @code{pass-signals-packet}
12906 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
12907 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
12908
12909 @end multitable
12910
12911 @node remote stub
12912 @section Implementing a remote stub
12913
12914 @cindex debugging stub, example
12915 @cindex remote stub, example
12916 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
12917 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
12918 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
12919 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
12920 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
12921 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
12922 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
12923 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
12924
12925 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
12926 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
12927 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
12928 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
12929 program, you need:
12930
12931 @enumerate
12932 @item
12933 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
12934 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
12935 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
12936
12937 @item
12938 A C subroutine library to support your program's
12939 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
12940
12941 @item
12942 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
12943 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
12944 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
12945 documentation.
12946 @end enumerate
12947
12948 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
12949 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
12950 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
12951
12952 @table @emph
12953 @item On the host,
12954 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
12955 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
12956 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
12957
12958 @item On the target,
12959 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
12960 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
12961 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
12962
12963 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
12964 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
12965 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
12966 @end table
12967
12968 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
12969 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
12970 @sc{sparc} boards.
12971
12972 @cindex remote serial stub list
12973 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
12974
12975 @table @code
12976
12977 @item i386-stub.c
12978 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
12979 @cindex Intel
12980 @cindex i386
12981 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
12982
12983 @item m68k-stub.c
12984 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
12985 @cindex Motorola 680x0
12986 @cindex m680x0
12987 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
12988
12989 @item sh-stub.c
12990 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
12991 @cindex Renesas
12992 @cindex SH
12993 For Renesas SH architectures.
12994
12995 @item sparc-stub.c
12996 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
12997 @cindex Sparc
12998 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
12999
13000 @item sparcl-stub.c
13001 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13002 @cindex Fujitsu
13003 @cindex SparcLite
13004 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13005
13006 @end table
13007
13008 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13009 recently added stubs.
13010
13011 @menu
13012 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13013 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13014 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13015 @end menu
13016
13017 @node Stub Contents
13018 @subsection What the stub can do for you
13019
13020 @cindex remote serial stub
13021 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13022 subroutines:
13023
13024 @table @code
13025 @item set_debug_traps
13026 @findex set_debug_traps
13027 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13028 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13029 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13030 beginning of your program.
13031
13032 @item handle_exception
13033 @findex handle_exception
13034 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13035 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13036 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13037 run when a trap is triggered.
13038
13039 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13040 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13041 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13042 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13043 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13044 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13045 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13046 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13047 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13048 machine.
13049
13050 @item breakpoint
13051 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13052 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13053 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13054 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13055 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13056 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13057 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13058 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13059 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13060 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13061 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13062
13063 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13064 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13065 start of your debugging session.
13066 @end table
13067
13068 @node Bootstrapping
13069 @subsection What you must do for the stub
13070
13071 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13072 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13073 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13074 debugging target machine.
13075
13076 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13077 serial port.
13078
13079 @table @code
13080 @item int getDebugChar()
13081 @findex getDebugChar
13082 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13083 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13084 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13085
13086 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13087 @findex putDebugChar
13088 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13089 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13090 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13091 @end table
13092
13093 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13094 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13095 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13096 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13097 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13098 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13099 remote system to stop.
13100
13101 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13102 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13103 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13104 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13105
13106 Other routines you need to supply are:
13107
13108 @table @code
13109 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13110 @findex exceptionHandler
13111 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13112 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13113 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13114 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13115 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13116 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13117 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13118 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13119 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13120 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13121 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13122 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13123 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13124
13125 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13126 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13127 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13128 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13129 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13130
13131 @item void flush_i_cache()
13132 @findex flush_i_cache
13133 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13134 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13135 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13136
13137 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13138 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13139 @end table
13140
13141 @noindent
13142 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13143
13144 @table @code
13145 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13146 @findex memset
13147 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13148 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13149 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13150 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13151 @end table
13152
13153 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13154 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13155 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13156 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
13157
13158
13159 @node Debug Session
13160 @subsection Putting it all together
13161
13162 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13163 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13164 steps.
13165
13166 @enumerate
13167 @item
13168 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13169 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
13170 @display
13171 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13172 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13173 @end display
13174
13175 @item
13176 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13177
13178 @smallexample
13179 set_debug_traps();
13180 breakpoint();
13181 @end smallexample
13182
13183 @item
13184 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13185 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13186
13187 @smallexample
13188 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13189 @end smallexample
13190
13191 @noindent
13192 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13193 function in your program, that function is called when
13194 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13195 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13196 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13197
13198 @item
13199 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13200 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13201
13202 @item
13203 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13204 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13205
13206 @item
13207 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13208 @c document that. FIXME.
13209 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13210 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13211
13212 @item
13213 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13214 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
13215
13216 @end enumerate
13217
13218 @node Configurations
13219 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13220
13221 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13222 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13223 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13224
13225 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13226 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13227 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13228 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13229 are quite different from each other.
13230
13231 @menu
13232 * Native::
13233 * Embedded OS::
13234 * Embedded Processors::
13235 * Architectures::
13236 @end menu
13237
13238 @node Native
13239 @section Native
13240
13241 This section describes details specific to particular native
13242 configurations.
13243
13244 @menu
13245 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13246 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13247 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13248 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13249 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13250 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13251 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13252 @end menu
13253
13254 @node HP-UX
13255 @subsection HP-UX
13256
13257 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13258 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13259 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13260
13261
13262 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13263 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13264
13265 @cindex libkvm
13266 @cindex kernel memory image
13267 @cindex kernel crash dump
13268
13269 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13270 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13271 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13272 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13273 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13274 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13275 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13276 @code{kvm} target:
13277
13278 @smallexample
13279 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13280 @end smallexample
13281
13282 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13283 argument:
13284
13285 @smallexample
13286 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13287 @end smallexample
13288
13289 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13290 available:
13291
13292 @table @code
13293 @kindex kvm
13294 @item kvm pcb
13295 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13296
13297 @item kvm proc
13298 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13299 modern FreeBSD systems.
13300 @end table
13301
13302 @node SVR4 Process Information
13303 @subsection SVR4 process information
13304 @cindex /proc
13305 @cindex examine process image
13306 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13307
13308 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13309 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13310 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13311 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13312 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13313 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13314 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13315 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13316 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13317
13318 @table @code
13319 @kindex info proc
13320 @cindex process ID
13321 @item info proc
13322 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13323 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13324 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13325 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13326 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13327 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13328 executable file's absolute file name.
13329
13330 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13331 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13332 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13333 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13334 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13335 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13336
13337 @item info proc mappings
13338 @cindex memory address space mappings
13339 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13340 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13341 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13342 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13343 memory access rights to that range.
13344
13345 @item info proc stat
13346 @itemx info proc status
13347 @cindex process detailed status information
13348 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13349 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13350 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13351 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13352 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13353 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13354 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13355
13356 @item info proc all
13357 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13358 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13359
13360 @ignore
13361 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13362 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13363 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13364 @kindex info proc times
13365 @item info proc times
13366 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13367 its children.
13368
13369 @kindex info proc id
13370 @item info proc id
13371 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13372 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13373 @end ignore
13374
13375 @item set procfs-trace
13376 @kindex set procfs-trace
13377 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13378 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13379
13380 @item show procfs-trace
13381 @kindex show procfs-trace
13382 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13383
13384 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13385 @kindex set procfs-file
13386 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13387 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13388 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13389 standard output.
13390
13391 @item show procfs-file
13392 @kindex show procfs-file
13393 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13394
13395 @item proc-trace-entry
13396 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13397 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13398 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13399 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13400 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13401 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13402 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13403 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13404 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13405
13406 @item info pidlist
13407 @kindex info pidlist
13408 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13409 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13410 processes and all the threads within each process.
13411
13412 @item info meminfo
13413 @kindex info meminfo
13414 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13415 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13416 @end table
13417
13418 @node DJGPP Native
13419 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13420 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13421 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13422 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13423
13424 @cindex DPMI
13425 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13426 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13427 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13428 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13429
13430 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13431 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13432 subsection describes those commands.
13433
13434 @table @code
13435 @kindex info dos
13436 @item info dos
13437 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13438 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13439
13440 @kindex sysinfo
13441 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13442 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13443 @item info dos sysinfo
13444 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13445 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13446 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13447
13448 @cindex GDT
13449 @cindex LDT
13450 @cindex IDT
13451 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13452 @cindex descriptor tables display
13453 @item info dos gdt
13454 @itemx info dos ldt
13455 @itemx info dos idt
13456 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13457 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13458 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13459 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13460 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13461 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13462 rights.
13463
13464 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13465 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13466 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13467 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13468 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13469
13470 @cindex garbled pointers
13471 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13472 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13473 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13474 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13475 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13476 debugged program's data segment:
13477
13478 @smallexample
13479 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13480 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13481 @end smallexample
13482
13483 @noindent
13484 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13485 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13486
13487 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13488 @item info dos pde
13489 @itemx info dos pte
13490 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13491 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13492 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13493 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13494 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13495 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13496 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13497 that is currently in use.
13498
13499 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13500 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13501 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13502 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13503 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13504 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13505 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13506
13507 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13508 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13509 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13510 controller.
13511
13512 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13513
13514 @cindex physical address from linear address
13515 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13516 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13517 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13518 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13519 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13520 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13521 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13522
13523 @smallexample
13524 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13525 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13526 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13527 @end smallexample
13528
13529 @noindent
13530 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13531 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13532 attributes of that page.
13533
13534 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13535 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13536 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13537 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13538 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13539 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13540
13541 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13542 transfer buffer:
13543
13544 @smallexample
13545 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13546 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13547 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13548 @end smallexample
13549
13550 @noindent
13551 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13552 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13553 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13554 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13555 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13556
13557 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13558 @end table
13559
13560 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13561 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13562 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13563 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13564
13565 @table @code
13566 @kindex set com1base
13567 @kindex set com1irq
13568 @kindex set com2base
13569 @kindex set com2irq
13570 @kindex set com3base
13571 @kindex set com3irq
13572 @kindex set com4base
13573 @kindex set com4irq
13574 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13575 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13576 port.
13577
13578 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13579 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13580 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13581
13582 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13583 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13584 other 3 COM ports.
13585
13586 @kindex show com1base
13587 @kindex show com1irq
13588 @kindex show com2base
13589 @kindex show com2irq
13590 @kindex show com3base
13591 @kindex show com3irq
13592 @kindex show com4base
13593 @kindex show com4irq
13594 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13595 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13596 lines used by the COM ports.
13597
13598 @item info serial
13599 @kindex info serial
13600 @cindex DOS serial port status
13601 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13602 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13603 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13604 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13605 @end table
13606
13607
13608 @node Cygwin Native
13609 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
13610 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13611 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13612 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13613
13614 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13615 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13616 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
13617 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
13618 that have no debugging symbols.
13619
13620
13621 @table @code
13622 @kindex info w32
13623 @item info w32
13624 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
13625 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13626
13627 @item info w32 selector
13628 This command displays information returned by
13629 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13630 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13631 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13632 Without argument, this command displays information
13633 about the the six segment registers.
13634
13635 @kindex info dll
13636 @item info dll
13637 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
13638
13639 @kindex dll-symbols
13640 @item dll-symbols
13641 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13642 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13643
13644 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
13645 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
13646 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
13647 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
13648 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
13649 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
13650 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
13651 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
13652 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
13653 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
13654 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
13655
13656 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
13657 @item show cygwin-exceptions
13658 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
13659 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
13660
13661 @kindex set new-console
13662 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13663 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13664 be started in a new console on next start.
13665 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13666 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13667
13668 @kindex show new-console
13669 @item show new-console
13670 Displays whether a new console is used
13671 when the debuggee is started.
13672
13673 @kindex set new-group
13674 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13675 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13676 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13677 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13678 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
13679
13680 @kindex show new-group
13681 @item show new-group
13682 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13683
13684 @kindex set debugevents
13685 @item set debugevents
13686 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
13687 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
13688 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
13689 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
13690 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
13691
13692 @kindex set debugexec
13693 @item set debugexec
13694 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13695 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
13696
13697 @kindex set debugexceptions
13698 @item set debugexceptions
13699 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
13700 debuggee seen by the debugger.
13701
13702 @kindex set debugmemory
13703 @item set debugmemory
13704 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
13705 and writes by the debugger.
13706
13707 @kindex set shell
13708 @item set shell
13709 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13710 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13711
13712 @kindex show shell
13713 @item show shell
13714 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13715
13716 @end table
13717
13718 @menu
13719 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13720 @end menu
13721
13722 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
13723 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13724 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13725 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13726
13727 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13728 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13729 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13730 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13731 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
13732 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13733 ``minimal symbols''.
13734
13735 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13736 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13737 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13738 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13739 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13740 see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
13741 @code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13742 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13743 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13744 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13745
13746 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
13747
13748 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13749 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13750 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13751 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13752 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13753 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13754 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13755 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13756 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13757
13758 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13759 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13760 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13761 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13762 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
13763 @pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13764
13765 @smallexample
13766 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13767 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13768
13769 Non-debugging symbols:
13770 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
13771 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13772 @end smallexample
13773
13774 @smallexample
13775 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
13776 All functions matching regular expression "!":
13777
13778 Non-debugging symbols:
13779 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
13780 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
13781 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13782 [etc...]
13783 @end smallexample
13784
13785 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
13786
13787 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13788 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13789 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13790 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13791 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13792 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13793 a function within a DLL without a running program.
13794
13795 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13796 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13797 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13798 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13799 problem:
13800
13801 @smallexample
13802 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13803 $1 = 268572168
13804 @end smallexample
13805
13806 @smallexample
13807 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
13808 0x10021610: "\230y\""
13809 @end smallexample
13810
13811 And two possible solutions:
13812
13813 @smallexample
13814 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13815 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13816 @end smallexample
13817
13818 @smallexample
13819 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
13820 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
13821 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
13822 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
13823 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
13824 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13825 @end smallexample
13826
13827 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
13828 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
13829 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
13830 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
13831 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
13832
13833 @smallexample
13834 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
13835 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
13836 @end smallexample
13837
13838 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
13839 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
13840 safe.
13841
13842 @node Hurd Native
13843 @subsection Commands specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd systems
13844 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
13845
13846 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
13847 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
13848
13849 @table @code
13850 @item set signals
13851 @itemx set sigs
13852 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
13853 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13854 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
13855 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
13856 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
13857 @code{signals}.
13858
13859 @item show signals
13860 @itemx show sigs
13861 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
13862 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13863 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
13864
13865 @item set signal-thread
13866 @itemx set sigthread
13867 @kindex set signal-thread
13868 @kindex set sigthread
13869 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
13870 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
13871 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
13872 signal-thread}.
13873
13874 @item show signal-thread
13875 @itemx show sigthread
13876 @kindex show signal-thread
13877 @kindex show sigthread
13878 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
13879 delivered a signal.
13880
13881 @item set stopped
13882 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13883 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
13884 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
13885 continued by delivering a signal to it.
13886
13887 @item show stopped
13888 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13889 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
13890 stopped.
13891
13892 @item set exceptions
13893 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13894 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
13895 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
13896 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
13897 trapping on.
13898
13899 @item show exceptions
13900 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13901 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
13902
13903 @item set task pause
13904 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
13905 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13906 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13907 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
13908 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
13909 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
13910 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
13911 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
13912 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
13913
13914 @item show task pause
13915 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
13916 Show the current state of task suspension.
13917
13918 @item set task detach-suspend-count
13919 @cindex task suspend count
13920 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13921 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
13922 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
13923
13924 @item show task detach-suspend-count
13925 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
13926
13927 @item set task exception-port
13928 @itemx set task excp
13929 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13930 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
13931 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
13932 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
13933
13934 @item set noninvasive
13935 @cindex noninvasive task options
13936 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
13937 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
13938 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
13939 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
13940
13941 @item info send-rights
13942 @itemx info receive-rights
13943 @itemx info port-rights
13944 @itemx info port-sets
13945 @itemx info dead-names
13946 @itemx info ports
13947 @itemx info psets
13948 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13949 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13950 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13951 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13952 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13953 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
13954 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
13955 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
13956 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
13957
13958 @item set thread pause
13959 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
13960 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13961 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13962 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
13963 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
13964 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
13965 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
13966 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
13967 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
13968 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
13969 only the current thread.
13970
13971 @item show thread pause
13972 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
13973 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
13974
13975 @item set thread run
13976 This comamnd sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13977
13978 @item show thread run
13979 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13980
13981 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
13982 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13983 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13984 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
13985 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
13986 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
13987 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
13988
13989 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
13990 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
13991 detaching.
13992
13993 @item set thread exception-port
13994 @itemx set thread excp
13995 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
13996 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
13997 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
13998
13999 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14000 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14001 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14002 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14003
14004 @item set thread default
14005 @itemx show thread default
14006 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14007 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14008 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14009 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14010 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14011 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14012 the non-default commands.
14013 @end table
14014
14015
14016 @node Neutrino
14017 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14018 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14019
14020 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14021 Neutrino target:
14022
14023 @table @code
14024 @item set debug nto-debug
14025 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14026 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14027 Neutrino support.
14028
14029 @item show debug nto-debug
14030 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14031 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14032 @end table
14033
14034
14035 @node Embedded OS
14036 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14037
14038 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14039 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14040 architectures.
14041
14042 @menu
14043 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14044 @end menu
14045
14046 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14047 various real-time operating systems.
14048
14049 @node VxWorks
14050 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14051
14052 @cindex VxWorks
14053
14054 @table @code
14055
14056 @kindex target vxworks
14057 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14058 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14059 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14060
14061 @end table
14062
14063 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14064 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14065
14066 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14067 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14068 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14069 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14070 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14071 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14072 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14073
14074 @table @code
14075 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14076 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14077 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14078 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14079 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14080 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14081 of a thin network line.
14082 @end table
14083
14084 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14085 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14086 procedures.
14087
14088 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14089 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14090 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14091 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14092 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14093 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14094 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14095 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14096 manual.
14097 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14098
14099 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14100 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14101 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14102 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14103
14104 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14105
14106 @smallexample
14107 (vxgdb)
14108 @end smallexample
14109
14110 @menu
14111 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14112 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14113 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14114 @end menu
14115
14116 @node VxWorks Connection
14117 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14118
14119 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14120 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14121
14122 @smallexample
14123 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14124 @end smallexample
14125
14126 @need 750
14127 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14128
14129 @smallexample
14130 Attaching remote machine across net...
14131 Connected to tt.
14132 @end smallexample
14133
14134 @need 1000
14135 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14136 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14137 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14138 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
14139 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14140
14141 @smallexample
14142 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14143 @end smallexample
14144
14145 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14146 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14147 command again.
14148
14149 @node VxWorks Download
14150 @subsubsection VxWorks download
14151
14152 @cindex download to VxWorks
14153 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14154 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14155 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14156 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14157 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14158 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14159 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14160 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14161 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14162 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14163 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14164 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14165 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14166 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14167 program, type this on VxWorks:
14168
14169 @smallexample
14170 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14171 @end smallexample
14172
14173 @noindent
14174 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14175
14176 @smallexample
14177 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14178 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14179 @end smallexample
14180
14181 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14182
14183 @smallexample
14184 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14185 @end smallexample
14186
14187 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14188 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14189 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14190 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14191 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14192 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14193 table.)
14194
14195 @node VxWorks Attach
14196 @subsubsection Running tasks
14197
14198 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14199 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14200 follows:
14201
14202 @smallexample
14203 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14204 @end smallexample
14205
14206 @noindent
14207 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14208 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14209 the time of attachment.
14210
14211 @node Embedded Processors
14212 @section Embedded Processors
14213
14214 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14215 configurations.
14216
14217 @cindex send command to simulator
14218 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14219 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14220
14221 @table @code
14222 @item sim @var{command}
14223 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14224 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14225 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14226 acceptable commands.
14227 @end table
14228
14229
14230 @menu
14231 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14232 * H8/300:: Renesas H8/300
14233 * H8/500:: Renesas H8/500
14234 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14235 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14236 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14237 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14238 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14239 * PowerPC: PowerPC
14240 * SH:: Renesas SH
14241 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14242 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14243 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
14244 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14245 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14246 * CRIS:: CRIS
14247 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14248 * WinCE:: Windows CE child processes
14249 @end menu
14250
14251 @node ARM
14252 @subsection ARM
14253 @cindex ARM RDI
14254
14255 @table @code
14256 @kindex target rdi
14257 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14258 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14259 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14260 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14261
14262 @kindex target rdp
14263 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14264 ARM Demon monitor.
14265
14266 @end table
14267
14268 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14269
14270 @table @code
14271 @item set arm disassembler
14272 @kindex set arm
14273 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14274 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14275
14276 @item show arm disassembler
14277 @kindex show arm
14278 Show the current disassembly style.
14279
14280 @item set arm apcs32
14281 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14282 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14283
14284 @item show arm apcs32
14285 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14286
14287 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14288 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14289 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14290
14291 @table @code
14292 @item auto
14293 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14294 @item softfpa
14295 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14296 processors.
14297 @item fpa
14298 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14299 @item softvfp
14300 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14301 @item vfp
14302 VFP co-processor.
14303 @end table
14304
14305 @item show arm fpu
14306 Show the current type of the FPU.
14307
14308 @item set arm abi
14309 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14310
14311 @item show arm abi
14312 Show the currently used ABI.
14313
14314 @item set debug arm
14315 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14316 target support subsystem.
14317
14318 @item show debug arm
14319 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14320 @end table
14321
14322 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14323 using the RDI interface:
14324
14325 @table @code
14326 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14327 @kindex rdilogfile
14328 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14329 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14330 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14331 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14332 @file{rdi.log}.
14333
14334 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14335 @kindex rdilogenable
14336 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14337 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14338 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14339 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14340 are logged to a file.
14341
14342 @item set rdiromatzero
14343 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14344 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14345 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14346 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14347 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14348 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14349
14350 @item show rdiromatzero
14351 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14352 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14353
14354 @item set rdiheartbeat
14355 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14356 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14357 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14358 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14359 well as the Angel monitor.
14360
14361 @item show rdiheartbeat
14362 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14363 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14364 @end table
14365
14366
14367 @node H8/300
14368 @subsection Renesas H8/300
14369
14370 @table @code
14371
14372 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
14373 @item target hms @var{dev}
14374 A Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
14375 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
14376 line and the communications speed used.
14377
14378 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
14379 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
14380 E7000 emulator for Renesas H8 and SH.
14381
14382 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
14383 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
14384 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
14385 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
14386 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
14387
14388 @end table
14389
14390 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
14391 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
14392 @cindex download to Renesas SH
14393 @cindex Renesas SH download
14394 When you select remote debugging to a Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500
14395 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Renesas
14396 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
14397 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
14398
14399 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
14400 Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
14401
14402 @enumerate
14403 @item
14404 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
14405 for Renesas microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
14406 emulator for the Renesas SH and the Renesas 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
14407 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Renesas SH,
14408 H8/300, or H8/500.)
14409
14410 @item
14411 what serial device connects your host to your Renesas board (the first
14412 serial device available on your host is the default).
14413
14414 @item
14415 what speed to use over the serial device.
14416 @end enumerate
14417
14418 @menu
14419 * Renesas Boards:: Connecting to Renesas boards.
14420 * Renesas ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
14421 * Renesas Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros.
14422 @end menu
14423
14424 @node Renesas Boards
14425 @subsubsection Connecting to Renesas boards
14426
14427 @c only for Unix hosts
14428 @kindex device
14429 @cindex serial device, Renesas micros
14430 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
14431 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
14432 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
14433 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
14434
14435 @kindex speed
14436 @cindex serial line speed, Renesas micros
14437 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
14438 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
14439 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
14440 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
14441 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
14442
14443 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
14444 use a Unix host to debug your Renesas microprocessor programs. If you
14445 use a DOS host,
14446 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
14447 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
14448 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
14449 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
14450
14451 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
14452 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
14453 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
14454 the Renesas SH and the H8/500.
14455
14456 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
14457 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
14458 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
14459 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
14460 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
14461 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
14462 @code{COM2}.
14463
14464 @smallexample
14465 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
14466 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
14467
14468 Resident portion of MODE loaded
14469
14470 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
14471
14472 @end smallexample
14473
14474 @quotation
14475 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
14476 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
14477 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
14478 your development board.
14479 @end quotation
14480
14481 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
14482 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
14483 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBN}} with
14484 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
14485 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
14486 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
14487 cross-debugging to the Renesas board, and the @code{load} command to
14488 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
14489 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
14490 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
14491 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
14492 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
14493 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
14494
14495 @smallexample
14496 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
14497 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
14498 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
14499 the conditions.
14500 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
14501 for details.
14502 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
14503 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
14504 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
14505 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
14506 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
14507 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
14508 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
14509 @end smallexample
14510
14511 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
14512 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
14513 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
14514 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
14515 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
14516 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
14517
14518 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
14519 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
14520 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
14521
14522 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
14523 @itemize @bullet
14524 @item
14525 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{Ctrl-c} on the DOS host---it has
14526 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
14527
14528 @item
14529 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
14530 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
14531 to detect program completion.
14532 @end itemize
14533
14534 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
14535 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
14536
14537 @node Renesas ICE
14538 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
14539
14540 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas ICE}
14541 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
14542 Renesas SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
14543 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
14544
14545 @table @code
14546 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
14547 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
14548 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
14549 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
14550 (for example, @samp{9600}).
14551
14552 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
14553 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
14554 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
14555 @end table
14556
14557 The following special commands are available when debugging with the
14558 Renesas E7000 ICE:
14559
14560 @table @code
14561 @item e7000 @var{command}
14562 @kindex e7000
14563 @cindex send command to E7000 monitor
14564 This sends the specified @var{command} to the E7000 monitor.
14565
14566 @item ftplogin @var{machine} @var{username} @var{password} @var{dir}
14567 @kindex ftplogin@r{, E7000}
14568 This command records information for subsequent interface with the
14569 E7000 monitor via the FTP protocol: @value{GDBN} will log into the
14570 named @var{machine} using specified @var{username} and @var{password},
14571 and then chdir to the named directory @var{dir}.
14572
14573 @item ftpload @var{file}
14574 @kindex ftpload@r{, E7000}
14575 This command uses credentials recorded by @code{ftplogin} to fetch and
14576 load the named @var{file} from the E7000 monitor.
14577
14578 @item drain
14579 @kindex drain@r{, E7000}
14580 This command drains any pending text buffers stored on the E7000.
14581
14582 @item set usehardbreakpoints
14583 @itemx show usehardbreakpoints
14584 @kindex set usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14585 @kindex show usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14586 @cindex hardware breakpoints, and E7000
14587 These commands set and show the use of hardware breakpoints for all
14588 breakpoints. @xref{Set Breaks, hardware-assisted breakpoint}, for
14589 more information about using hardware breakpoints selectively.
14590 @end table
14591
14592 @node Renesas Special
14593 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros
14594
14595 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
14596
14597 @table @code
14598
14599 @kindex set machine
14600 @kindex show machine
14601 @item set machine h8300
14602 @itemx set machine h8300h
14603 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
14604 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
14605 to check which variant is currently in effect.
14606
14607 @end table
14608
14609 @node H8/500
14610 @subsection H8/500
14611
14612 @table @code
14613
14614 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
14615 @cindex memory models, H8/500
14616 @item set memory @var{mod}
14617 @itemx show memory
14618 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
14619 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
14620 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
14621 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
14622
14623 @end table
14624
14625 @node M32R/D
14626 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14627
14628 @table @code
14629 @kindex target m32r
14630 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14631 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14632
14633 @kindex target m32rsdi
14634 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14635 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14636 @end table
14637
14638 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14639
14640 @table @code
14641 @item set download-path @var{path}
14642 @kindex set download-path
14643 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14644 Set the default path for finding donwloadable @sc{srec} files.
14645
14646 @item show download-path
14647 @kindex show download-path
14648 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14649
14650 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14651 @kindex set board-address
14652 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14653 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14654
14655 @item show board-address
14656 @kindex show board-address
14657 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14658
14659 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14660 @kindex set server-address
14661 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14662 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14663 host machine.
14664
14665 @item show server-address
14666 @kindex show server-address
14667 Display the IP address of the download server.
14668
14669 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14670 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14671 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14672 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14673 executable file is uploaded.
14674
14675 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14676 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14677 Test the @code{upload} command.
14678 @end table
14679
14680 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14681
14682 @table @code
14683 @item sdireset
14684 @kindex sdireset
14685 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14686 This command resets the SDI connection.
14687
14688 @item sdistatus
14689 @kindex sdistatus
14690 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14691
14692 @item debug_chaos
14693 @kindex debug_chaos
14694 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14695 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14696
14697 @item use_debug_dma
14698 @kindex use_debug_dma
14699 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14700
14701 @item use_mon_code
14702 @kindex use_mon_code
14703 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14704
14705 @item use_ib_break
14706 @kindex use_ib_break
14707 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14708
14709 @item use_dbt_break
14710 @kindex use_dbt_break
14711 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14712 @end table
14713
14714 @node M68K
14715 @subsection M68k
14716
14717 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
14718 target command for the following ROM monitors.
14719
14720 @table @code
14721
14722 @kindex target abug
14723 @item target abug @var{dev}
14724 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
14725
14726 @kindex target cpu32bug
14727 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
14728 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14729
14730 @kindex target dbug
14731 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14732 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14733
14734 @kindex target est
14735 @item target est @var{dev}
14736 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14737
14738 @kindex target rom68k
14739 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
14740 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
14741
14742 @end table
14743
14744 @table @code
14745
14746 @kindex target rombug
14747 @item target rombug @var{dev}
14748 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
14749
14750 @end table
14751
14752 @node MIPS Embedded
14753 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14754
14755 @cindex MIPS boards
14756 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14757 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14758 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14759
14760 @need 1000
14761 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14762
14763 @table @code
14764 @item target mips @var{port}
14765 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14766 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14767 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14768 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14769 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14770 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14771 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14772
14773 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14774 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14775 debugger:
14776
14777 @smallexample
14778 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14779 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14780 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14781 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14782 (@value{GDBP}) run
14783 @end smallexample
14784
14785 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14786 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14787 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14788 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14789 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14790
14791 @item target pmon @var{port}
14792 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14793 PMON ROM monitor.
14794
14795 @item target ddb @var{port}
14796 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14797 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14798
14799 @item target lsi @var{port}
14800 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14801 LSI variant of PMON.
14802
14803 @kindex target r3900
14804 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14805 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14806
14807 @kindex target array
14808 @item target array @var{dev}
14809 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14810
14811 @end table
14812
14813
14814 @noindent
14815 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14816
14817 @table @code
14818 @item set mipsfpu double
14819 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14820 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14821 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14822 @itemx show mipsfpu
14823 @kindex set mipsfpu
14824 @kindex show mipsfpu
14825 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14826 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14827 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14828 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14829 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14830 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14831 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14832 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14833 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14834 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14835 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14836 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14837 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14838
14839 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14840 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14841 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14842
14843 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14844 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14845
14846 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14847 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14848 @itemx show timeout
14849 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14850 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14851 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14852 @kindex set timeout
14853 @kindex show timeout
14854 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14855 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14856 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14857 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14858 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14859 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14860 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14861 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14862 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14863 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14864
14865 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14866 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14867 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14868 to run before stopping.
14869
14870 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14871 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14872 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14873 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14874 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14875 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14876
14877 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14878 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14879 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14880 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14881
14882 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14883 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14884 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14885 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14886 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14887 @table @asis
14888 @item pmon target
14889 @samp{PMON}
14890 @item ddb target
14891 @samp{NEC010}
14892 @item lsi target
14893 @samp{PMON>}
14894 @end table
14895
14896 @item show monitor-prompt
14897 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14898 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14899 remote monitor.
14900
14901 @item set monitor-warnings
14902 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14903 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14904 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14905 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14906 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14907
14908 @item show monitor-warnings
14909 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14910 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14911
14912 @item pmon @var{command}
14913 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14914 @cindex send PMON command
14915 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14916 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14917 @end table
14918
14919 @node OpenRISC 1000
14920 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14921 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14922
14923 @cindex or1k boards
14924 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14925 about platform and commands.
14926
14927 @table @code
14928
14929 @kindex target jtag
14930 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14931
14932 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14933 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14934 connected via parallel port to the board.
14935
14936 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14937
14938 @kindex or1ksim
14939 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14940 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14941 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14942
14943 @kindex info or1k spr
14944 @item info or1k spr
14945 Displays spr groups.
14946
14947 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14948 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14949 Displays register names in selected group.
14950
14951 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14952 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14953 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14954 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14955 Shows information about specified spr register.
14956
14957 @kindex spr
14958 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14959 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14960 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14961 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14962 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14963 @end table
14964
14965 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14966 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14967 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14968 triggers can be set using:
14969 @table @code
14970 @item $LEA/$LDATA
14971 Load effective address/data
14972 @item $SEA/$SDATA
14973 Store effective address/data
14974 @item $AEA/$ADATA
14975 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14976 @item $FETCH
14977 Fetch data
14978 @end table
14979
14980 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
14981 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
14982
14983 @code{htrace} commands:
14984 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
14985 @table @code
14986 @kindex hwatch
14987 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
14988 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
14989 or Data. For example:
14990
14991 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14992
14993 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14994
14995 @kindex htrace
14996 @item htrace info
14997 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
14998
14999 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15000 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15001
15002 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15003 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15004
15005 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15006 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15007
15008 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15009 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15010 triggered.
15011
15012 @item htrace enable
15013 @itemx htrace disable
15014 Enables/disables the HW trace.
15015
15016 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15017 Clears currently recorded trace data.
15018
15019 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15020 will be written there.
15021
15022 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15023 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15024
15025 @item htrace mode continuous
15026 Set continuous trace mode.
15027
15028 @item htrace mode suspend
15029 Set suspend trace mode.
15030
15031 @end table
15032
15033 @node PowerPC
15034 @subsection PowerPC
15035
15036 @table @code
15037 @kindex target dink32
15038 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
15039 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15040
15041 @kindex target ppcbug
15042 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15043 @kindex target ppcbug1
15044 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15045 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15046
15047 @kindex target sds
15048 @item target sds @var{dev}
15049 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15050 @end table
15051
15052 @cindex SDS protocol
15053 The following commands specifi to the SDS protocol are supported
15054 by@value{GDBN}:
15055
15056 @table @code
15057 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15058 @kindex set sdstimeout
15059 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15060 default is 2 seconds.
15061
15062 @item show sdstimeout
15063 @kindex show sdstimeout
15064 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15065
15066 @item sds @var{command}
15067 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15068 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15069 @end table
15070
15071
15072 @node PA
15073 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15074
15075 @table @code
15076
15077 @kindex target op50n
15078 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15079 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15080
15081 @kindex target w89k
15082 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15083 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15084
15085 @end table
15086
15087 @node SH
15088 @subsection Renesas SH
15089
15090 @table @code
15091
15092 @kindex target hms@r{, with Renesas SH}
15093 @item target hms @var{dev}
15094 A Renesas SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
15095 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
15096 the communications speed used.
15097
15098 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas SH}
15099 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
15100 E7000 emulator for Renesas SH.
15101
15102 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
15103 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
15104 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
15105 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
15106 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
15107
15108 @end table
15109
15110 @node Sparclet
15111 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15112
15113 @cindex Sparclet
15114
15115 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15116 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15117 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15118 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15119 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15120
15121 @table @code
15122 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15123 @kindex remotetimeout
15124 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15125 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15126 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15127 @end table
15128
15129 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15130 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15131 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15132 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15133 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15134
15135 @smallexample
15136 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15137 @end smallexample
15138
15139 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15140
15141 @smallexample
15142 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15143 @end smallexample
15144
15145 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15146 Once you have set
15147 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15148 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15149 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15150
15151 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15152
15153 @smallexample
15154 (gdbslet)
15155 @end smallexample
15156
15157 @menu
15158 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15159 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15160 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15161 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15162 @end menu
15163
15164 @node Sparclet File
15165 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
15166
15167 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15168
15169 @smallexample
15170 (gdbslet) file prog
15171 @end smallexample
15172
15173 @need 1000
15174 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15175 @value{GDBN} locates
15176 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15177 path.
15178 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
15179 files will be searched as well.
15180 @value{GDBN} locates
15181 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15182 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
15183 If it fails
15184 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15185
15186 @smallexample
15187 prog: No such file or directory.
15188 @end smallexample
15189
15190 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15191 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15192 @code{target} command again.
15193
15194 @node Sparclet Connection
15195 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15196
15197 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15198 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15199
15200 @smallexample
15201 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15202 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15203 main () at ../prog.c:3
15204 @end smallexample
15205
15206 @need 750
15207 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15208
15209 @smallexample
15210 Connected to ttya.
15211 @end smallexample
15212
15213 @node Sparclet Download
15214 @subsubsection Sparclet download
15215
15216 @cindex download to Sparclet
15217 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15218 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15219 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15220 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15221 command.
15222 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15223 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15224 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15225 of each of the file's sections.
15226 For instance, if the program
15227 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15228 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15229
15230 @smallexample
15231 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15232 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15233 @end smallexample
15234
15235 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15236 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15237 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15238
15239 @node Sparclet Execution
15240 @subsubsection Running and debugging
15241
15242 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15243 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15244 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15245 manual for the list of commands.
15246
15247 @smallexample
15248 (gdbslet) b main
15249 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15250 (gdbslet) run
15251 Starting program: prog
15252 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15253 3 char *symarg = 0;
15254 (gdbslet) step
15255 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15256 (gdbslet)
15257 @end smallexample
15258
15259 @node Sparclite
15260 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15261
15262 @table @code
15263
15264 @kindex target sparclite
15265 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15266 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15267 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15268 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15269 remote protocol.
15270
15271 @end table
15272
15273 @node ST2000
15274 @subsection Tandem ST2000
15275
15276 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
15277 STDBUG protocol.
15278
15279 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
15280 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
15281
15282 @smallexample
15283 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
15284 @end smallexample
15285
15286 @noindent
15287 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
15288 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
15289 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
15290 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
15291 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15292
15293 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
15294 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
15295 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
15296 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
15297 available on your host computer.
15298 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
15299 @c basically hearsay.
15300
15301 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
15302 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
15303 environment:
15304
15305 @table @code
15306 @item st2000 @var{command}
15307 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
15308 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
15309 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
15310 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
15311 manual for available commands.
15312
15313 @item connect
15314 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
15315 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
15316 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
15317 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
15318 @kbd{@key{RET} ~ .} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
15319 @kbd{@key{RET} ~ Ctrl-d} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
15320 @end table
15321
15322 @node Z8000
15323 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15324
15325 @cindex Z8000
15326 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15327 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15328
15329 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15330 a Z8000 simulator.
15331
15332 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15333 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15334 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15335 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15336
15337 @table @code
15338 @item target sim @var{args}
15339 @kindex sim
15340 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15341 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15342 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15343 @end table
15344
15345 @noindent
15346 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15347 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15348 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15349 to run your program, and so on.
15350
15351 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15352 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15353 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15354
15355 @table @code
15356
15357 @item cycles
15358 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15359
15360 @item insts
15361 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15362
15363 @item time
15364 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15365
15366 @end table
15367
15368 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15369 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15370 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15371 simulated clock ticks.
15372
15373 @node AVR
15374 @subsection Atmel AVR
15375 @cindex AVR
15376
15377 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15378 following AVR-specific commands:
15379
15380 @table @code
15381 @item info io_registers
15382 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15383 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15384 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15385 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15386 @end table
15387
15388 @node CRIS
15389 @subsection CRIS
15390 @cindex CRIS
15391
15392 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15393 following CRIS-specific commands:
15394
15395 @table @code
15396 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15397 @cindex CRIS version
15398 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15399 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15400 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15401
15402 @item show cris-version
15403 Show the current CRIS version.
15404
15405 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15406 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15407 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15408 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15409 @code{R59}.
15410
15411 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15412 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15413
15414 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15415 @cindex CRIS mode
15416 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15417 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15418 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15419
15420 @item show cris-mode
15421 Show the current CRIS mode.
15422 @end table
15423
15424 @node Super-H
15425 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15426 @cindex Super-H
15427
15428 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15429 commands:
15430
15431 @table @code
15432 @item regs
15433 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15434 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15435 @end table
15436
15437 @node WinCE
15438 @subsection Windows CE
15439 @cindex Windows CE
15440
15441 The following commands are available for Windows CE:
15442
15443 @table @code
15444 @item set remotedirectory @var{dir}
15445 @kindex set remotedirectory
15446 Tell @value{GDBN} to upload files from the named directory @var{dir}.
15447 The default is @file{/gdb}, i.e.@: the root directory on the current
15448 drive.
15449
15450 @item show remotedirectory
15451 @kindex show remotedirectory
15452 Show the current value of the upload directory.
15453
15454 @item set remoteupload @var{method}
15455 @kindex set remoteupload
15456 Set the method used to upload files to remote device. Valid values
15457 for @var{method} are @samp{always}, @samp{newer}, and @samp{never}.
15458 The default is @samp{newer}.
15459
15460 @item show remoteupload
15461 @kindex show remoteupload
15462 Show the current setting of the upload method.
15463
15464 @item set remoteaddhost
15465 @kindex set remoteaddhost
15466 Tell @value{GDBN} whether to add this host to the remote stub's
15467 arguments when you debug over a network.
15468
15469 @item show remoteaddhost
15470 @kindex show remoteaddhost
15471 Show whether to add this host to remote stub's arguments when
15472 debugging over a network.
15473 @end table
15474
15475
15476 @node Architectures
15477 @section Architectures
15478
15479 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15480 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15481
15482 @menu
15483 * i386::
15484 * A29K::
15485 * Alpha::
15486 * MIPS::
15487 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15488 @end menu
15489
15490 @node i386
15491 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific issues.
15492
15493 @table @code
15494 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15495 @kindex set struct-convention
15496 @cindex struct return convention
15497 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15498 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15499 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15500 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15501 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15502 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15503 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15504 be returned in a register.
15505
15506 @item show struct-convention
15507 @kindex show struct-convention
15508 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15509 from functions.
15510 @end table
15511
15512 @node A29K
15513 @subsection A29K
15514
15515 @table @code
15516
15517 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15518 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15519 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15520 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15521 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15522 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15523 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15524 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15525 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15526 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15527 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15528 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15529 hexadecimal.
15530
15531 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15532 @item show rstack_high_address
15533 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15534 processors.
15535
15536 @end table
15537
15538 @node Alpha
15539 @subsection Alpha
15540
15541 See the following section.
15542
15543 @node MIPS
15544 @subsection MIPS
15545
15546 @cindex stack on Alpha
15547 @cindex stack on MIPS
15548 @cindex Alpha stack
15549 @cindex MIPS stack
15550 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15551 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15552 find the beginning of a function.
15553
15554 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15555 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15556 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15557 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15558 commands:
15559
15560 @table @code
15561 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15562 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15563 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15564 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15565 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15566 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15567 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15568 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15569
15570 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15571 Display the current limit.
15572 @end table
15573
15574 @noindent
15575 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15576 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15577
15578 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15579 programs:
15580
15581 @table @code
15582 @item set mips saved-gpreg-size @var{size}
15583 @kindex set mips saved-gpreg-size
15584 @cindex MIPS GP register size on stack
15585 Set the size of MIPS general-purpose registers saved on the stack.
15586 The argument @var{size} can be one of the following:
15587
15588 @table @samp
15589 @item 32
15590 32-bit GP registers
15591 @item 64
15592 64-bit GP registers
15593 @item auto
15594 Use the target's default setting or autodetect the saved size from the
15595 information contained in the executable. This is the default
15596 @end table
15597
15598 @item show mips saved-gpreg-size
15599 @kindex show mips saved-gpreg-size
15600 Show the current size of MIPS GP registers on the stack.
15601
15602 @item set mips stack-arg-size @var{size}
15603 @kindex set mips stack-arg-size
15604 @cindex MIPS stack space for arguments
15605 Set the amount of stack space reserved for arguments to functions.
15606 The argument can be one of @code{"32"}, @code{"64"} or @code{"auto"}
15607 (the default).
15608
15609 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15610 @kindex set mips abi
15611 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15612 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15613 values of @var{arg} are:
15614
15615 @table @samp
15616 @item auto
15617 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15618 default).
15619 @item o32
15620 @item o64
15621 @item n32
15622 @item n64
15623 @item eabi32
15624 @item eabi64
15625 @item auto
15626 @end table
15627
15628 @item show mips abi
15629 @kindex show mips abi
15630 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15631
15632 @item set mipsfpu
15633 @itemx show mipsfpu
15634 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15635
15636 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15637 @kindex set mips mask-address
15638 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15639 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15640 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15641 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15642 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15643
15644 @item show mips mask-address
15645 @kindex show mips mask-address
15646 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15647 not.
15648
15649 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15650 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15651 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15652 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15653 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15654 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15655
15656 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15657 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15658 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15659
15660 @item set debug mips
15661 @kindex set debug mips
15662 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15663 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15664
15665 @item show debug mips
15666 @kindex show debug mips
15667 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15668 @end table
15669
15670
15671 @node HPPA
15672 @subsection HPPA
15673 @cindex HPPA support
15674
15675 When @value{GDBN} is debugging te HP PA architecture, it provides the
15676 following special commands:
15677
15678 @table @code
15679 @item set debug hppa
15680 @kindex set debug hppa
15681 THis command determines whether HPPA architecture specific debugging
15682 messages are to be displayed.
15683
15684 @item show debug hppa
15685 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15686
15687 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15688 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15689 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15690 given @var{address}.
15691
15692 @end table
15693
15694
15695 @node Controlling GDB
15696 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15697
15698 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15699 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15700 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
15701 described here.
15702
15703 @menu
15704 * Prompt:: Prompt
15705 * Editing:: Command editing
15706 * Command History:: Command history
15707 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15708 * Numbers:: Numbers
15709 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15710 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15711 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15712 @end menu
15713
15714 @node Prompt
15715 @section Prompt
15716
15717 @cindex prompt
15718
15719 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15720 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15721 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15722 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15723 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15724 which one you are talking to.
15725
15726 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15727 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15728 or a prompt that does not.
15729
15730 @table @code
15731 @kindex set prompt
15732 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15733 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15734
15735 @kindex show prompt
15736 @item show prompt
15737 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15738 @end table
15739
15740 @node Editing
15741 @section Command editing
15742 @cindex readline
15743 @cindex command line editing
15744
15745 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15746 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15747 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15748 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15749 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15750 debugging sessions.
15751
15752 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15753 command @code{set}.
15754
15755 @table @code
15756 @kindex set editing
15757 @cindex editing
15758 @item set editing
15759 @itemx set editing on
15760 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15761
15762 @item set editing off
15763 Disable command line editing.
15764
15765 @kindex show editing
15766 @item show editing
15767 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15768 @end table
15769
15770 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15771 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15772 encouraged to read that chapter.
15773
15774 @node Command History
15775 @section Command history
15776 @cindex command history
15777
15778 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15779 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15780 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15781 history facility.
15782
15783 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15784 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15785 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15786
15787 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15788 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
15789 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15790 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15791 pressed on a line by itself.
15792
15793 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15794 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15795 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15796 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15797
15798 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15799 history.
15800
15801 @table @code
15802 @cindex history substitution
15803 @cindex history file
15804 @kindex set history filename
15805 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15806 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15807 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15808 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15809 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15810 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15811 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15812 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15813 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15814 is not set.
15815
15816 @cindex save command history
15817 @kindex set history save
15818 @item set history save
15819 @itemx set history save on
15820 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15821 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15822
15823 @item set history save off
15824 Stop recording command history in a file.
15825
15826 @cindex history size
15827 @kindex set history size
15828 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15829 @item set history size @var{size}
15830 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15831 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15832 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15833 @end table
15834
15835 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15836 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15837
15838 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15839 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15840 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15841 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15842 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15843 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15844 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15845 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15846
15847 The commands to control history expansion are:
15848
15849 @table @code
15850 @item set history expansion on
15851 @itemx set history expansion
15852 @kindex set history expansion
15853 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15854
15855 @item set history expansion off
15856 Disable history expansion.
15857
15858 @c @group
15859 @kindex show history
15860 @item show history
15861 @itemx show history filename
15862 @itemx show history save
15863 @itemx show history size
15864 @itemx show history expansion
15865 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15866 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15867 @c @end group
15868 @end table
15869
15870 @table @code
15871 @kindex show commands
15872 @cindex show last commands
15873 @cindex display command history
15874 @item show commands
15875 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15876
15877 @item show commands @var{n}
15878 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15879
15880 @item show commands +
15881 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15882 @end table
15883
15884 @node Screen Size
15885 @section Screen size
15886 @cindex size of screen
15887 @cindex pauses in output
15888
15889 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15890 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15891 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15892 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15893 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15894 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15895 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15896 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15897
15898 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15899 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15900 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15901 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15902 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15903 width} commands:
15904
15905 @table @code
15906 @kindex set height
15907 @kindex set width
15908 @kindex show width
15909 @kindex show height
15910 @item set height @var{lpp}
15911 @itemx show height
15912 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15913 @itemx show width
15914 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15915 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15916 commands display the current settings.
15917
15918 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15919 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15920 file or to an editor buffer.
15921
15922 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15923 from wrapping its output.
15924
15925 @item set pagination on
15926 @itemx set pagination off
15927 @kindex set pagination
15928 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15929 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15930
15931 @item show pagination
15932 @kindex show pagination
15933 Show the current pagination mode.
15934 @end table
15935
15936 @node Numbers
15937 @section Numbers
15938 @cindex number representation
15939 @cindex entering numbers
15940
15941 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15942 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15943 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15944 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15945 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15946 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15947 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15948 both input and output with the commands described below.
15949
15950 @table @code
15951 @kindex set input-radix
15952 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15953 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15954 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15955 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15956 example, any of
15957
15958 @smallexample
15959 set input-radix 012
15960 set input-radix 10.
15961 set input-radix 0xa
15962 @end smallexample
15963
15964 @noindent
15965 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15966 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15967 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15968 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15969 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15970 change the radix.
15971
15972 @kindex set output-radix
15973 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15974 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15975 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15976 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15977
15978 @kindex show input-radix
15979 @item show input-radix
15980 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15981
15982 @kindex show output-radix
15983 @item show output-radix
15984 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15985
15986 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15987 @itemx show radix
15988 @kindex set radix
15989 @kindex show radix
15990 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15991 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15992 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15993 default value of 10.
15994
15995 @end table
15996
15997 @node ABI
15998 @section Configuring the current ABI
15999
16000 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16001 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16002 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16003 current ABI.
16004
16005 @cindex OS ABI
16006 @kindex set osabi
16007 @kindex show osabi
16008
16009 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16010 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16011 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16012 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16013 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16014 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16015 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16016 platform provides.
16017
16018 @table @code
16019 @item show osabi
16020 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16021
16022 @item set osabi
16023 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16024
16025 @item set osabi @var{abi}
16026 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16027 @end table
16028
16029 @cindex float promotion
16030
16031 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16032 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16033 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16034 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16035 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16036 @code{double} and then passed.
16037
16038 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16039 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16040 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16041
16042 @table @code
16043 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16044 @item set coerce-float-to-double
16045 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16046 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16047 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16048
16049 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
16050 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16051 functions.
16052
16053 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16054 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16055 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16056 @end table
16057
16058 @kindex set cp-abi
16059 @kindex show cp-abi
16060 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16061 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16062 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16063 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16064 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16065 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16066 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16067 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16068 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16069 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16070 ``auto''.
16071
16072 @table @code
16073 @item show cp-abi
16074 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16075
16076 @item set cp-abi
16077 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16078
16079 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16080 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16081 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16082 @end table
16083
16084 @node Messages/Warnings
16085 @section Optional warnings and messages
16086
16087 @cindex verbose operation
16088 @cindex optional warnings
16089 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16090 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16091 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16092 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16093
16094 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16095 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16096 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
16097
16098 @table @code
16099 @kindex set verbose
16100 @item set verbose on
16101 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16102
16103 @item set verbose off
16104 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16105
16106 @kindex show verbose
16107 @item show verbose
16108 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16109 @end table
16110
16111 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16112 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16113 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
16114 symbol files}).
16115
16116 @table @code
16117
16118 @kindex set complaints
16119 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16120 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16121 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16122 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16123 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16124
16125 @kindex show complaints
16126 @item show complaints
16127 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16128
16129 @end table
16130
16131 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16132 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16133 you try to run a program which is already running:
16134
16135 @smallexample
16136 (@value{GDBP}) run
16137 The program being debugged has been started already.
16138 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16139 @end smallexample
16140
16141 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16142 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16143
16144 @table @code
16145
16146 @kindex set confirm
16147 @cindex flinching
16148 @cindex confirmation
16149 @cindex stupid questions
16150 @item set confirm off
16151 Disables confirmation requests.
16152
16153 @item set confirm on
16154 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16155
16156 @kindex show confirm
16157 @item show confirm
16158 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16159
16160 @end table
16161
16162 @cindex command tracing
16163 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16164 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16165 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16166 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16167
16168 @table @code
16169 @kindex set trace-commands
16170 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16171 @item set trace-commands on
16172 Enable command tracing.
16173 @item set trace-commands off
16174 Disable command tracing.
16175 @item show trace-commands
16176 Display the current state of command tracing.
16177 @end table
16178
16179 @node Debugging Output
16180 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
16181 @cindex optional debugging messages
16182
16183 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16184 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16185 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16186 section documents those commands.
16187
16188 @table @code
16189 @kindex set exec-done-display
16190 @item set exec-done-display
16191 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16192 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16193 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16194 @kindex show exec-done-display
16195 @item show exec-done-display
16196 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16197 notification.
16198 @kindex set debug
16199 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16200 @cindex architecture debugging info
16201 @item set debug arch
16202 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16203 @kindex show debug
16204 @item show debug arch
16205 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16206 @item set debug aix-thread
16207 @cindex AIX threads
16208 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16209 module.
16210 @item show debug aix-thread
16211 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16212 @item set debug event
16213 @cindex event debugging info
16214 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16215 default is off.
16216 @item show debug event
16217 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16218 info.
16219 @item set debug expression
16220 @cindex expression debugging info
16221 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16222 expression parsing. The default is off.
16223 @item show debug expression
16224 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16225 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16226 @item set debug frame
16227 @cindex frame debugging info
16228 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16229 default is off.
16230 @item show debug frame
16231 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16232 info.
16233 @item set debug infrun
16234 @cindex inferior debugging info
16235 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16236 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16237 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16238 @item show debug infrun
16239 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16240 @item set debug lin-lwp
16241 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16242 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16243 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16244 @item show debug lin-lwp
16245 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16246 @item set debug observer
16247 @cindex observer debugging info
16248 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16249 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16250 @item show debug observer
16251 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16252 @item set debug overload
16253 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16254 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16255 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16256 is off.
16257 @item show debug overload
16258 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16259 debugging info.
16260 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16261 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16262 @cindex debug remote protocol
16263 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16264 @cindex display remote packets
16265 @item set debug remote
16266 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16267 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16268 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16269 @item show debug remote
16270 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16271 @item set debug serial
16272 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16273 default is off.
16274 @item show debug serial
16275 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16276 info.
16277 @item set debug solib-frv
16278 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16279 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16280 @item show debug solib-frv
16281 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16282 messages.
16283 @item set debug target
16284 @cindex target debugging info
16285 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16286 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16287 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16288 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16289 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16290 @item show debug target
16291 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16292 info.
16293 @item set debugvarobj
16294 @cindex variable object debugging info
16295 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16296 info. The default is off.
16297 @item show debugvarobj
16298 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16299 debugging info.
16300 @item set debug xml
16301 @cindex XML parser debugging
16302 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16303 @item show debug xml
16304 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16305 @end table
16306
16307 @node Sequences
16308 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16309
16310 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16311 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16312 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16313 files.
16314
16315 @menu
16316 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16317 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16318 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16319 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16320 @end menu
16321
16322 @node Define
16323 @section User-defined commands
16324
16325 @cindex user-defined command
16326 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16327 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16328 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16329 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16330 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16331 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16332
16333 @smallexample
16334 define adder
16335 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16336 end
16337 @end smallexample
16338
16339 @noindent
16340 To execute the command use:
16341
16342 @smallexample
16343 adder 1 2 3
16344 @end smallexample
16345
16346 @noindent
16347 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16348 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16349 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16350 functions calls.
16351
16352 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16353 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16354 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16355 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16356
16357 @smallexample
16358 define adder
16359 if $argc == 2
16360 print $arg0 + $arg1
16361 end
16362 if $argc == 3
16363 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16364 end
16365 end
16366 @end smallexample
16367
16368 @table @code
16369
16370 @kindex define
16371 @item define @var{commandname}
16372 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16373 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16374
16375 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16376 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16377 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16378
16379 @kindex document
16380 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16381 @item document @var{commandname}
16382 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16383 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16384 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16385 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16386 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16387 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16388
16389 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16390 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16391 does not change the documentation.
16392
16393 @kindex dont-repeat
16394 @cindex don't repeat command
16395 @item dont-repeat
16396 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16397 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16398 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16399
16400 @kindex help user-defined
16401 @item help user-defined
16402 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16403 (if any) for each.
16404
16405 @kindex show user
16406 @item show user
16407 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16408 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16409 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16410 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16411
16412 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16413 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16414 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16415 @item show max-user-call-depth
16416 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16417 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16418 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
16419 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16420 @end table
16421
16422 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16423 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16424
16425 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16426 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16427 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16428
16429 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16430 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16431 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16432 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16433
16434 @node Hooks
16435 @section User-defined command hooks
16436 @cindex command hooks
16437 @cindex hooks, for commands
16438 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16439
16440 @kindex hook
16441 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16442 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16443 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16444 before that command.
16445
16446 @cindex hooks, post-command
16447 @kindex hookpost
16448 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16449 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16450 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16451 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16452 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16453
16454 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16455 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16456
16457 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16458 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16459
16460 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16461 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16462 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16463 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16464 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16465
16466 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16467 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16468 you could define:
16469
16470 @smallexample
16471 define hook-stop
16472 handle SIGALRM nopass
16473 end
16474
16475 define hook-run
16476 handle SIGALRM pass
16477 end
16478
16479 define hook-continue
16480 handle SIGLARM pass
16481 end
16482 @end smallexample
16483
16484 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
16485 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16486 you could define:
16487
16488 @smallexample
16489 define hook-echo
16490 echo <<<---
16491 end
16492
16493 define hookpost-echo
16494 echo --->>>\n
16495 end
16496
16497 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16498 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16499 (@value{GDBP})
16500
16501 @end smallexample
16502
16503 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16504 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16505 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16506 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16507 @c or not?
16508 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16509 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16510 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16511
16512 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16513 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16514
16515 @node Command Files
16516 @section Command files
16517
16518 @cindex command files
16519 @cindex scripting commands
16520 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16521 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16522 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16523 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16524 terminal.
16525
16526 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16527 command:
16528
16529 @table @code
16530 @kindex source
16531 @cindex execute commands from a file
16532 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16533 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16534 @end table
16535
16536 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16537 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16538 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16539 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16540 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16541
16542 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16543 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16544
16545 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16546 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16547 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16548
16549 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16550 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16551 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16552 when called from command files.
16553
16554 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16555 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16556 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16557 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16558 the next command.
16559
16560 @smallexample
16561 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16562 @end smallexample
16563
16564 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16565 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16566 would be directed to @file{log}.
16567
16568 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16569 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16570 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16571 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16572 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16573 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16574 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16575 conditionally, etc.
16576
16577 @table @code
16578 @kindex if
16579 @kindex else
16580 @item if
16581 @itemx else
16582 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16583 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16584 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16585 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16586 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16587 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16588 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16589
16590 @kindex while
16591 @item while
16592 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16593 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16594 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16595 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16596 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16597 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16598
16599 @kindex loop_break
16600 @item loop_break
16601 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16602 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16603 line.
16604
16605 @kindex loop_continue
16606 @item loop_continue
16607 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16608 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16609 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16610 the controlling expression.
16611
16612 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16613 @item end
16614 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16615 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16616 @end table
16617
16618
16619 @node Output
16620 @section Commands for controlled output
16621
16622 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16623 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16624 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16625 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16626 want.
16627
16628 @table @code
16629 @kindex echo
16630 @item echo @var{text}
16631 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16632 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16633 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16634 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16635 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16636 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16637 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16638 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16639 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16640 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16641 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16642
16643 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16644 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16645
16646 @smallexample
16647 echo This is some text\n\
16648 which is continued\n\
16649 onto several lines.\n
16650 @end smallexample
16651
16652 produces the same output as
16653
16654 @smallexample
16655 echo This is some text\n
16656 echo which is continued\n
16657 echo onto several lines.\n
16658 @end smallexample
16659
16660 @kindex output
16661 @item output @var{expression}
16662 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16663 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16664 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16665 on expressions.
16666
16667 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16668 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16669 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16670 formats}, for more information.
16671
16672 @kindex printf
16673 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16674 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
16675 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
16676 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
16677 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
16678 subroutine
16679 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
16680 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
16681 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
16682 @c supported.
16683
16684 @smallexample
16685 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16686 @end smallexample
16687
16688 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16689
16690 @smallexample
16691 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16692 @end smallexample
16693
16694 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
16695 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
16696 letter.
16697 @end table
16698
16699 @node Interpreters
16700 @chapter Command Interpreters
16701 @cindex command interpreters
16702
16703 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16704 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16705 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16706
16707 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16708 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16709 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16710 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16711
16712 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16713 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16714 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16715 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16716
16717 @table @code
16718 @item console
16719 @cindex console interpreter
16720 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16721 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16722 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16723
16724 @item mi
16725 @cindex mi interpreter
16726 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16727 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16728 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16729 Interface}.
16730
16731 @item mi2
16732 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16733 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16734
16735 @item mi1
16736 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16737 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16738
16739 @end table
16740
16741 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16742 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16743 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16744 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16745 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16746 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16747 the IDE inoperable!
16748
16749 @kindex interpreter-exec
16750 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16751 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16752 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16753 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16754
16755 @smallexample
16756 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16757 @end smallexample
16758
16759 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16760 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16761
16762 @node TUI
16763 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16764 @cindex TUI
16765 @cindex Text User Interface
16766
16767 @menu
16768 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16769 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16770 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16771 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
16772 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16773 @end menu
16774
16775 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short, is a terminal
16776 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16777 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16778 commands in separate text windows.
16779
16780 The TUI is enabled by invoking @value{GDBN} using either
16781 @pindex gdbtui
16782 @samp{gdbtui} or @samp{gdb -tui}.
16783
16784 @node TUI Overview
16785 @section TUI overview
16786
16787 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
16788 @value{GDBN} runs:
16789
16790 @itemize @bullet
16791 @item
16792 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
16793 windows on the terminal.
16794
16795 @item
16796 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
16797 the TUI.
16798 @end itemize
16799
16800 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
16801 on the terminal:
16802
16803 @table @emph
16804 @item command
16805 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16806 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16807 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
16808 window is always visible.
16809
16810 @item source
16811 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16812 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16813
16814 @item assembly
16815 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16816
16817 @item register
16818 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
16819 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
16820 changed are highlighted.
16821
16822 @end table
16823
16824 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16825 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
16826 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
16827 indicates the breakpoint type:
16828
16829 @table @code
16830 @item B
16831 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16832
16833 @item b
16834 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16835
16836 @item H
16837 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16838
16839 @item h
16840 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16841
16842 @end table
16843
16844 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16845
16846 @table @code
16847 @item +
16848 Breakpoint is enabled.
16849
16850 @item -
16851 Breakpoint is disabled.
16852
16853 @end table
16854
16855 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
16856 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
16857 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
16858 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
16859 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
16860 The following layouts are available:
16861
16862 @itemize @bullet
16863 @item
16864 source
16865
16866 @item
16867 assembly
16868
16869 @item
16870 source and assembly
16871
16872 @item
16873 source and registers
16874
16875 @item
16876 assembly and registers
16877
16878 @end itemize
16879
16880 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
16881 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
16882 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
16883 are displayed:
16884
16885 @table @emph
16886 @item target
16887 Indicates the current gdb target
16888 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16889
16890 @item process
16891 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
16892 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16893
16894 @item function
16895 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16896 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16897 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
16898 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16899
16900 @item line
16901 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16902 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
16903
16904 @item pc
16905 Indicates the current program counter address.
16906
16907 @end table
16908
16909 @node TUI Keys
16910 @section TUI Key Bindings
16911 @cindex TUI key bindings
16912
16913 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16914 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
16915 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
16916 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
16917 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
16918 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
16919 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16920
16921 @table @kbd
16922 @kindex C-x C-a
16923 @item C-x C-a
16924 @kindex C-x a
16925 @itemx C-x a
16926 @kindex C-x A
16927 @itemx C-x A
16928 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
16929 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
16930 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
16931 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
16932 The screen is then refreshed.
16933
16934 @kindex C-x 1
16935 @item C-x 1
16936 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16937 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16938 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16939
16940 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16941
16942 @kindex C-x 2
16943 @item C-x 2
16944 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16945 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
16946 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16947 previous layout and the new one.
16948
16949 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16950
16951 @kindex C-x o
16952 @item C-x o
16953 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16954 (like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
16955 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16956
16957 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16958
16959 @kindex C-x s
16960 @item C-x s
16961 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
16962 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16963
16964 @end table
16965
16966 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
16967
16968 @table @key
16969 @kindex PgUp
16970 @item PgUp
16971 Scroll the active window one page up.
16972
16973 @kindex PgDn
16974 @item PgDn
16975 Scroll the active window one page down.
16976
16977 @kindex Up
16978 @item Up
16979 Scroll the active window one line up.
16980
16981 @kindex Down
16982 @item Down
16983 Scroll the active window one line down.
16984
16985 @kindex Left
16986 @item Left
16987 Scroll the active window one column left.
16988
16989 @kindex Right
16990 @item Right
16991 Scroll the active window one column right.
16992
16993 @kindex C-L
16994 @item C-L
16995 Refresh the screen.
16996
16997 @end table
16998
16999 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
17000 for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
17001 active window is the command window. When the command window
17002 does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
17003 key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b} and @kbd{C-f}.
17004
17005 @node TUI Single Key Mode
17006 @section TUI Single Key Mode
17007 @cindex TUI single key mode
17008
17009 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
17010 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
17011 some gdb commands.
17012
17013 @table @kbd
17014 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17015 @item c
17016 continue
17017
17018 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17019 @item d
17020 down
17021
17022 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17023 @item f
17024 finish
17025
17026 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17027 @item n
17028 next
17029
17030 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17031 @item q
17032 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
17033
17034 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17035 @item r
17036 run
17037
17038 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17039 @item s
17040 step
17041
17042 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17043 @item u
17044 up
17045
17046 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17047 @item v
17048 info locals
17049
17050 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17051 @item w
17052 where
17053
17054 @end table
17055
17056 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17057 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17058 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17059 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17060 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17061 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17062
17063
17064 @node TUI Commands
17065 @section TUI specific commands
17066 @cindex TUI commands
17067
17068 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17069 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
17070 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
17071 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
17072 in the TUI mode.
17073
17074 @table @code
17075 @item info win
17076 @kindex info win
17077 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17078
17079 @item layout next
17080 @kindex layout
17081 Display the next layout.
17082
17083 @item layout prev
17084 Display the previous layout.
17085
17086 @item layout src
17087 Display the source window only.
17088
17089 @item layout asm
17090 Display the assembly window only.
17091
17092 @item layout split
17093 Display the source and assembly window.
17094
17095 @item layout regs
17096 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17097
17098 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
17099 @kindex focus
17100 Set the focus to the named window.
17101 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
17102 can be affected to another window.
17103
17104 @item refresh
17105 @kindex refresh
17106 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17107
17108 @item tui reg float
17109 @kindex tui reg
17110 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17111
17112 @item tui reg general
17113 Show the general registers in the register window.
17114
17115 @item tui reg next
17116 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17117 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17118 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17119 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17120
17121 @item tui reg system
17122 Show the system registers in the register window.
17123
17124 @item update
17125 @kindex update
17126 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17127
17128 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17129 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17130 @kindex winheight
17131 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17132 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17133 decrease it.
17134
17135 @item tabset
17136 @kindex tabset @var{nchars}
17137 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17138
17139 @end table
17140
17141 @node TUI Configuration
17142 @section TUI configuration variables
17143 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17144
17145 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
17146 appearance of windows on the terminal.
17147
17148 @table @code
17149 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17150 @kindex set tui border-kind
17151 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17152 The possible values are the following:
17153 @table @code
17154 @item space
17155 Use a space character to draw the border.
17156
17157 @item ascii
17158 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
17159
17160 @item acs
17161 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17162 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17163
17164 @end table
17165
17166 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17167 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17168 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
17169 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
17170 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
17171
17172 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17173 @kindex set tui border-mode
17174 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
17175 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17176 @table @code
17177 @item normal
17178 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17179
17180 @item standout
17181 Use standout mode.
17182
17183 @item reverse
17184 Use reverse video mode.
17185
17186 @item half
17187 Use half bright mode.
17188
17189 @item half-standout
17190 Use half bright and standout mode.
17191
17192 @item bold
17193 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17194
17195 @item bold-standout
17196 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17197
17198 @end table
17199
17200 @end table
17201
17202 @node Emacs
17203 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17204
17205 @cindex Emacs
17206 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17207 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17208 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17209 @value{GDBN}.
17210
17211 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17212 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17213 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17214 created Emacs buffer.
17215 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17216
17217 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17218 things:
17219
17220 @itemize @bullet
17221 @item
17222 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
17223 @end itemize
17224
17225 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17226 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17227
17228 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17229 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17230 in this way.
17231
17232 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17233 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17234 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17235 stop.
17236
17237 @itemize @bullet
17238 @item
17239 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17240 @end itemize
17241
17242 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17243 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17244 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17245 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17246 and the source.
17247
17248 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17249 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17250
17251 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17252 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17253 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17254 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17255 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17256 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17257 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17258 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17259 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17260
17261 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17262 line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
17263 the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
17264 on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
17265
17266 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17267 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17268 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17269 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17270 one you want.
17271
17272 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17273 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17274
17275 @table @kbd
17276 @item C-h m
17277 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
17278
17279 @item C-c C-s
17280 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17281 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17282
17283 @item C-c C-n
17284 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17285 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17286 to show the current file and location.
17287
17288 @item C-c C-i
17289 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17290 display window accordingly.
17291
17292 @item C-c C-f
17293 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17294 @code{finish} command.
17295
17296 @item C-c C-r
17297 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17298 command.
17299
17300 @item C-c <
17301 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17302 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17303 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17304
17305 @item C-c >
17306 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17307 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17308 @end table
17309
17310 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17311 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17312
17313 If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
17314 shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
17315 point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
17316 current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
17317 Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
17318 current one.
17319
17320 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17321 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17322 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17323 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17324 frame.
17325
17326 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17327 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17328 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17329 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17330 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17331 to correspond properly with the code.
17332
17333 The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
17334 detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
17335 the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
17336
17337 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17338 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17339 @ignore
17340 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17341 @kindex Epoch
17342 @kindex inspect
17343
17344 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17345 called the @code{epoch}
17346 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17347 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17348 each value is printed in its own window.
17349 @end ignore
17350
17351
17352 @node GDB/MI
17353 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17354
17355 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17356
17357 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17358 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17359 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17360 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17361 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17362 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17363
17364 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17365 in the form of a reference manual.
17366
17367 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17368 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17369 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17370
17371 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17372
17373 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17374 This chapter uses the following notation:
17375
17376 @itemize @bullet
17377 @item
17378 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17379
17380 @item
17381 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17382 it may or may not be given.
17383
17384 @item
17385 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17386 may repeat zero or more times.
17387
17388 @item
17389 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17390 may repeat one or more times.
17391
17392 @item
17393 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17394 @end itemize
17395
17396 @ignore
17397 @heading Dependencies
17398 @end ignore
17399
17400 @menu
17401 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17402 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17403 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17404 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17405 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17406 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17407 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17408 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17409 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17410 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17411 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17412 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17413 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17414 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17415 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17416 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17417 @ignore
17418 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17419 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17420 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17421 @end ignore
17422 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17423 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17424 @end menu
17425
17426 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17427 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17428 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17429
17430 @menu
17431 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17432 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17433 @end menu
17434
17435 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17436 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17437
17438 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17439 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17440 @table @code
17441 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17442 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17443
17444 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17445 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17446 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17447
17448 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17449 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17450 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17451
17452 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17453 "any sequence of digits"
17454
17455 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17456 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17457
17458 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17459 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17460
17461 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17462 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17463
17464 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17465 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17466 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17467
17468 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17469 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17470
17471 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17472 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17473 @end table
17474
17475 @noindent
17476 Notes:
17477
17478 @itemize @bullet
17479 @item
17480 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17481 output is described below.
17482
17483 @item
17484 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17485 finishes.
17486
17487 @item
17488 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17489 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17490 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17491 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17492 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17493 @end itemize
17494
17495 Pragmatics:
17496
17497 @itemize @bullet
17498 @item
17499 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17500
17501 @item
17502 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17503 @end itemize
17504
17505 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17506 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17507
17508 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17509 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17510 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17511 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17512 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17513 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17514
17515 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17516 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17517 @var{token}.
17518
17519 @table @code
17520 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17521 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17522
17523 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17524 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17525
17526 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17527 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17528
17529 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17530 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17531
17532 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17533 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17534
17535 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17536 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17537
17538 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17539 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17540
17541 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17542 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17543
17544 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17545 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17546
17547 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17548 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17549 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17550
17551 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17552 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17553
17554 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17555 @code{ @var{string} }
17556
17557 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17558 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17559
17560 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17561 @code{@var{c-string}}
17562
17563 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17564 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17565
17566 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17567 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17568 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17569
17570 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17571 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17572
17573 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17574 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17575
17576 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17577 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17578
17579 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17580 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17581
17582 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17583 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17584
17585 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17586 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17587 @end table
17588
17589 @noindent
17590 Notes:
17591
17592 @itemize @bullet
17593 @item
17594 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17595
17596 @item
17597 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17598 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17599 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17600 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17601
17602 @item
17603 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17604 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17605 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17606 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17607
17608 @item
17609 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17610 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17611 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17612 @samp{*}.
17613
17614 @item
17615 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17616 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17617 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17618 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17619
17620 @item
17621 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17622 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17623 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17624 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17625
17626 @item
17627 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17628 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17629 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17630
17631 @item
17632 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17633 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17634 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17635 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17636
17637 @item
17638 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17639 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17640 @var{values}.
17641
17642
17643 @end itemize
17644
17645 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17646 details about the various output records.
17647
17648 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17649 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17650 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17651
17652 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17653 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17654
17655 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17656 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17657 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17658 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17659 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17660 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17661
17662 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17663 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17664 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17665
17666 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17667 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17668 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17669 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17670
17671 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17672 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17673
17674 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17675 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17676 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17677 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17678 might change.
17679
17680 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17681 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17682 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17683 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17684
17685 @itemize @bullet
17686 @item
17687 New MI commands may be added.
17688
17689 @item
17690 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17691
17692 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17693 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17694
17695 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17696 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17697 @end itemize
17698
17699 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17700 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17701 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17702 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17703 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17704
17705 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17706 @c version?
17707
17708 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17709 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17710 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17711 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17712 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17713 Group, which has the aim of creating a a more general MI protocol
17714 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17715 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17716 @cindex mailing lists
17717
17718 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17719 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17720 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17721
17722 @menu
17723 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17724 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17725 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17726 @end menu
17727
17728 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17729 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17730
17731 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17732 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17733 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17734 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17735
17736 @table @code
17737 @findex ^done
17738 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17739 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17740 values.
17741
17742 @item "^running"
17743 @findex ^running
17744 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17745 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17746 running.
17747
17748 @item "^connected"
17749 @findex ^connected
17750 GDB has connected to a remote target.
17751
17752 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17753 @findex ^error
17754 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17755 error message.
17756
17757 @item "^exit"
17758 @findex ^exit
17759 GDB has terminated.
17760
17761 @end table
17762
17763 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17764 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17765
17766 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17767 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17768 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17769 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17770 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17771
17772 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17773 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17774 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17775 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17776 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17777
17778 @table @code
17779 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17780 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17781 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17782
17783 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17784 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17785 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17786 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17787
17788 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17789 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17790 internals.
17791 @end table
17792
17793 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17794 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17795
17796 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17797 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17798 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17799 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17800 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17801 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17802
17803 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17804 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17805
17806 @table @code
17807 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17808 @end table
17809
17810 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17811
17812 @table @code
17813 @item breakpoint-hit
17814 A breakpoint was reached.
17815 @item watchpoint-trigger
17816 A watchpoint was triggered.
17817 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17818 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17819 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17820 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17821 @item function-finished
17822 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17823 @item location-reached
17824 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17825 @item watchpoint-scope
17826 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17827 @item end-stepping-range
17828 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17829 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17830 @item exited-signalled
17831 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17832 @item exited
17833 The inferior exited.
17834 @item exited-normally
17835 The inferior exited normally.
17836 @item signal-received
17837 A signal was received by the inferior.
17838 @end table
17839
17840
17841 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17842 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17843 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17844 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17845
17846 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17847 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17848 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17849 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17850
17851 Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17852 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17853
17854 @subheading Setting a breakpoint
17855
17856 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17857 information of the breakpoint.
17858
17859 @smallexample
17860 -> -break-insert main
17861 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17862 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17863 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17864 <- (gdb)
17865 @end smallexample
17866
17867 @subheading Program Execution
17868
17869 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17870 reason that execution stopped.
17871
17872 @smallexample
17873 -> -exec-run
17874 <- ^running
17875 <- (gdb)
17876 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17877 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17878 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17879 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17880 <- (gdb)
17881 -> -exec-continue
17882 <- ^running
17883 <- (gdb)
17884 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17885 <- (gdb)
17886 @end smallexample
17887
17888 @subheading Quitting GDB
17889
17890 Quitting GDB just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17891
17892 @smallexample
17893 -> (gdb)
17894 <- -gdb-exit
17895 <- ^exit
17896 @end smallexample
17897
17898 @subheading A Bad Command
17899
17900 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17901
17902 @smallexample
17903 -> -rubbish
17904 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17905 <- (gdb)
17906 @end smallexample
17907
17908
17909 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17910 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17911 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17912
17913 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17914 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17915
17916 @subheading Motivation
17917
17918 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17919
17920 @subheading Introduction
17921
17922 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17923
17924 @subheading Commands
17925
17926 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17927
17928 @subsubheading Synopsis
17929
17930 @smallexample
17931 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17932 @end smallexample
17933
17934 @subsubheading Result
17935
17936 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17937
17938 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17939
17940 @subsubheading Example
17941
17942 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17943 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
17944
17945
17946 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17947 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
17948 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
17949
17950 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17951 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17952 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17953 breakpoints.
17954
17955 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17956 @findex -break-after
17957
17958 @subsubheading Synopsis
17959
17960 @smallexample
17961 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17962 @end smallexample
17963
17964 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17965 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17966 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17967 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17968
17969 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17970
17971 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17972
17973 @subsubheading Example
17974
17975 @smallexample
17976 (gdb)
17977 -break-insert main
17978 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
17979 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
17980 (gdb)
17981 -break-after 1 3
17982 ~
17983 ^done
17984 (gdb)
17985 -break-list
17986 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17987 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17988 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17989 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17990 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17991 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17992 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17993 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17994 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17995 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17996 (gdb)
17997 @end smallexample
17998
17999 @ignore
18000 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18001 @findex -break-catch
18002
18003 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
18004 @findex -break-commands
18005 @end ignore
18006
18007
18008 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
18009 @findex -break-condition
18010
18011 @subsubheading Synopsis
18012
18013 @smallexample
18014 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
18015 @end smallexample
18016
18017 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
18018 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
18019 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
18020 command below).
18021
18022 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18023
18024 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
18025
18026 @subsubheading Example
18027
18028 @smallexample
18029 (gdb)
18030 -break-condition 1 1
18031 ^done
18032 (gdb)
18033 -break-list
18034 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18035 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18036 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18037 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18038 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18039 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18040 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18041 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18042 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18043 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18044 (gdb)
18045 @end smallexample
18046
18047 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
18048 @findex -break-delete
18049
18050 @subsubheading Synopsis
18051
18052 @smallexample
18053 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18054 @end smallexample
18055
18056 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18057 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18058
18059 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18060
18061 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18062
18063 @subsubheading Example
18064
18065 @smallexample
18066 (gdb)
18067 -break-delete 1
18068 ^done
18069 (gdb)
18070 -break-list
18071 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18072 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18073 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18074 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18075 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18076 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18077 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18078 body=[]@}
18079 (gdb)
18080 @end smallexample
18081
18082 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18083 @findex -break-disable
18084
18085 @subsubheading Synopsis
18086
18087 @smallexample
18088 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18089 @end smallexample
18090
18091 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18092 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18093
18094 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18095
18096 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18097
18098 @subsubheading Example
18099
18100 @smallexample
18101 (gdb)
18102 -break-disable 2
18103 ^done
18104 (gdb)
18105 -break-list
18106 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18107 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18108 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18109 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18110 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18111 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18112 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18113 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18114 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18115 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18116 (gdb)
18117 @end smallexample
18118
18119 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18120 @findex -break-enable
18121
18122 @subsubheading Synopsis
18123
18124 @smallexample
18125 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18126 @end smallexample
18127
18128 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18129
18130 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18131
18132 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18133
18134 @subsubheading Example
18135
18136 @smallexample
18137 (gdb)
18138 -break-enable 2
18139 ^done
18140 (gdb)
18141 -break-list
18142 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18143 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18144 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18145 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18146 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18147 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18148 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18149 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18150 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18151 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18152 (gdb)
18153 @end smallexample
18154
18155 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18156 @findex -break-info
18157
18158 @subsubheading Synopsis
18159
18160 @smallexample
18161 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18162 @end smallexample
18163
18164 @c REDUNDANT???
18165 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18166
18167 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18168
18169 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18170
18171 @subsubheading Example
18172 N.A.
18173
18174 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18175 @findex -break-insert
18176
18177 @subsubheading Synopsis
18178
18179 @smallexample
18180 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
18181 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18182 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
18183 @end smallexample
18184
18185 @noindent
18186 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
18187
18188 @itemize @bullet
18189 @item function
18190 @c @item +offset
18191 @c @item -offset
18192 @c @item linenum
18193 @item filename:linenum
18194 @item filename:function
18195 @item *address
18196 @end itemize
18197
18198 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18199
18200 @table @samp
18201 @item -t
18202 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18203 @item -h
18204 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18205 @item -c @var{condition}
18206 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18207 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18208 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18209 @item -r
18210 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
18211 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
18212 expresson.
18213 @end table
18214
18215 @subsubheading Result
18216
18217 The result is in the form:
18218
18219 @smallexample
18220 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18221 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18222 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18223 times="@var{times}"@}
18224 @end smallexample
18225
18226 @noindent
18227 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18228 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18229 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18230 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18231 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18232 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18233 which use the same output).
18234
18235 Note: this format is open to change.
18236 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18237
18238 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18239
18240 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18241 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18242
18243 @subsubheading Example
18244
18245 @smallexample
18246 (gdb)
18247 -break-insert main
18248 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18249 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18250 (gdb)
18251 -break-insert -t foo
18252 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18253 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18254 (gdb)
18255 -break-list
18256 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18257 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18258 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18259 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18260 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18261 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18262 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18263 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18264 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18265 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18266 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18267 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18268 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18269 (gdb)
18270 -break-insert -r foo.*
18271 ~int foo(int, int);
18272 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18273 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18274 (gdb)
18275 @end smallexample
18276
18277 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18278 @findex -break-list
18279
18280 @subsubheading Synopsis
18281
18282 @smallexample
18283 -break-list
18284 @end smallexample
18285
18286 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18287
18288 @table @samp
18289 @item Number
18290 number of the breakpoint
18291 @item Type
18292 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18293 @item Disposition
18294 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18295 or @samp{nokeep}
18296 @item Enabled
18297 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18298 @item Address
18299 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18300 @item What
18301 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18302 name, line number
18303 @item Times
18304 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18305 @end table
18306
18307 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18308 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18309
18310 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18311
18312 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18313
18314 @subsubheading Example
18315
18316 @smallexample
18317 (gdb)
18318 -break-list
18319 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18320 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18321 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18322 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18323 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18324 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18325 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18326 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18327 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18328 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18329 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18330 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18331 (gdb)
18332 @end smallexample
18333
18334 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18335
18336 @smallexample
18337 (gdb)
18338 -break-list
18339 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18340 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18341 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18342 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18343 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18344 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18345 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18346 body=[]@}
18347 (gdb)
18348 @end smallexample
18349
18350 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18351 @findex -break-watch
18352
18353 @subsubheading Synopsis
18354
18355 @smallexample
18356 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18357 @end smallexample
18358
18359 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18360 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18361 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18362 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
18363 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18364 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18365 i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18366 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
18367
18368 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18369 breakpoints inserted.
18370
18371 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18372
18373 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18374 @samp{rwatch}.
18375
18376 @subsubheading Example
18377
18378 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18379
18380 @smallexample
18381 (gdb)
18382 -break-watch x
18383 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18384 (gdb)
18385 -exec-continue
18386 ^running
18387 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18388 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18389 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18390 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18391 (gdb)
18392 @end smallexample
18393
18394 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18395 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18396 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18397
18398 @smallexample
18399 (gdb)
18400 -break-watch C
18401 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18402 (gdb)
18403 -exec-continue
18404 ^running
18405 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18406 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18407 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18408 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18409 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18410 (gdb)
18411 -exec-continue
18412 ^running
18413 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18414 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18415 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18416 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18417 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18418 (gdb)
18419 @end smallexample
18420
18421 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18422 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18423 deleted.
18424
18425 @smallexample
18426 (gdb)
18427 -break-watch C
18428 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18429 (gdb)
18430 -break-list
18431 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18432 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18433 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18434 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18435 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18436 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18437 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18438 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18439 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18440 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18441 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18442 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18443 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18444 (gdb)
18445 -exec-continue
18446 ^running
18447 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18448 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18449 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18450 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18451 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18452 (gdb)
18453 -break-list
18454 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18455 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18456 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18457 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18458 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18459 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18460 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18461 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18462 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18463 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18464 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18465 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18466 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18467 (gdb)
18468 -exec-continue
18469 ^running
18470 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18471 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18472 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18473 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18474 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18475 (gdb)
18476 -break-list
18477 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18478 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18479 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18480 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18481 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18482 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18483 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18484 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18485 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18486 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18487 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18488 times="1"@}]@}
18489 (gdb)
18490 @end smallexample
18491
18492 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18493 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18494 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18495
18496 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18497 @findex -exec-arguments
18498
18499
18500 @subsubheading Synopsis
18501
18502 @smallexample
18503 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18504 @end smallexample
18505
18506 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18507 @samp{-exec-run}.
18508
18509 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18510
18511 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18512
18513 @subsubheading Example
18514
18515 @c FIXME!
18516 Don't have one around.
18517
18518
18519 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18520 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18521
18522 @subsubheading Synopsis
18523
18524 @smallexample
18525 -exec-show-arguments
18526 @end smallexample
18527
18528 Print the arguments of the program.
18529
18530 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18531
18532 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18533
18534 @subsubheading Example
18535 N.A.
18536
18537
18538 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18539 @findex -environment-cd
18540
18541 @subsubheading Synopsis
18542
18543 @smallexample
18544 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18545 @end smallexample
18546
18547 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18548
18549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18550
18551 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18552
18553 @subsubheading Example
18554
18555 @smallexample
18556 (gdb)
18557 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18558 ^done
18559 (gdb)
18560 @end smallexample
18561
18562
18563 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18564 @findex -environment-directory
18565
18566 @subsubheading Synopsis
18567
18568 @smallexample
18569 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18570 @end smallexample
18571
18572 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18573 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18574 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18575 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18576 occurs as normal.
18577 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18578 multiple directories in a single command
18579 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18580 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18581 If blanks are needed as
18582 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18583 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18584 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18585 character must not be used
18586 in any directory name.
18587 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18588
18589 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18590
18591 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18592
18593 @subsubheading Example
18594
18595 @smallexample
18596 (gdb)
18597 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18598 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18599 (gdb)
18600 -environment-directory ""
18601 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18602 (gdb)
18603 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18604 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18605 (gdb)
18606 -environment-directory -r
18607 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18608 (gdb)
18609 @end smallexample
18610
18611
18612 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18613 @findex -environment-path
18614
18615 @subsubheading Synopsis
18616
18617 @smallexample
18618 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18619 @end smallexample
18620
18621 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18622 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18623 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18624 supplied in addition to the
18625 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18626 occurs as normal.
18627 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18628 multiple directories in a single command
18629 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18630 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18631 If blanks are needed as
18632 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18633 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18634 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18635 character must not be used
18636 in any directory name.
18637 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18638
18639
18640 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18641
18642 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18643
18644 @subsubheading Example
18645
18646 @smallexample
18647 (gdb)
18648 -environment-path
18649 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18650 (gdb)
18651 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18652 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18653 (gdb)
18654 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18655 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18656 (gdb)
18657 @end smallexample
18658
18659
18660 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18661 @findex -environment-pwd
18662
18663 @subsubheading Synopsis
18664
18665 @smallexample
18666 -environment-pwd
18667 @end smallexample
18668
18669 Show the current working directory.
18670
18671 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18672
18673 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18674
18675 @subsubheading Example
18676
18677 @smallexample
18678 (gdb)
18679 -environment-pwd
18680 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18681 (gdb)
18682 @end smallexample
18683
18684 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18685 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18686 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18687
18688
18689 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18690 @findex -thread-info
18691
18692 @subsubheading Synopsis
18693
18694 @smallexample
18695 -thread-info
18696 @end smallexample
18697
18698 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18699
18700 No equivalent.
18701
18702 @subsubheading Example
18703 N.A.
18704
18705
18706 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18707 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18708
18709 @subsubheading Synopsis
18710
18711 @smallexample
18712 -thread-list-all-threads
18713 @end smallexample
18714
18715 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18716
18717 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18718
18719 @subsubheading Example
18720 N.A.
18721
18722
18723 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18724 @findex -thread-list-ids
18725
18726 @subsubheading Synopsis
18727
18728 @smallexample
18729 -thread-list-ids
18730 @end smallexample
18731
18732 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18733 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18734
18735 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18736
18737 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18738
18739 @subsubheading Example
18740
18741 No threads present, besides the main process:
18742
18743 @smallexample
18744 (gdb)
18745 -thread-list-ids
18746 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18747 (gdb)
18748 @end smallexample
18749
18750
18751 Several threads:
18752
18753 @smallexample
18754 (gdb)
18755 -thread-list-ids
18756 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18757 number-of-threads="3"
18758 (gdb)
18759 @end smallexample
18760
18761
18762 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18763 @findex -thread-select
18764
18765 @subsubheading Synopsis
18766
18767 @smallexample
18768 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18769 @end smallexample
18770
18771 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18772 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18773
18774 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18775
18776 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18777
18778 @subsubheading Example
18779
18780 @smallexample
18781 (gdb)
18782 -exec-next
18783 ^running
18784 (gdb)
18785 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18786 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18787 (gdb)
18788 -thread-list-ids
18789 ^done,
18790 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18791 number-of-threads="3"
18792 (gdb)
18793 -thread-select 3
18794 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18795 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18796 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18797 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18798 (gdb)
18799 @end smallexample
18800
18801 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18802 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18803 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18804
18805 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18806 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently GDB only really executes
18807 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18808 other cases.
18809
18810 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18811 @findex -exec-continue
18812
18813 @subsubheading Synopsis
18814
18815 @smallexample
18816 -exec-continue
18817 @end smallexample
18818
18819 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18820 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18821
18822 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18823
18824 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18825
18826 @subsubheading Example
18827
18828 @smallexample
18829 -exec-continue
18830 ^running
18831 (gdb)
18832 @@Hello world
18833 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18834 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18835 (gdb)
18836 @end smallexample
18837
18838
18839 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18840 @findex -exec-finish
18841
18842 @subsubheading Synopsis
18843
18844 @smallexample
18845 -exec-finish
18846 @end smallexample
18847
18848 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18849 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18850
18851 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18852
18853 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18854
18855 @subsubheading Example
18856
18857 Function returning @code{void}.
18858
18859 @smallexample
18860 -exec-finish
18861 ^running
18862 (gdb)
18863 @@hello from foo
18864 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18865 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18866 (gdb)
18867 @end smallexample
18868
18869 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18870 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18871 value itself.
18872
18873 @smallexample
18874 -exec-finish
18875 ^running
18876 (gdb)
18877 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18878 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18879 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18880 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18881 (gdb)
18882 @end smallexample
18883
18884
18885 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18886 @findex -exec-interrupt
18887
18888 @subsubheading Synopsis
18889
18890 @smallexample
18891 -exec-interrupt
18892 @end smallexample
18893
18894 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18895 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18896 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18897 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18898 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18899
18900 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18901
18902 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18903
18904 @subsubheading Example
18905
18906 @smallexample
18907 (gdb)
18908 111-exec-continue
18909 111^running
18910
18911 (gdb)
18912 222-exec-interrupt
18913 222^done
18914 (gdb)
18915 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18916 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18917 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18918 (gdb)
18919
18920 (gdb)
18921 -exec-interrupt
18922 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18923 (gdb)
18924 @end smallexample
18925
18926
18927 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18928 @findex -exec-next
18929
18930 @subsubheading Synopsis
18931
18932 @smallexample
18933 -exec-next
18934 @end smallexample
18935
18936 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18937 of the next source line is reached.
18938
18939 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18940
18941 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18942
18943 @subsubheading Example
18944
18945 @smallexample
18946 -exec-next
18947 ^running
18948 (gdb)
18949 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18950 (gdb)
18951 @end smallexample
18952
18953
18954 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18955 @findex -exec-next-instruction
18956
18957 @subsubheading Synopsis
18958
18959 @smallexample
18960 -exec-next-instruction
18961 @end smallexample
18962
18963 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
18964 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
18965 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
18966 printed as well.
18967
18968 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18969
18970 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18971
18972 @subsubheading Example
18973
18974 @smallexample
18975 (gdb)
18976 -exec-next-instruction
18977 ^running
18978
18979 (gdb)
18980 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18981 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
18982 (gdb)
18983 @end smallexample
18984
18985
18986 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
18987 @findex -exec-return
18988
18989 @subsubheading Synopsis
18990
18991 @smallexample
18992 -exec-return
18993 @end smallexample
18994
18995 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
18996 Displays the new current frame.
18997
18998 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18999
19000 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
19001
19002 @subsubheading Example
19003
19004 @smallexample
19005 (gdb)
19006 200-break-insert callee4
19007 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
19008 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19009 (gdb)
19010 000-exec-run
19011 000^running
19012 (gdb)
19013 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19014 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19015 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19016 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19017 (gdb)
19018 205-break-delete
19019 205^done
19020 (gdb)
19021 111-exec-return
19022 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
19023 args=[@{name="strarg",
19024 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19025 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19026 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19027 (gdb)
19028 @end smallexample
19029
19030
19031 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
19032 @findex -exec-run
19033
19034 @subsubheading Synopsis
19035
19036 @smallexample
19037 -exec-run
19038 @end smallexample
19039
19040 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
19041 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
19042 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
19043 the program has exited exceptionally.
19044
19045 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19046
19047 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19048
19049 @subsubheading Examples
19050
19051 @smallexample
19052 (gdb)
19053 -break-insert main
19054 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19055 (gdb)
19056 -exec-run
19057 ^running
19058 (gdb)
19059 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19060 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19061 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19062 (gdb)
19063 @end smallexample
19064
19065 @noindent
19066 Program exited normally:
19067
19068 @smallexample
19069 (gdb)
19070 -exec-run
19071 ^running
19072 (gdb)
19073 x = 55
19074 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19075 (gdb)
19076 @end smallexample
19077
19078 @noindent
19079 Program exited exceptionally:
19080
19081 @smallexample
19082 (gdb)
19083 -exec-run
19084 ^running
19085 (gdb)
19086 x = 55
19087 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19088 (gdb)
19089 @end smallexample
19090
19091 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19092 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19093
19094 @smallexample
19095 (gdb)
19096 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19097 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19098 @end smallexample
19099
19100
19101 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19102
19103
19104 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19105 @findex -exec-step
19106
19107 @subsubheading Synopsis
19108
19109 @smallexample
19110 -exec-step
19111 @end smallexample
19112
19113 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19114 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19115 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19116 function.
19117
19118 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19119
19120 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19121
19122 @subsubheading Example
19123
19124 Stepping into a function:
19125
19126 @smallexample
19127 -exec-step
19128 ^running
19129 (gdb)
19130 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19131 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19132 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19133 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19134 (gdb)
19135 @end smallexample
19136
19137 Regular stepping:
19138
19139 @smallexample
19140 -exec-step
19141 ^running
19142 (gdb)
19143 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19144 (gdb)
19145 @end smallexample
19146
19147
19148 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19149 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19150
19151 @subsubheading Synopsis
19152
19153 @smallexample
19154 -exec-step-instruction
19155 @end smallexample
19156
19157 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19158 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19159 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19160 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19161 well.
19162
19163 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19164
19165 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19166
19167 @subsubheading Example
19168
19169 @smallexample
19170 (gdb)
19171 -exec-step-instruction
19172 ^running
19173
19174 (gdb)
19175 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19176 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19177 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19178 (gdb)
19179 -exec-step-instruction
19180 ^running
19181
19182 (gdb)
19183 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19184 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19185 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19186 (gdb)
19187 @end smallexample
19188
19189
19190 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19191 @findex -exec-until
19192
19193 @subsubheading Synopsis
19194
19195 @smallexample
19196 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19197 @end smallexample
19198
19199 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19200 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19201 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19202 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19203
19204 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19205
19206 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19207
19208 @subsubheading Example
19209
19210 @smallexample
19211 (gdb)
19212 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19213 ^running
19214 (gdb)
19215 x = 55
19216 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19217 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19218 (gdb)
19219 @end smallexample
19220
19221 @ignore
19222 @subheading -file-clear
19223 Is this going away????
19224 @end ignore
19225
19226 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19227 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19228 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19229
19230
19231 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19232 @findex -stack-info-frame
19233
19234 @subsubheading Synopsis
19235
19236 @smallexample
19237 -stack-info-frame
19238 @end smallexample
19239
19240 Get info on the selected frame.
19241
19242 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19243
19244 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19245 (without arguments).
19246
19247 @subsubheading Example
19248
19249 @smallexample
19250 (gdb)
19251 -stack-info-frame
19252 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19253 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19254 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19255 (gdb)
19256 @end smallexample
19257
19258 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19259 @findex -stack-info-depth
19260
19261 @subsubheading Synopsis
19262
19263 @smallexample
19264 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19265 @end smallexample
19266
19267 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19268 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19269
19270 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19271
19272 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19273
19274 @subsubheading Example
19275
19276 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19277
19278 @smallexample
19279 (gdb)
19280 -stack-info-depth
19281 ^done,depth="12"
19282 (gdb)
19283 -stack-info-depth 4
19284 ^done,depth="4"
19285 (gdb)
19286 -stack-info-depth 12
19287 ^done,depth="12"
19288 (gdb)
19289 -stack-info-depth 11
19290 ^done,depth="11"
19291 (gdb)
19292 -stack-info-depth 13
19293 ^done,depth="12"
19294 (gdb)
19295 @end smallexample
19296
19297 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19298 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19299
19300 @subsubheading Synopsis
19301
19302 @smallexample
19303 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19304 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19305 @end smallexample
19306
19307 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19308 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19309 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19310 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19311 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19312 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19313 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19314 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19315
19316 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19317 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19318 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19319
19320 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19321
19322 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19323 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19324 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19325
19326 @subsubheading Example
19327
19328 @smallexample
19329 (gdb)
19330 -stack-list-frames
19331 ^done,
19332 stack=[
19333 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19334 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19335 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19336 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19337 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19338 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19339 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19340 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19341 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19342 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19343 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19344 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19345 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19346 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19347 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19348 (gdb)
19349 -stack-list-arguments 0
19350 ^done,
19351 stack-args=[
19352 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19353 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19354 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19355 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19356 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19357 (gdb)
19358 -stack-list-arguments 1
19359 ^done,
19360 stack-args=[
19361 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19362 frame=@{level="1",
19363 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19364 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19365 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19366 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19367 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19368 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19369 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19370 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19371 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19372 (gdb)
19373 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19374 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19375 (gdb)
19376 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19377 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19378 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19379 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19380 (gdb)
19381 @end smallexample
19382
19383 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19384
19385
19386 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19387 @findex -stack-list-frames
19388
19389 @subsubheading Synopsis
19390
19391 @smallexample
19392 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19393 @end smallexample
19394
19395 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19396 following info:
19397
19398 @table @samp
19399 @item @var{level}
19400 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
19401 @item @var{addr}
19402 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19403 @item @var{func}
19404 Function name.
19405 @item @var{file}
19406 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19407 @item @var{line}
19408 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19409 @end table
19410
19411 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19412 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19413 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19414 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19415 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19416 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19417 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19418
19419 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19420
19421 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19422
19423 @subsubheading Example
19424
19425 Full stack backtrace:
19426
19427 @smallexample
19428 (gdb)
19429 -stack-list-frames
19430 ^done,stack=
19431 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19432 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19433 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19434 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19435 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19436 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19437 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19438 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19439 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19440 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19441 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19442 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19443 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19444 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19445 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19446 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19447 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19448 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19449 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19450 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19451 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19452 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19453 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19454 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19455 (gdb)
19456 @end smallexample
19457
19458 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19459
19460 @smallexample
19461 (gdb)
19462 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19463 ^done,stack=
19464 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19465 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19466 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19467 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19468 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19469 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19470 (gdb)
19471 @end smallexample
19472
19473 Show a single frame:
19474
19475 @smallexample
19476 (gdb)
19477 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19478 ^done,stack=
19479 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19480 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19481 (gdb)
19482 @end smallexample
19483
19484
19485 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19486 @findex -stack-list-locals
19487
19488 @subsubheading Synopsis
19489
19490 @smallexample
19491 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19492 @end smallexample
19493
19494 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19495 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19496 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19497 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19498 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19499 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19500 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19501 other data types when the the user wishes to explore their values in
19502 more detail.
19503
19504 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19505
19506 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19507
19508 @subsubheading Example
19509
19510 @smallexample
19511 (gdb)
19512 -stack-list-locals 0
19513 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19514 (gdb)
19515 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19516 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19517 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19518 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19519 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19520 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19521 (gdb)
19522 @end smallexample
19523
19524
19525 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19526 @findex -stack-select-frame
19527
19528 @subsubheading Synopsis
19529
19530 @smallexample
19531 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19532 @end smallexample
19533
19534 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19535 the stack.
19536
19537 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19538
19539 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19540 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19541
19542 @subsubheading Example
19543
19544 @smallexample
19545 (gdb)
19546 -stack-select-frame 2
19547 ^done
19548 (gdb)
19549 @end smallexample
19550
19551 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19552 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19553 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19554
19555 @ignore
19556
19557 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19558
19559 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19560 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19561 used by @code{Insight}.
19562
19563 The two main reasons for that are:
19564
19565 @enumerate 1
19566 @item
19567 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19568
19569 @item
19570 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19571 now).
19572 @end enumerate
19573
19574 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19575 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19576 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19577 hints about their use.
19578
19579 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19580 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19581 least, the following operations:
19582
19583 @itemize @bullet
19584 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19585 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19586 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19587 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19588 @end itemize
19589
19590 @end ignore
19591
19592 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19593
19594 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19595 The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
19596 to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
19597 register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
19598 examining or changing its properties.
19599
19600 Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
19601 in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
19602 root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
19603 is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
19604 Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
19605
19606 When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
19607 for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
19608 creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
19609 and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
19610 chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19611 for pointers, etc.).
19612
19613 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19614 access this functionality:
19615
19616 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19617 @item @strong{Operation}
19618 @tab @strong{Description}
19619
19620 @item @code{-var-create}
19621 @tab create a variable object
19622 @item @code{-var-delete}
19623 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19624 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19625 @tab set the display format of this variable
19626 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19627 @tab show the display format of this variable
19628 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19629 @tab tells how many children this object has
19630 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19631 @tab return a list of the object's children
19632 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19633 @tab show the type of this variable object
19634 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19635 @tab print what this variable object represents
19636 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19637 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19638 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19639 @tab get the value of this variable
19640 @item @code{-var-assign}
19641 @tab set the value of this variable
19642 @item @code{-var-update}
19643 @tab update the variable and its children
19644 @end multitable
19645
19646 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19647 how it can be used.
19648
19649 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19650
19651 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19652 @findex -var-create
19653
19654 @subsubheading Synopsis
19655
19656 @smallexample
19657 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19658 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19659 @end smallexample
19660
19661 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19662 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19663 register.
19664
19665 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19666 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19667 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19668 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19669 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19670
19671 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19672 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19673 frame should be used.
19674
19675 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19676 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19677
19678 @itemize @bullet
19679 @item
19680 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19681
19682 @item
19683 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19684
19685 @item
19686 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19687 @end itemize
19688
19689 @subsubheading Result
19690
19691 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19692 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19693 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19694
19695 @smallexample
19696 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19697 @end smallexample
19698
19699
19700 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19701 @findex -var-delete
19702
19703 @subsubheading Synopsis
19704
19705 @smallexample
19706 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
19707 @end smallexample
19708
19709 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19710 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
19711
19712 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19713
19714
19715 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19716 @findex -var-set-format
19717
19718 @subsubheading Synopsis
19719
19720 @smallexample
19721 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19722 @end smallexample
19723
19724 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19725 @var{format-spec}.
19726
19727 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19728
19729 @smallexample
19730 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19731 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19732 @end smallexample
19733
19734
19735 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19736 @findex -var-show-format
19737
19738 @subsubheading Synopsis
19739
19740 @smallexample
19741 -var-show-format @var{name}
19742 @end smallexample
19743
19744 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19745
19746 @smallexample
19747 @var{format} @expansion{}
19748 @var{format-spec}
19749 @end smallexample
19750
19751
19752 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19753 @findex -var-info-num-children
19754
19755 @subsubheading Synopsis
19756
19757 @smallexample
19758 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19759 @end smallexample
19760
19761 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19762
19763 @smallexample
19764 numchild=@var{n}
19765 @end smallexample
19766
19767
19768 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19769 @findex -var-list-children
19770
19771 @subsubheading Synopsis
19772
19773 @smallexample
19774 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19775 @end smallexample
19776 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19777
19778 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19779 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19780 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19781 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19782 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19783 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19784 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19785 and unions.
19786
19787 @subsubheading Example
19788
19789 @smallexample
19790 (gdb)
19791 -var-list-children n
19792 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19793 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19794 (gdb)
19795 -var-list-children --all-values n
19796 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19797 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19798 @end smallexample
19799
19800
19801 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19802 @findex -var-info-type
19803
19804 @subsubheading Synopsis
19805
19806 @smallexample
19807 -var-info-type @var{name}
19808 @end smallexample
19809
19810 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19811 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19812 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19813
19814 @smallexample
19815 type=@var{typename}
19816 @end smallexample
19817
19818
19819 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19820 @findex -var-info-expression
19821
19822 @subsubheading Synopsis
19823
19824 @smallexample
19825 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19826 @end smallexample
19827
19828 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
19829
19830 @smallexample
19831 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
19832 @end smallexample
19833
19834 @noindent
19835 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19836
19837 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19838 @findex -var-show-attributes
19839
19840 @subsubheading Synopsis
19841
19842 @smallexample
19843 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19844 @end smallexample
19845
19846 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19847
19848 @smallexample
19849 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19850 @end smallexample
19851
19852 @noindent
19853 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19854
19855 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19856 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
19857
19858 @subsubheading Synopsis
19859
19860 @smallexample
19861 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19862 @end smallexample
19863
19864 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
19865 object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
19866 for the object:
19867
19868 @smallexample
19869 value=@var{value}
19870 @end smallexample
19871
19872 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
19873 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
19874
19875 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
19876 @findex -var-assign
19877
19878 @subsubheading Synopsis
19879
19880 @smallexample
19881 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
19882 @end smallexample
19883
19884 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
19885 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
19886 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
19887 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
19888
19889 @subsubheading Example
19890
19891 @smallexample
19892 (gdb)
19893 -var-assign var1 3
19894 ^done,value="3"
19895 (gdb)
19896 -var-update *
19897 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
19898 (gdb)
19899 @end smallexample
19900
19901 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
19902 @findex -var-update
19903
19904 @subsubheading Synopsis
19905
19906 @smallexample
19907 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
19908 @end smallexample
19909
19910 Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
19911 expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
19912 A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated. The
19913 option @var{print-values} determines whether names both and values, or
19914 just names are printed in the manner described for
19915 @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}).
19916
19917 @subsubheading Example
19918
19919 @smallexample
19920 (gdb)
19921 -var-assign var1 3
19922 ^done,value="3"
19923 (gdb)
19924 -var-update --all-values var1
19925 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
19926 type_changed="false"@}]
19927 (gdb)
19928 @end smallexample
19929
19930 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19931 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
19932 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
19933
19934 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
19935 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
19936 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
19937 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
19938
19939 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
19940 @c @subheading -data-assign
19941 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
19942 @c @subsubheading GDB command
19943 @c set variable
19944 @c @subsubheading Example
19945 @c N.A.
19946
19947 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
19948 @findex -data-disassemble
19949
19950 @subsubheading Synopsis
19951
19952 @smallexample
19953 -data-disassemble
19954 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
19955 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
19956 -- @var{mode}
19957 @end smallexample
19958
19959 @noindent
19960 Where:
19961
19962 @table @samp
19963 @item @var{start-addr}
19964 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
19965 @item @var{end-addr}
19966 is the end address
19967 @item @var{filename}
19968 is the name of the file to disassemble
19969 @item @var{linenum}
19970 is the line number to disassemble around
19971 @item @var{lines}
19972 is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
19973 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
19974 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
19975 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
19976 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
19977 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
19978 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
19979 are displayed.
19980 @item @var{mode}
19981 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
19982 disassembly).
19983 @end table
19984
19985 @subsubheading Result
19986
19987 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
19988
19989 @itemize @bullet
19990 @item Address
19991 @item Func-name
19992 @item Offset
19993 @item Instruction
19994 @end itemize
19995
19996 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
19997 directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
19998
19999 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20000
20001 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
20002
20003 @subsubheading Example
20004
20005 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
20006
20007 @smallexample
20008 (gdb)
20009 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
20010 ^done,
20011 asm_insns=[
20012 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20013 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20014 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20015 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20016 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
20017 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
20018 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
20019 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20020 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
20021 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
20022 (gdb)
20023 @end smallexample
20024
20025 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
20026 @code{main}.
20027
20028 @smallexample
20029 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
20030 ^done,asm_insns=[
20031 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20032 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20033 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20034 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20035 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20036 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20037 [@dots{}]
20038 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20039 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20040 (gdb)
20041 @end smallexample
20042
20043 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20044
20045 @smallexample
20046 (gdb)
20047 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20048 ^done,asm_insns=[
20049 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20050 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20051 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20052 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20053 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20054 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20055 (gdb)
20056 @end smallexample
20057
20058 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20059
20060 @smallexample
20061 (gdb)
20062 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20063 ^done,asm_insns=[
20064 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20065 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20066 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20067 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20068 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20069 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20070 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20071 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20072 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20073 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20074 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20075 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20076 (gdb)
20077 @end smallexample
20078
20079
20080 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20081 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20082
20083 @subsubheading Synopsis
20084
20085 @smallexample
20086 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20087 @end smallexample
20088
20089 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20090 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20091 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20092
20093 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20094
20095 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20096 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20097 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20098
20099 @subsubheading Example
20100
20101 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20102 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20103 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20104 output.
20105
20106 @smallexample
20107 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20108 211^done,value="1"
20109 (gdb)
20110 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20111 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20112 (gdb)
20113 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20114 411^done,value="4"
20115 (gdb)
20116 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20117 511^done,value="4"
20118 (gdb)
20119 @end smallexample
20120
20121
20122 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20123 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20124
20125 @subsubheading Synopsis
20126
20127 @smallexample
20128 -data-list-changed-registers
20129 @end smallexample
20130
20131 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20132
20133 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20134
20135 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20136 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20137
20138 @subsubheading Example
20139
20140 On a PPC MBX board:
20141
20142 @smallexample
20143 (gdb)
20144 -exec-continue
20145 ^running
20146
20147 (gdb)
20148 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
20149 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
20150 (gdb)
20151 -data-list-changed-registers
20152 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20153 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20154 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20155 (gdb)
20156 @end smallexample
20157
20158
20159 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20160 @findex -data-list-register-names
20161
20162 @subsubheading Synopsis
20163
20164 @smallexample
20165 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20166 @end smallexample
20167
20168 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20169 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20170 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20171 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20172 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20173 include empty register names.
20174
20175 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20176
20177 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20178 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20179 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20180
20181 @subsubheading Example
20182
20183 For the PPC MBX board:
20184 @smallexample
20185 (gdb)
20186 -data-list-register-names
20187 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20188 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20189 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20190 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20191 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20192 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20193 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20194 (gdb)
20195 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20196 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20197 (gdb)
20198 @end smallexample
20199
20200 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20201 @findex -data-list-register-values
20202
20203 @subsubheading Synopsis
20204
20205 @smallexample
20206 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20207 @end smallexample
20208
20209 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20210 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20211 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20212 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20213
20214 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20215
20216 @table @code
20217 @item x
20218 Hexadecimal
20219 @item o
20220 Octal
20221 @item t
20222 Binary
20223 @item d
20224 Decimal
20225 @item r
20226 Raw
20227 @item N
20228 Natural
20229 @end table
20230
20231 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20232
20233 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20234 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20235
20236 @subsubheading Example
20237
20238 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20239 don't appear in the actual output):
20240
20241 @smallexample
20242 (gdb)
20243 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20244 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20245 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20246 (gdb)
20247 -data-list-register-values x
20248 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20249 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20250 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20251 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20252 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20253 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20254 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20255 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20256 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20257 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20258 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20259 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20260 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20261 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20262 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20263 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20264 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20265 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20266 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20267 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20268 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20269 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20270 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20271 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20272 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20273 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20274 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20275 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20276 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20277 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20278 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20279 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20280 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20281 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20282 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20283 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20284 (gdb)
20285 @end smallexample
20286
20287
20288 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20289 @findex -data-read-memory
20290
20291 @subsubheading Synopsis
20292
20293 @smallexample
20294 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20295 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20296 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20297 @end smallexample
20298
20299 @noindent
20300 where:
20301
20302 @table @samp
20303 @item @var{address}
20304 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20305 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20306 quoted using the C convention.
20307
20308 @item @var{word-format}
20309 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20310 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20311 ,Output formats}).
20312
20313 @item @var{word-size}
20314 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20315
20316 @item @var{nr-rows}
20317 The number of rows in the output table.
20318
20319 @item @var{nr-cols}
20320 The number of columns in the output table.
20321
20322 @item @var{aschar}
20323 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20324 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20325 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20326 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20327
20328 @item @var{byte-offset}
20329 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20330 @end table
20331
20332 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20333 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20334 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20335 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20336 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20337 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20338 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20339 @samp{addr}.
20340
20341 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20342 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20343 @samp{prev-page}.
20344
20345 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20346
20347 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20348 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20349
20350 @subsubheading Example
20351
20352 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20353 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20354 word. Display each word in hex.
20355
20356 @smallexample
20357 (gdb)
20358 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20359 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20360 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20361 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20362 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20363 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20364 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20365 (gdb)
20366 @end smallexample
20367
20368 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20369 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20370
20371 @smallexample
20372 (gdb)
20373 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20374 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20375 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20376 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20377 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20378 (gdb)
20379 @end smallexample
20380
20381 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20382 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20383 used as the non-printable character.
20384
20385 @smallexample
20386 (gdb)
20387 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20388 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20389 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20390 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20391 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20392 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20393 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20394 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20395 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20396 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20397 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20398 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20399 (gdb)
20400 @end smallexample
20401
20402 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20403 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20404 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20405
20406 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20407
20408 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20409
20410 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20411
20412 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20413
20414 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20415
20416 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20417
20418 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20419
20420 @c @subheading -trace-find
20421
20422 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20423
20424 @c @subheading -trace-info
20425
20426 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20427
20428 @c @subheading -trace-list
20429
20430 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20431
20432 @c @subheading -trace-save
20433
20434 @c @subheading -trace-start
20435
20436 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20437
20438
20439 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20440 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20441 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20442
20443
20444 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20445 @findex -symbol-info-address
20446
20447 @subsubheading Synopsis
20448
20449 @smallexample
20450 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20451 @end smallexample
20452
20453 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20454
20455 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20456
20457 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20458
20459 @subsubheading Example
20460 N.A.
20461
20462
20463 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20464 @findex -symbol-info-file
20465
20466 @subsubheading Synopsis
20467
20468 @smallexample
20469 -symbol-info-file
20470 @end smallexample
20471
20472 Show the file for the symbol.
20473
20474 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20475
20476 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20477 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20478
20479 @subsubheading Example
20480 N.A.
20481
20482
20483 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20484 @findex -symbol-info-function
20485
20486 @subsubheading Synopsis
20487
20488 @smallexample
20489 -symbol-info-function
20490 @end smallexample
20491
20492 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20493
20494 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20495
20496 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20497
20498 @subsubheading Example
20499 N.A.
20500
20501
20502 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20503 @findex -symbol-info-line
20504
20505 @subsubheading Synopsis
20506
20507 @smallexample
20508 -symbol-info-line
20509 @end smallexample
20510
20511 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20512
20513 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20514
20515 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20516 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20517
20518 @subsubheading Example
20519 N.A.
20520
20521
20522 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20523 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20524
20525 @subsubheading Synopsis
20526
20527 @smallexample
20528 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20529 @end smallexample
20530
20531 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20532
20533 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20534
20535 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20536
20537 @subsubheading Example
20538 N.A.
20539
20540
20541 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20542 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20543
20544 @subsubheading Synopsis
20545
20546 @smallexample
20547 -symbol-list-functions
20548 @end smallexample
20549
20550 List the functions in the executable.
20551
20552 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20553
20554 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20555 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20556
20557 @subsubheading Example
20558 N.A.
20559
20560
20561 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20562 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20563
20564 @subsubheading Synopsis
20565
20566 @smallexample
20567 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20568 @end smallexample
20569
20570 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20571 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20572 ascending PC order.
20573
20574 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20575
20576 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20577
20578 @subsubheading Example
20579 @smallexample
20580 (gdb)
20581 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20582 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20583 (gdb)
20584 @end smallexample
20585
20586
20587 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20588 @findex -symbol-list-types
20589
20590 @subsubheading Synopsis
20591
20592 @smallexample
20593 -symbol-list-types
20594 @end smallexample
20595
20596 List all the type names.
20597
20598 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20599
20600 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20601 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20602
20603 @subsubheading Example
20604 N.A.
20605
20606
20607 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20608 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20609
20610 @subsubheading Synopsis
20611
20612 @smallexample
20613 -symbol-list-variables
20614 @end smallexample
20615
20616 List all the global and static variable names.
20617
20618 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20619
20620 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20621
20622 @subsubheading Example
20623 N.A.
20624
20625
20626 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20627 @findex -symbol-locate
20628
20629 @subsubheading Synopsis
20630
20631 @smallexample
20632 -symbol-locate
20633 @end smallexample
20634
20635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20636
20637 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20638
20639 @subsubheading Example
20640 N.A.
20641
20642
20643 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20644 @findex -symbol-type
20645
20646 @subsubheading Synopsis
20647
20648 @smallexample
20649 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20650 @end smallexample
20651
20652 Show type of @var{variable}.
20653
20654 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20655
20656 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20657 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20658
20659 @subsubheading Example
20660 N.A.
20661
20662
20663 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20664 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20665 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20666
20667 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20668 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20669
20670 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20671 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20672
20673 @subsubheading Synopsis
20674
20675 @smallexample
20676 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20677 @end smallexample
20678
20679 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20680 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20681 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20682 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20683 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20684 notification.
20685
20686 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20687
20688 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20689
20690 @subsubheading Example
20691
20692 @smallexample
20693 (gdb)
20694 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20695 ^done
20696 (gdb)
20697 @end smallexample
20698
20699
20700 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20701 @findex -file-exec-file
20702
20703 @subsubheading Synopsis
20704
20705 @smallexample
20706 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20707 @end smallexample
20708
20709 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20710 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20711 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20712 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20713 notification.
20714
20715 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20716
20717 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20718
20719 @subsubheading Example
20720
20721 @smallexample
20722 (gdb)
20723 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20724 ^done
20725 (gdb)
20726 @end smallexample
20727
20728
20729 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20730 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
20731
20732 @subsubheading Synopsis
20733
20734 @smallexample
20735 -file-list-exec-sections
20736 @end smallexample
20737
20738 List the sections of the current executable file.
20739
20740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20741
20742 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20743 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20744 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
20745
20746 @subsubheading Example
20747 N.A.
20748
20749
20750 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20751 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20752
20753 @subsubheading Synopsis
20754
20755 @smallexample
20756 -file-list-exec-source-file
20757 @end smallexample
20758
20759 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20760 to the current source file for the current executable.
20761
20762 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20763
20764 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20765
20766 @subsubheading Example
20767
20768 @smallexample
20769 (gdb)
20770 123-file-list-exec-source-file
20771 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20772 (gdb)
20773 @end smallexample
20774
20775
20776 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20777 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20778
20779 @subsubheading Synopsis
20780
20781 @smallexample
20782 -file-list-exec-source-files
20783 @end smallexample
20784
20785 List the source files for the current executable.
20786
20787 It will always output the filename, but only when GDB can find the absolute
20788 file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20789
20790 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20791
20792 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20793 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20794
20795 @subsubheading Example
20796 @smallexample
20797 (gdb)
20798 -file-list-exec-source-files
20799 ^done,files=[
20800 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
20801 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
20802 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
20803 (gdb)
20804 @end smallexample
20805
20806 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
20807 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
20808
20809 @subsubheading Synopsis
20810
20811 @smallexample
20812 -file-list-shared-libraries
20813 @end smallexample
20814
20815 List the shared libraries in the program.
20816
20817 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20818
20819 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
20820
20821 @subsubheading Example
20822 N.A.
20823
20824
20825 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
20826 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
20827
20828 @subsubheading Synopsis
20829
20830 @smallexample
20831 -file-list-symbol-files
20832 @end smallexample
20833
20834 List symbol files.
20835
20836 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20837
20838 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
20839
20840 @subsubheading Example
20841 N.A.
20842
20843
20844 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
20845 @findex -file-symbol-file
20846
20847 @subsubheading Synopsis
20848
20849 @smallexample
20850 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
20851 @end smallexample
20852
20853 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
20854 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
20855 produced, except for a completion notification.
20856
20857 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20858
20859 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
20860
20861 @subsubheading Example
20862
20863 @smallexample
20864 (gdb)
20865 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20866 ^done
20867 (gdb)
20868 @end smallexample
20869
20870 @ignore
20871 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20872 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
20873 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
20874
20875 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
20876
20877 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
20878
20879 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
20880
20881 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
20882
20883 @c @subheading -overlay-map
20884
20885 @c @subheading -overlay-off
20886
20887 @c @subheading -overlay-on
20888
20889 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
20890
20891 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20892 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
20893 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
20894
20895 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
20896
20897 @c @subheading -signal-handle
20898
20899 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
20900
20901 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
20902 @end ignore
20903
20904
20905 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20906 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
20907 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
20908
20909
20910 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
20911 @findex -target-attach
20912
20913 @subsubheading Synopsis
20914
20915 @smallexample
20916 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
20917 @end smallexample
20918
20919 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
20920
20921 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20922
20923 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
20924
20925 @subsubheading Example
20926 N.A.
20927
20928
20929 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
20930 @findex -target-compare-sections
20931
20932 @subsubheading Synopsis
20933
20934 @smallexample
20935 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
20936 @end smallexample
20937
20938 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
20939 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
20940
20941 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20942
20943 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
20944
20945 @subsubheading Example
20946 N.A.
20947
20948
20949 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
20950 @findex -target-detach
20951
20952 @subsubheading Synopsis
20953
20954 @smallexample
20955 -target-detach
20956 @end smallexample
20957
20958 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
20959 There's no output.
20960
20961 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20962
20963 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
20964
20965 @subsubheading Example
20966
20967 @smallexample
20968 (gdb)
20969 -target-detach
20970 ^done
20971 (gdb)
20972 @end smallexample
20973
20974
20975 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
20976 @findex -target-disconnect
20977
20978 @subsubheading Synopsis
20979
20980 @example
20981 -target-disconnect
20982 @end example
20983
20984 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
20985 generally not resumed.
20986
20987 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20988
20989 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
20990
20991 @subsubheading Example
20992
20993 @smallexample
20994 (gdb)
20995 -target-disconnect
20996 ^done
20997 (gdb)
20998 @end smallexample
20999
21000
21001 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
21002 @findex -target-download
21003
21004 @subsubheading Synopsis
21005
21006 @smallexample
21007 -target-download
21008 @end smallexample
21009
21010 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
21011 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
21012
21013 @table @samp
21014 @item section
21015 The name of the section.
21016 @item section-sent
21017 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
21018 @item section-size
21019 The size of the section.
21020 @item total-sent
21021 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
21022 @item total-size
21023 The size of the overall executable to download.
21024 @end table
21025
21026 @noindent
21027 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
21028 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
21029
21030 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
21031 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
21032
21033 @table @samp
21034 @item section
21035 The name of the section.
21036 @item section-size
21037 The size of the section.
21038 @item total-size
21039 The size of the overall executable to download.
21040 @end table
21041
21042 @noindent
21043 At the end, a summary is printed.
21044
21045 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21046
21047 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21048
21049 @subsubheading Example
21050
21051 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21052 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21053
21054 @smallexample
21055 (gdb)
21056 -target-download
21057 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21058 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21059 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21060 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21061 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21062 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21063 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21064 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21065 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21066 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21067 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21068 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21069 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21070 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21071 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21072 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21073 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21074 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21075 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21076 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21077 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21078 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21079 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21080 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21081 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21082 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21083 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21084 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21085 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21086 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21087 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21088 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21089 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21090 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21091 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21092 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21093 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21094 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21095 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21096 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21097 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21098 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21099 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21100 write-rate="429"
21101 (gdb)
21102 @end smallexample
21103
21104
21105 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21106 @findex -target-exec-status
21107
21108 @subsubheading Synopsis
21109
21110 @smallexample
21111 -target-exec-status
21112 @end smallexample
21113
21114 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21115 not, for instance).
21116
21117 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21118
21119 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21120
21121 @subsubheading Example
21122 N.A.
21123
21124
21125 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21126 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21127
21128 @subsubheading Synopsis
21129
21130 @smallexample
21131 -target-list-available-targets
21132 @end smallexample
21133
21134 List the possible targets to connect to.
21135
21136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21137
21138 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21139
21140 @subsubheading Example
21141 N.A.
21142
21143
21144 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21145 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21146
21147 @subsubheading Synopsis
21148
21149 @smallexample
21150 -target-list-current-targets
21151 @end smallexample
21152
21153 Describe the current target.
21154
21155 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21156
21157 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21158 other things).
21159
21160 @subsubheading Example
21161 N.A.
21162
21163
21164 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21165 @findex -target-list-parameters
21166
21167 @subsubheading Synopsis
21168
21169 @smallexample
21170 -target-list-parameters
21171 @end smallexample
21172
21173 @c ????
21174
21175 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21176
21177 No equivalent.
21178
21179 @subsubheading Example
21180 N.A.
21181
21182
21183 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21184 @findex -target-select
21185
21186 @subsubheading Synopsis
21187
21188 @smallexample
21189 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21190 @end smallexample
21191
21192 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21193
21194 @table @samp
21195 @item @var{type}
21196 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21197 @item @var{parameters}
21198 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21199 Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
21200 @end table
21201
21202 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21203 which the target program is, in the following form:
21204
21205 @smallexample
21206 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21207 args=[@var{arg list}]
21208 @end smallexample
21209
21210 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21211
21212 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21213
21214 @subsubheading Example
21215
21216 @smallexample
21217 (gdb)
21218 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21219 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21220 (gdb)
21221 @end smallexample
21222
21223 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21224 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21225 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21226
21227 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21228
21229 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21230 @findex -gdb-exit
21231
21232 @subsubheading Synopsis
21233
21234 @smallexample
21235 -gdb-exit
21236 @end smallexample
21237
21238 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21239
21240 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21241
21242 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21243
21244 @subsubheading Example
21245
21246 @smallexample
21247 (gdb)
21248 -gdb-exit
21249 ^exit
21250 @end smallexample
21251
21252
21253 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21254 @findex -exec-abort
21255
21256 @subsubheading Synopsis
21257
21258 @smallexample
21259 -exec-abort
21260 @end smallexample
21261
21262 Kill the inferior running program.
21263
21264 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21265
21266 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21267
21268 @subsubheading Example
21269 N.A.
21270
21271
21272 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21273 @findex -gdb-set
21274
21275 @subsubheading Synopsis
21276
21277 @smallexample
21278 -gdb-set
21279 @end smallexample
21280
21281 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21282 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21283
21284 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21285
21286 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21287
21288 @subsubheading Example
21289
21290 @smallexample
21291 (gdb)
21292 -gdb-set $foo=3
21293 ^done
21294 (gdb)
21295 @end smallexample
21296
21297
21298 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21299 @findex -gdb-show
21300
21301 @subsubheading Synopsis
21302
21303 @smallexample
21304 -gdb-show
21305 @end smallexample
21306
21307 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21308
21309 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
21310
21311 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21312
21313 @subsubheading Example
21314
21315 @smallexample
21316 (gdb)
21317 -gdb-show annotate
21318 ^done,value="0"
21319 (gdb)
21320 @end smallexample
21321
21322 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21323
21324
21325 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21326 @findex -gdb-version
21327
21328 @subsubheading Synopsis
21329
21330 @smallexample
21331 -gdb-version
21332 @end smallexample
21333
21334 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21335
21336 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21337
21338 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21339 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21340
21341 @subsubheading Example
21342
21343 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21344 @c box in TeX.
21345 @smallexample
21346 (gdb)
21347 -gdb-version
21348 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21349 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21350 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21351 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21352 ~ certain conditions.
21353 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21354 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21355 ~ details.
21356 ~This GDB was configured as
21357 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21358 ^done
21359 (gdb)
21360 @end smallexample
21361
21362 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21363 @findex -interpreter-exec
21364
21365 @subheading Synopsis
21366
21367 @smallexample
21368 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21369 @end smallexample
21370 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21371
21372 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21373
21374 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21375
21376 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21377
21378 @subheading Example
21379
21380 @smallexample
21381 (gdb)
21382 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21383 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21384 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21385 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21386 ^done
21387 (gdb)
21388 @end smallexample
21389
21390 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21391 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21392
21393 @subheading Synopsis
21394
21395 @smallexample
21396 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21397 @end smallexample
21398
21399 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21400
21401 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21402
21403 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21404
21405 @subheading Example
21406
21407 @smallexample
21408 (gdb)
21409 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21410 ^done
21411 (gdb)
21412 @end smallexample
21413
21414 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21415 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21416
21417 @subheading Synopsis
21418
21419 @smallexample
21420 -inferior-tty-show
21421 @end smallexample
21422
21423 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21424
21425 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21426
21427 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21428
21429 @subheading Example
21430
21431 @smallexample
21432 (gdb)
21433 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21434 ^done
21435 (gdb)
21436 -inferior-tty-show
21437 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21438 (gdb)
21439 @end smallexample
21440
21441 @node Annotations
21442 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21443
21444 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21445 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21446 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21447 relatively high level.
21448
21449 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21450 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21451
21452 @ignore
21453 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21454 @end ignore
21455
21456 @menu
21457 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21458 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21459 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21460 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21461 * Annotations for Running::
21462 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21463 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21464 @end menu
21465
21466 @node Annotations Overview
21467 @section What is an Annotation?
21468 @cindex annotations
21469
21470 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21471 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21472 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21473 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21474 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21475 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21476 cannot contain newline characters.
21477
21478 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21479 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21480 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21481 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21482 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21483 means those three characters as output.
21484
21485 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21486 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21487 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21488 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21489 is for no anntations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21490 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21491 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21492 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21493 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21494
21495 @table @code
21496 @kindex set annotate
21497 @item set annotate @var{level}
21498 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21499 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21500
21501 @item show annotate
21502 @kindex show annotate
21503 Show the current annotation level.
21504 @end table
21505
21506 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21507
21508 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21509
21510 @smallexample
21511 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21512 GNU gdb 6.0
21513 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21514 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21515 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21516 under certain conditions.
21517 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21518 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21519 for details.
21520 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21521
21522 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21523 (@value{GDBP})
21524 ^Z^Zprompt
21525 @kbd{quit}
21526
21527 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21528 $
21529 @end smallexample
21530
21531 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21532 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21533 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21534 output from @value{GDBN}.
21535
21536 @node Prompting
21537 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21538
21539 @cindex annotations for prompts
21540 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21541 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21542 over, etc.
21543
21544 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21545 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21546 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21547 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21548 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21549 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21550 features the following annotations:
21551
21552 @smallexample
21553 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21554 ^Z^Zprompt
21555 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21556 @end smallexample
21557
21558 The input types are
21559
21560 @table @code
21561 @findex pre-prompt annotation
21562 @findex prompt annotation
21563 @findex post-prompt annotation
21564 @item prompt
21565 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21566
21567 @findex pre-commands annotation
21568 @findex commands annotation
21569 @findex post-commands annotation
21570 @item commands
21571 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21572 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21573
21574 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
21575 @findex overload-choice annotation
21576 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
21577 @item overload-choice
21578 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21579
21580 @findex pre-query annotation
21581 @findex query annotation
21582 @findex post-query annotation
21583 @item query
21584 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21585
21586 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
21587 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
21588 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
21589 @item prompt-for-continue
21590 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21591 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21592 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21593 presence of annotations.
21594 @end table
21595
21596 @node Errors
21597 @section Errors
21598 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21599
21600 @findex quit annotation
21601 @smallexample
21602 ^Z^Zquit
21603 @end smallexample
21604
21605 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21606
21607 @findex error annotation
21608 @smallexample
21609 ^Z^Zerror
21610 @end smallexample
21611
21612 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21613
21614 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21615 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21616 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21617 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21618 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21619 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21620 to the top level.
21621
21622 @findex error-begin annotation
21623 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21624
21625 @smallexample
21626 ^Z^Zerror-begin
21627 @end smallexample
21628
21629 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21630 message.
21631
21632 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21633 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21634 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21635
21636 @node Invalidation
21637 @section Invalidation Notices
21638
21639 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21640 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21641 changed.
21642
21643 @table @code
21644 @findex frames-invalid annotation
21645 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21646
21647 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21648 have changed.
21649
21650 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
21651 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21652
21653 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21654 deleted a breakpoint.
21655 @end table
21656
21657 @node Annotations for Running
21658 @section Running the Program
21659 @cindex annotations for running programs
21660
21661 @findex starting annotation
21662 @findex stopping annotation
21663 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21664 @code{step} or @code{continue},
21665
21666 @smallexample
21667 ^Z^Zstarting
21668 @end smallexample
21669
21670 is output. When the program stops,
21671
21672 @smallexample
21673 ^Z^Zstopped
21674 @end smallexample
21675
21676 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21677 annotations describe how the program stopped.
21678
21679 @table @code
21680 @findex exited annotation
21681 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21682 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21683 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21684
21685 @findex signalled annotation
21686 @findex signal-name annotation
21687 @findex signal-name-end annotation
21688 @findex signal-string annotation
21689 @findex signal-string-end annotation
21690 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
21691 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21692 annotation continues:
21693
21694 @smallexample
21695 @var{intro-text}
21696 ^Z^Zsignal-name
21697 @var{name}
21698 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21699 @var{middle-text}
21700 ^Z^Zsignal-string
21701 @var{string}
21702 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21703 @var{end-text}
21704 @end smallexample
21705
21706 @noindent
21707 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21708 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21709 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21710 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21711 user's benefit and have no particular format.
21712
21713 @findex signal annotation
21714 @item ^Z^Zsignal
21715 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21716 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21717 terminated with it.
21718
21719 @findex breakpoint annotation
21720 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21721 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21722
21723 @findex watchpoint annotation
21724 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21725 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21726 @end table
21727
21728 @node Source Annotations
21729 @section Displaying Source
21730 @cindex annotations for source display
21731
21732 @findex source annotation
21733 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21734
21735 @smallexample
21736 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21737 @end smallexample
21738
21739 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21740 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21741 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21742 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21743 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21744 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21745 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21746 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21747 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21748 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21749 depend on the language).
21750
21751 @node GDB Bugs
21752 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21753 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21754 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21755
21756 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21757
21758 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21759 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21760 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21761 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21762
21763 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21764 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21765
21766 @menu
21767 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21768 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21769 @end menu
21770
21771 @node Bug Criteria
21772 @section Have you found a bug?
21773 @cindex bug criteria
21774
21775 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21776
21777 @itemize @bullet
21778 @cindex fatal signal
21779 @cindex debugger crash
21780 @cindex crash of debugger
21781 @item
21782 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21783 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21784
21785 @cindex error on valid input
21786 @item
21787 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21788 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21789 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21790
21791 @cindex invalid input
21792 @item
21793 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21794 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21795 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21796 for traditional practice''.
21797
21798 @item
21799 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21800 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21801 @end itemize
21802
21803 @node Bug Reporting
21804 @section How to report bugs
21805 @cindex bug reports
21806 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21807
21808 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21809 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21810 contact that organization first.
21811
21812 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21813 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21814 distribution.
21815 @c should add a web page ref...
21816
21817 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21818 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
21819 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21820 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21821 be used.
21822
21823 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21824 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21825 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21826 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21827
21828 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21829 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21830 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21831 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21832 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21833 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21834 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21835 bug reports to the mailing list.
21836
21837 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21838 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21839 fact or leave it out, state it!
21840
21841 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21842 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21843 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21844 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21845 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
21846 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
21847 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
21848 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
21849 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
21850
21851 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
21852 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
21853 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
21854 self-contained.
21855
21856 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
21857 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
21858 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
21859 bugs properly.
21860
21861 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
21862
21863 @itemize @bullet
21864 @item
21865 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
21866 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
21867 version}.
21868
21869 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
21870 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
21871
21872 @item
21873 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
21874 version number.
21875
21876 @item
21877 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
21878 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
21879
21880 @item
21881 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
21882 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
21883 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
21884 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
21885 compilers.
21886
21887 @item
21888 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
21889 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
21890 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
21891 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
21892
21893 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
21894 and then we might not encounter the bug.
21895
21896 @item
21897 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
21898 reproduce the bug.
21899
21900 @item
21901 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
21902 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
21903
21904 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
21905 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
21906 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
21907 a chance to make a mistake.
21908
21909 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
21910 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
21911 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
21912 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
21913 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
21914 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
21915 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
21916 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
21917
21918 @pindex script
21919 @cindex recording a session script
21920 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
21921 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
21922 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
21923 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
21924
21925 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
21926 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
21927
21928 @item
21929 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
21930 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
21931 it by context, not by line number.
21932
21933 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
21934 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
21935
21936 @end itemize
21937
21938 Here are some things that are not necessary:
21939
21940 @itemize @bullet
21941 @item
21942 A description of the envelope of the bug.
21943
21944 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
21945 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
21946 changes will not affect it.
21947
21948 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
21949 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
21950 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
21951 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
21952
21953 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
21954 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
21955 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
21956 less time, and so on.
21957
21958 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
21959 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
21960
21961 @item
21962 A patch for the bug.
21963
21964 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
21965 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
21966 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
21967 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
21968
21969 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
21970 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
21971 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
21972 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
21973
21974 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
21975 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
21976 help us to understand.
21977
21978 @item
21979 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
21980
21981 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
21982 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
21983 @end itemize
21984
21985 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
21986 @c and consists of the two following files:
21987 @c rluser.texinfo
21988 @c inc-hist.texinfo
21989 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
21990 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
21991 @include rluser.texi
21992 @include inc-hist.texinfo
21993
21994
21995 @node Formatting Documentation
21996 @appendix Formatting Documentation
21997
21998 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
21999 @cindex reference card
22000 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22001 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22002 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22003 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22004 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22005 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22006
22007 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22008 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22009
22010 @smallexample
22011 make refcard.dvi
22012 @end smallexample
22013
22014 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22015 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22016 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22017 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22018 your @sc{dvi} output program.
22019
22020 @cindex documentation
22021
22022 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22023 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22024 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22025 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22026 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22027 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22028
22029 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22030 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22031 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22032 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22033 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22034 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22035 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
22036 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
22037
22038 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
22039 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
22040 @code{makeinfo}.
22041
22042 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
22043 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
22044 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
22045
22046 @smallexample
22047 cd gdb
22048 make gdb.info
22049 @end smallexample
22050
22051 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22052 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22053 Texinfo definitions file.
22054
22055 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22056 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22057 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22058 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22059 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22060 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22061 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22062
22063 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22064 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22065 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22066 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22067 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22068 directory.
22069
22070 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22071 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
22072 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22073 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22074
22075 @smallexample
22076 make gdb.dvi
22077 @end smallexample
22078
22079 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22080
22081 @node Installing GDB
22082 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22083 @cindex installation
22084
22085 @menu
22086 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22087 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @code{configure} script
22088 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22089 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22090 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22091 @end menu
22092
22093 @node Requirements
22094 @section Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22095 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22096
22097 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22098 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22099
22100 @heading Tools/packages necessary for building @value{GDBN}
22101 @table @asis
22102 @item ISO C90 compiler
22103 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22104 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22105
22106 @end table
22107
22108 @heading Tools/packages optional for building @value{GDBN}
22109 @table @asis
22110 @item Expat
22111 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22112 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22113 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22114 The @code{configure} script will search for this library in several
22115 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22116 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22117
22118 Expat is used currently only used to implement some remote-specific
22119 features.
22120
22121 @end table
22122
22123 @node Running Configure
22124 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @code{configure} script
22125 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22126 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
22127 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22128 build the @code{gdb} program.
22129 @iftex
22130 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22131 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22132 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22133 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22134 @end iftex
22135
22136 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22137 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22138 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22139
22140 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22141 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22142
22143 @table @code
22144 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22145 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22146
22147 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22148 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22149
22150 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22151 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22152
22153 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22154 @sc{gnu} include files
22155
22156 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22157 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22158
22159 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22160 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22161
22162 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22163 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22164
22165 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22166 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22167
22168 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22169 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22170 @end table
22171
22172 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
22173 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22174 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22175
22176 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22177 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
22178 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22179 argument.
22180
22181 For example:
22182
22183 @smallexample
22184 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22185 ./configure @var{host}
22186 make
22187 @end smallexample
22188
22189 @noindent
22190 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22191 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22192 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
22193 correct value by examining your system.)
22194
22195 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22196 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22197 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22198 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22199
22200 @need 750
22201 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22202 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22203 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22204
22205 @smallexample
22206 sh configure @var{host}
22207 @end smallexample
22208
22209 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
22210 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22211 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
22212 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22213 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22214
22215 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
22216 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22217 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22218 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22219 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22220 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22221 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22222 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22223 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22224
22225 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22226 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22227 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22228 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22229 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22230
22231 @node Separate Objdir
22232 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22233
22234 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22235 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22236 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22237 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22238 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22239 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22240 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22241 program specified there.
22242
22243 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
22244 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22245 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
22246 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
22247 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22248 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22249
22250 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22251 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22252
22253 @smallexample
22254 @group
22255 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22256 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22257 cd ../gdb-sun4
22258 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22259 make
22260 @end group
22261 @end smallexample
22262
22263 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22264 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22265 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22266 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22267 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22268 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22269
22270 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22271 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22272 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22273 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22274 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22275
22276 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22277 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22278 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22279 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22280 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22281 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
22282
22283 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22284 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22285 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22286
22287 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
22288 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22289 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22290 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22291 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22292
22293 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22294 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22295 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22296 with each other.
22297
22298 @node Config Names
22299 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
22300
22301 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
22302 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22303 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22304 of information in the following pattern:
22305
22306 @smallexample
22307 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22308 @end smallexample
22309
22310 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22311 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22312 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22313
22314 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22315 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22316 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22317 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22318 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22319 abbreviations---for example:
22320
22321 @smallexample
22322 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22323 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22324 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22325 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22326 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22327 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22328 % sh config.sub sun4
22329 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22330 % sh config.sub sun3
22331 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22332 % sh config.sub i986v
22333 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22334 @end smallexample
22335
22336 @noindent
22337 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22338 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22339
22340 @node Configure Options
22341 @section @code{configure} options
22342
22343 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
22344 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
22345 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22346 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
22347
22348 @smallexample
22349 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22350 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22351 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22352 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22353 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22354 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22355 @var{host}
22356 @end smallexample
22357
22358 @noindent
22359 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22360 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22361 @samp{--}.
22362
22363 @table @code
22364 @item --help
22365 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
22366
22367 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22368 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22369 @file{@var{dir}}.
22370
22371 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22372 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22373 @file{@var{dir}}.
22374
22375 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22376 @need 2000
22377 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22378 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22379 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22380 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22381 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22382 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22383 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
22384 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22385 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
22386 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22387 @var{dirname}.
22388
22389 @item --norecursion
22390 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
22391 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22392
22393 @item --target=@var{target}
22394 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22395 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22396 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22397
22398 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22399
22400 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22401 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22402
22403 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22404 @end table
22405
22406 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22407 needed for special purposes only.
22408
22409 @node Maintenance Commands
22410 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22411 @cindex maintenance commands
22412 @cindex internal commands
22413
22414 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22415 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22416 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22417 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22418 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22419
22420 @table @code
22421 @kindex maint agent
22422 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22423 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22424 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22425 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22426
22427 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22428 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22429 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22430 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22431 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22432 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22433 is shown:
22434
22435 @table @code
22436 @item breakpoint
22437 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22438
22439 @item watchpoint
22440 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22441
22442 @item longjmp
22443 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22444 @code{longjmp} calls.
22445
22446 @item longjmp resume
22447 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22448
22449 @item until
22450 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22451
22452 @item finish
22453 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22454
22455 @item shlib events
22456 Shared library events.
22457
22458 @end table
22459
22460 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22461 @item maint check-symtabs
22462 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22463
22464 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22465 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22466 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22467
22468 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22469 @item maint cplus namespace
22470 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22471
22472 @kindex maint demangle
22473 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22474 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C manled @var{name}.
22475
22476 @kindex maint deprecate
22477 @kindex maint undeprecate
22478 @cindex deprecated commands
22479 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22480 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22481 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22482 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22483 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22484 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22485 the replacement as part of the warning.
22486
22487 @kindex maint dump-me
22488 @item maint dump-me
22489 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22490 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22491 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22492 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22493
22494 @kindex maint internal-error
22495 @kindex maint internal-warning
22496 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22497 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22498 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22499 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22500 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22501 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22502 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22503 @value{GDBN} session.
22504
22505 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22506 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22507
22508 Here's an example of using @code{indernal-error}:
22509
22510 @smallexample
22511 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22512 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22513 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22514 debugging may prove unreliable.
22515 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22516 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22517 (@value{GDBP})
22518 @end smallexample
22519
22520 @kindex maint packet
22521 @item maint packet @var{text}
22522 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22523 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22524 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22525 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22526 checksum.
22527
22528 @kindex maint print architecture
22529 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22530 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22531 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22532
22533 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22534 @item maint print dummy-frames
22535 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22536
22537 @smallexample
22538 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22539 @dots{}
22540 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22541 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22542 58 return (a + b);
22543 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22544 @dots{}
22545 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22546 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22547 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22548 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22549 (@value{GDBP})
22550 @end smallexample
22551
22552 Takes an optional file parameter.
22553
22554 @kindex maint print registers
22555 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22556 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22557 @kindex maint print register-groups
22558 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22559 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22560 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22561 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22562 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22563
22564 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22565 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22566 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22567 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22568 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22569 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22570
22571 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22572 write the information.
22573
22574 @kindex maint print reggroups
22575 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22576 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22577 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22578 information.
22579
22580 The register groups info looks like this:
22581
22582 @smallexample
22583 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22584 Group Type
22585 general user
22586 float user
22587 all user
22588 vector user
22589 system user
22590 save internal
22591 restore internal
22592 @end smallexample
22593
22594 @kindex flushregs
22595 @item flushregs
22596 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22597
22598 @kindex maint print objfiles
22599 @cindex info for known object files
22600 @item maint print objfiles
22601 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22602 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22603 and symtabs.
22604
22605 @kindex maint print statistics
22606 @cindex bcache statistics
22607 @item maint print statistics
22608 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22609 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22610 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22611 of minimal, partical, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22612 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22613 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22614 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22615 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22616 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22617 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22618 lengths.
22619
22620 @kindex maint print type
22621 @cindex type chain of a data type
22622 @item maint print type @var{expr}
22623 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22624 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22625 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22626 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22627 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22628
22629 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22630 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22631 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22632 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22633 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22634
22635 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
22636 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
22637 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
22638 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
22639 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
22640 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
22641 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
22642 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
22643 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
22644
22645 @kindex maint set profile
22646 @kindex maint show profile
22647 @cindex profiling GDB
22648 @item maint set profile
22649 @itemx maint show profile
22650 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
22651
22652 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
22653 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
22654 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
22655 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
22656 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
22657 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
22658 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
22659
22660 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
22661 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
22662
22663 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
22664 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
22665 @item maint show-debug-regs
22666 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
22667 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
22668 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when GDB inserts or
22669 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
22670 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
22671
22672 @kindex maint space
22673 @cindex memory used by commands
22674 @item maint space
22675 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
22676 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
22677 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
22678 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
22679 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22680
22681 @kindex maint time
22682 @cindex time of command execution
22683 @item maint time
22684 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
22685 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
22686 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
22687 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
22688 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22689
22690 @kindex maint translate-address
22691 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
22692 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
22693 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
22694 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
22695 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
22696 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
22697 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
22698
22699 @end table
22700
22701 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
22702 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
22703
22704 @table @code
22705 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
22706 @kindex set watchdog
22707 @cindex watchdog timer
22708 @cindex timeout for commands
22709 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22710 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22711 reports and error and the command is aborted.
22712
22713 @item show watchdog
22714 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22715 @end table
22716
22717 @node Remote Protocol
22718 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22719
22720 @menu
22721 * Overview::
22722 * Packets::
22723 * Stop Reply Packets::
22724 * General Query Packets::
22725 * Register Packet Format::
22726 * Tracepoint Packets::
22727 * Interrupts::
22728 * Examples::
22729 * File-I/O remote protocol extension::
22730 * Memory map format::
22731 @end menu
22732
22733 @node Overview
22734 @section Overview
22735
22736 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22737 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22738 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22739 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22740
22741 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22742 transmitted and received data respectfully.
22743
22744 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22745 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22746 @cindex remote serial protocol
22747 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22748 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22749 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22750 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22751
22752 @smallexample
22753 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22754 @end smallexample
22755 @noindent
22756
22757 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22758 @noindent
22759 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22760 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22761 eight bit unsigned checksum).
22762
22763 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22764 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22765
22766 @smallexample
22767 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22768 @end smallexample
22769
22770 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22771 @noindent
22772 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22773 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22774 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22775
22776 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22777 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22778 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22779 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22780 retransmission):
22781
22782 @smallexample
22783 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22784 <- @code{+}
22785 @end smallexample
22786 @noindent
22787
22788 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22789 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22790 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22791 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22792
22793 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22794 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22795 exceptions).
22796
22797 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22798 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22799 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22800 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22801
22802 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22803 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22804 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22805
22806 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
22807 @anchor{Binary Data}
22808 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
22809 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
22810 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
22811 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
22812 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
22813 binary data.
22814
22815 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
22816 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
22817 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
22818 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
22819 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
22820 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
22821 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
22822 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
22823 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
22824 (described next).
22825
22826 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22827 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22828 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22829 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22830 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22831 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
22832 value greater than 126 should not be used.
22833
22834 So:
22835 @smallexample
22836 "@code{0* }"
22837 @end smallexample
22838 @noindent
22839 means the same as "0000".
22840
22841 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
22842 error number. That number is not well defined.
22843
22844 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
22845 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
22846 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
22847 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
22848 on that response.
22849
22850 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
22851 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
22852 optional.
22853
22854 @node Packets
22855 @section Packets
22856
22857 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
22858 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
22859 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for details about the File
22860 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
22861
22862 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
22863 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
22864 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
22865 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
22866 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
22867 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
22868 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
22869 @var{baz}. GDB does not transmit a space character between the
22870 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
22871 @var{baz}.
22872
22873 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
22874 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
22875
22876 Here are the packet descriptions.
22877
22878 @table @samp
22879
22880 @item !
22881 @cindex @samp{!} packet
22882 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
22883 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
22884 debugged.
22885
22886 Reply:
22887 @table @samp
22888 @item OK
22889 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
22890 @end table
22891
22892 @item ?
22893 @cindex @samp{?} packet
22894 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
22895 step and continue.
22896
22897 Reply:
22898 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22899
22900 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
22901 @cindex @samp{A} packet
22902 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
22903 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
22904 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
22905
22906 Reply:
22907 @table @samp
22908 @item OK
22909 The arguments were set.
22910 @item E @var{NN}
22911 An error occurred.
22912 @end table
22913
22914 @item b @var{baud}
22915 @cindex @samp{b} packet
22916 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
22917 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
22918
22919 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
22920 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
22921 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
22922
22923 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
22924 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
22925 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
22926 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
22927 of view, nothing actually happened.}
22928
22929 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
22930 @cindex @samp{B} packet
22931 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
22932 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
22933
22934 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
22935 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
22936
22937 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
22938 @cindex @samp{c} packet
22939 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
22940 resume at current address.
22941
22942 Reply:
22943 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22944
22945 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
22946 @cindex @samp{C} packet
22947 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
22948 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
22949
22950 Reply:
22951 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22952
22953 @item d
22954 @cindex @samp{d} packet
22955 Toggle debug flag.
22956
22957 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
22958 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
22959
22960 @item D
22961 @cindex @samp{D} packet
22962 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
22963 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
22964
22965 Reply:
22966 @table @samp
22967 @item OK
22968 for success
22969 @item E @var{NN}
22970 for an error
22971 @end table
22972
22973 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
22974 @cindex @samp{F} packet
22975 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
22976 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
22977 remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
22978
22979 @item g
22980 @anchor{read registers packet}
22981 @cindex @samp{g} packet
22982 Read general registers.
22983
22984 Reply:
22985 @table @samp
22986 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22987 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
22988 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
22989 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
22990 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
22991 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
22992 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
22993 @item E @var{NN}
22994 for an error.
22995 @end table
22996
22997 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
22998 @cindex @samp{G} packet
22999 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
23000 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
23001
23002 Reply:
23003 @table @samp
23004 @item OK
23005 for success
23006 @item E @var{NN}
23007 for an error
23008 @end table
23009
23010 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
23011 @cindex @samp{H} packet
23012 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
23013 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
23014 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
23015 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
23016 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
23017
23018 Reply:
23019 @table @samp
23020 @item OK
23021 for success
23022 @item E @var{NN}
23023 for an error
23024 @end table
23025
23026 @c FIXME: JTC:
23027 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
23028 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
23029 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
23030 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
23031 @c described. For example:
23032 @c
23033 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23034 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
23035 @c otherwise returns current registers.
23036 @c
23037 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23038 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
23039 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
23040
23041 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
23042 @anchor{cycle step packet}
23043 @cindex @samp{i} packet
23044 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
23045 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
23046 step starting at that address.
23047
23048 @item I
23049 @cindex @samp{I} packet
23050 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23051 step packet}.
23052
23053 @item k
23054 @cindex @samp{k} packet
23055 Kill request.
23056
23057 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23058 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23059 thread?)}.
23060
23061 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23062 @cindex @samp{m} packet
23063 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23064 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23065
23066 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23067 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23068 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23069 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23070 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23071 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23072 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23073 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23074
23075 Reply:
23076 @table @samp
23077 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23078 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23079 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23080 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23081 @item E @var{NN}
23082 @var{NN} is errno
23083 @end table
23084
23085 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23086 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23087 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23088 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23089 hexadecimal number.
23090
23091 Reply:
23092 @table @samp
23093 @item OK
23094 for success
23095 @item E @var{NN}
23096 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23097 written).
23098 @end table
23099
23100 @item p @var{n}
23101 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23102 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23103 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23104 register value is encoded.
23105
23106 Reply:
23107 @table @samp
23108 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23109 the register's value
23110 @item E @var{NN}
23111 for an error
23112 @item
23113 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23114 @end table
23115
23116 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23117 @anchor{write register packet}
23118 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23119 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23120 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23121 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23122
23123 Reply:
23124 @table @samp
23125 @item OK
23126 for success
23127 @item E @var{NN}
23128 for an error
23129 @end table
23130
23131 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23132 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23133 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23134 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23135 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23136 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23137
23138 @item r
23139 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23140 Reset the entire system.
23141
23142 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23143
23144 @item R @var{XX}
23145 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23146 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23147 This packet is only available in extended mode.
23148
23149 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23150
23151 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23152 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23153 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23154 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23155
23156 Reply:
23157 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23158
23159 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23160 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23161 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23162 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23163 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23164
23165 Reply:
23166 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23167
23168 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23169 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23170 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23171 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23172 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23173
23174 @item T @var{XX}
23175 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23176 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23177
23178 Reply:
23179 @table @samp
23180 @item OK
23181 thread is still alive
23182 @item E @var{NN}
23183 thread is dead
23184 @end table
23185
23186 @item v
23187 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23188 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23189
23190 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23191 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23192 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23193 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23194 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23195 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23196 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23197 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23198
23199 @table @samp
23200 @item c
23201 Continue.
23202 @item C @var{sig}
23203 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23204 @item s
23205 Step.
23206 @item S @var{sig}
23207 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23208 @end table
23209
23210 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23211 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23212
23213 Reply:
23214 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23215
23216 @item vCont?
23217 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23218 Request a list of actions supporetd by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23219
23220 Reply:
23221 @table @samp
23222 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23223 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23224 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23225 @item
23226 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23227 @end table
23228
23229 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23230 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23231 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23232 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23233 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23234 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory map
23235 format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23236 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23237 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23238 packet is received.
23239
23240 Reply:
23241 @table @samp
23242 @item OK
23243 for success
23244 @item E @var{NN}
23245 for an error
23246 @end table
23247
23248 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23249 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23250 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23251 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23252 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23253 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23254 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23255 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23256 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23257 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23258 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23259 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23260
23261
23262 Reply:
23263 @table @samp
23264 @item OK
23265 for success
23266 @item E.memtype
23267 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23268 @item E @var{NN}
23269 for an error
23270 @end table
23271
23272 @item vFlashDone
23273 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23274 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23275 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23276 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23277 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23278 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23279 request is completed.
23280
23281 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23282 @anchor{X packet}
23283 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23284 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23285 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23286 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23287
23288 Reply:
23289 @table @samp
23290 @item OK
23291 for success
23292 @item E @var{NN}
23293 for an error
23294 @end table
23295
23296 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23297 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23298 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23299 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23300 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23301 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23302 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23303 @var{length} bytes.
23304
23305 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23306 separately.
23307
23308 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23309 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23310 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23311 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23312 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23313 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23314
23315 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23316 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23317 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23318 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23319 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23320 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23321
23322 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23323 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23324 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23325 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23326 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23327
23328 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23329 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23330 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23331 target, is not defined.}
23332
23333 Reply:
23334 @table @samp
23335 @item OK
23336 success
23337 @item
23338 not supported
23339 @item E @var{NN}
23340 for an error
23341 @end table
23342
23343 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23344 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23345 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23346 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23347 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23348 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23349
23350 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23351 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23352
23353 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23354 movement.}
23355
23356 Reply:
23357 @table @samp
23358 @item OK
23359 success
23360 @item
23361 not supported
23362 @item E @var{NN}
23363 for an error
23364 @end table
23365
23366 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23367 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23368 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23369 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23370 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23371
23372 Reply:
23373 @table @samp
23374 @item OK
23375 success
23376 @item
23377 not supported
23378 @item E @var{NN}
23379 for an error
23380 @end table
23381
23382 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23383 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23384 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23385 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23386 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23387
23388 Reply:
23389 @table @samp
23390 @item OK
23391 success
23392 @item
23393 not supported
23394 @item E @var{NN}
23395 for an error
23396 @end table
23397
23398 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23399 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23400 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23401 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23402 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23403
23404 Reply:
23405 @table @samp
23406 @item OK
23407 success
23408 @item
23409 not supported
23410 @item E @var{NN}
23411 for an error
23412 @end table
23413
23414 @end table
23415
23416 @node Stop Reply Packets
23417 @section Stop Reply Packets
23418 @cindex stop reply packets
23419
23420 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23421 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23422 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23423 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23424 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
23425 @value{GDBN} source code.
23426
23427 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23428 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23429 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23430 components.
23431
23432 @table @samp
23433
23434 @item S @var{AA}
23435 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23436 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23437 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23438
23439 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23440 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23441 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23442 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23443 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23444 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23445 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23446 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23447 @enumerate
23448 @item
23449 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23450 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23451 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23452 two-digit hex number.
23453 @item
23454 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23455 hex.
23456 @item
23457 If @var{n} is @samp{watch}, @samp{rwatch}, or @samp{awatch}, then the
23458 packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23459 hex.
23460 @item
23461 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23462 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23463 future.
23464 @end enumerate
23465
23466 @item W @var{AA}
23467 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23468 applicable to certain targets.
23469
23470 @item X @var{AA}
23471 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23472
23473 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23474 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23475 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23476 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23477 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23478
23479 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23480 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23481 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23482 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23483 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
23484 system calls.
23485
23486 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23487 this very system call.
23488
23489 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23490 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23491 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23492 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23493 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O remote
23494 protocol extension}, for more details.
23495
23496 @end table
23497
23498 @node General Query Packets
23499 @section General Query Packets
23500 @cindex remote query requests
23501
23502 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23503 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23504 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23505 sending information to and from the stub.
23506
23507 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23508 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23509 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23510 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23511 conventions:
23512
23513 @itemize @bullet
23514 @item
23515 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23516 @item
23517 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23518 letter.
23519 @item
23520 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23521 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23522 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23523 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23524 @end itemize
23525
23526 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23527 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23528 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23529 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23530 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23531 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23532 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23533 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23534 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23535 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23536 packet.}.
23537
23538 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23539 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23540 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23541 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23542 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23543
23544 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23545
23546 @table @samp
23547
23548 @item qC
23549 @cindex current thread, remote request
23550 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23551 Return the current thread id.
23552
23553 Reply:
23554 @table @samp
23555 @item QC @var{pid}
23556 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23557 @item @r{(anything else)}
23558 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23559 @end table
23560
23561 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23562 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23563 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23564 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23565 Reply:
23566 @table @samp
23567 @item E @var{NN}
23568 An error (such as memory fault)
23569 @item C @var{crc32}
23570 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23571 @end table
23572
23573 @item qfThreadInfo
23574 @itemx qsThreadInfo
23575 @cindex list active threads, remote request
23576 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23577 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23578 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23579 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23580 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23581 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23582 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23583 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23584
23585 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23586
23587 Reply:
23588 @table @samp
23589 @item m @var{id}
23590 A single thread id
23591 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23592 a comma-separated list of thread ids
23593 @item l
23594 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23595 @end table
23596
23597 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23598 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23599 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23600 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23601 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23602
23603 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
23604 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23605 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23606 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23607 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23608
23609 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23610 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23611
23612 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23613 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23614 information associated with the variable.)
23615
23616 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI specific encoding of the
23617 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23618 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23619 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23620 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23621 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23622
23623 Reply:
23624 @table @samp
23625 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23626 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23627 local storage requested.
23628
23629 @item E @var{nn}
23630 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23631
23632 @item
23633 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23634 @end table
23635
23636 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
23637 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
23638 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
23639 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
23640 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
23641 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
23642 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
23643
23644 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
23645
23646 Reply:
23647 @table @samp
23648 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
23649 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
23650 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
23651 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
23652 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
23653 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
23654 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
23655 @end table
23656
23657 @item qOffsets
23658 @cindex section offsets, remote request
23659 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
23660 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
23661 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
23662 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
23663 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
23664
23665 Reply:
23666 @table @samp
23667 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy};Bss=@var{zzz}
23668 @end table
23669
23670 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
23671 @cindex thread information, remote request
23672 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
23673 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
23674 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
23675
23676 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
23677 (see below).
23678
23679 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
23680
23681 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
23682 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
23683 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
23684 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
23685 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
23686 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
23687 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
23688 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
23689 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
23690 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
23691 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
23692 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
23693
23694 Reply:
23695 @table @samp
23696 @item OK
23697 The request succeeded.
23698
23699 @item E @var{nn}
23700 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23701
23702 @item
23703 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
23704 the stub.
23705 @end table
23706
23707 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
23708 command (@pxref{Remote configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
23709 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23710 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23711
23712 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
23713 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
23714 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
23715 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
23716 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
23717 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
23718 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
23719 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
23720 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
23721
23722 Reply:
23723 @table @samp
23724 @item OK
23725 A command response with no output.
23726 @item @var{OUTPUT}
23727 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
23728 @item E @var{NN}
23729 Indicate a badly formed request.
23730 @item
23731 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
23732 @end table
23733
23734 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
23735 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23736 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23737 packets.)
23738
23739 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
23740 @cindex supported packets, remote query
23741 @cindex features of the remote protocol
23742 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
23743 @anchor{qSupported}
23744 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
23745 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
23746 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
23747 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
23748 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
23749 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
23750 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
23751 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
23752 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
23753 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
23754 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
23755 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
23756 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
23757 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
23758
23759 Reply:
23760 @table @samp
23761 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
23762 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
23763 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
23764 possible forms).
23765 @item
23766 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
23767 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
23768 @end table
23769
23770 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
23771 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
23772 are:
23773
23774 @table @samp
23775 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
23776 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
23777 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
23778 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
23779 @item @var{name}+
23780 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
23781 need an associated value.
23782 @item @var{name}-
23783 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
23784 @item @var{name}?
23785 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
23786 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
23787 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
23788 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
23789 @end table
23790
23791 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
23792 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
23793 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
23794 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
23795 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
23796
23797 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
23798 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
23799 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
23800 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
23801 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
23802 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
23803 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
23804 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
23805 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
23806 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
23807 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
23808 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
23809 all the features it supports.
23810
23811 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
23812 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
23813
23814 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
23815 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
23816 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
23817 form response.
23818
23819 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
23820 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
23821 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
23822 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
23823
23824 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
23825 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
23826 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
23827 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
23828 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
23829
23830 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
23831
23832 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.2 0.2 0.2
23833 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
23834 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
23835 @item Feature Name
23836 @tab Value Required
23837 @tab Default
23838 @tab Probe Allowed
23839
23840 @item @samp{PacketSize}
23841 @tab Yes
23842 @tab @samp{-}
23843 @tab No
23844
23845 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
23846 @tab No
23847 @tab @samp{-}
23848 @tab Yes
23849
23850 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
23851 @tab No
23852 @tab @samp{-}
23853 @tab Yes
23854
23855 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
23856 @tab No
23857 @tab @samp{-}
23858 @tab Yes
23859
23860 @end multitable
23861
23862 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
23863
23864 @table @samp
23865 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
23866 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
23867 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
23868 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
23869 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
23870 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
23871 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
23872 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
23873 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
23874 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
23875
23876 @item qXfer:auxv:read
23877 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
23878 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
23879
23880 @end table
23881
23882 @item qSymbol::
23883 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
23884 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
23885 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
23886 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
23887
23888 Reply:
23889 @table @samp
23890 @item OK
23891 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23892 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23893 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
23894 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
23895 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
23896 below.
23897 @end table
23898
23899 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
23900 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
23901
23902 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
23903 target has previously requested.
23904
23905 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
23906 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
23907 will be empty.
23908
23909 Reply:
23910 @table @samp
23911 @item OK
23912 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23913 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23914 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
23915 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
23916 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
23917 @end table
23918
23919 @item QTDP
23920 @itemx QTFrame
23921 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23922
23923 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
23924 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
23925 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
23926 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
23927 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
23928 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
23929 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
23930 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
23931 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
23932 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
23933
23934 Reply:
23935 @table @samp
23936 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23937 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
23938 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
23939 the thread's attributes.
23940 @end table
23941
23942 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
23943 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23944 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23945 packets.)
23946
23947 @item QTStart
23948 @itemx QTStop
23949 @itemx QTinit
23950 @itemx QTro
23951 @itemx qTStatus
23952 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23953
23954 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23955 @cindex read special object, remote request
23956 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
23957 @anchor{qXfer read}
23958 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
23959 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
23960 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
23961 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object; it can supply
23962 additional details about what data to access.
23963
23964 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
23965 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
23966 formats, listed below.
23967
23968 @table @samp
23969 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23970 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
23971 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
23972 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
23973
23974 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23975 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23976 @end table
23977
23978 @table @samp
23979 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23980 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
23981 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory map format}. The
23982 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
23983 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
23984
23985 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23986 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23987 @end table
23988
23989 Reply:
23990 @table @samp
23991 @item m @var{data}
23992 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
23993 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
23994 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
23995 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
23996 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
23997 request.
23998
23999 @item l @var{data}
24000 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
24001 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
24002 than the @var{length} in the request.
24003
24004 @item l
24005 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
24006 There is no more data to be read.
24007
24008 @item E00
24009 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24010
24011 @item E @var{nn}
24012 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
24013 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24014
24015 @item
24016 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
24017 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
24018 @end table
24019
24020 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24021 @cindex write data into object, remote request
24022 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
24023 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
24024 into the data. @samp{@var{data}@dots{}} is the binary-encoded data
24025 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
24026 is specific to the object; it can supply additional details about what data
24027 to access.
24028
24029 No requests of this form are presently in use. This specification
24030 serves as a placeholder to document the common format that new
24031 specific request specifications ought to use.
24032
24033 Reply:
24034 @table @samp
24035 @item @var{nn}
24036 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
24037 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
24038
24039 @item E00
24040 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24041
24042 @item E @var{nn}
24043 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
24044 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24045
24046 @item
24047 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
24048 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
24049 @end table
24050
24051 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
24052 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
24053 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
24054 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
24055 must respond with an empty packet.
24056
24057 @end table
24058
24059 @node Register Packet Format
24060 @section Register Packet Format
24061
24062 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
24063 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
24064 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
24065 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
24066 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
24067 most-significant - least-significant.
24068
24069 @table @r
24070
24071 @item MIPS32
24072
24073 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
24074 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24075 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24076
24077 @item MIPS64
24078
24079 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
24080 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
24081 as @code{MIPS32}.
24082
24083 @end table
24084
24085 @node Tracepoint Packets
24086 @section Tracepoint Packets
24087 @cindex tracepoint packets
24088 @cindex packets, tracepoint
24089
24090 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
24091 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24092
24093 @table @samp
24094
24095 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24096 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24097 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24098 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24099 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24100 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24101 tracepoint's actions.
24102
24103 Replies:
24104 @table @samp
24105 @item OK
24106 The packet was understood and carried out.
24107 @item
24108 The packet was not recognized.
24109 @end table
24110
24111 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24112 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24113 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24114 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24115 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24116 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24117 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24118
24119 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24120 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24121 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24122 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24123 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24124 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24125 tracepoint actions.
24126
24127 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24128 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24129 following forms:
24130
24131 @table @samp
24132
24133 @item R @var{mask}
24134 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24135 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24136 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24137 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24138 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24139
24140 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24141 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24142 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24143 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24144 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24145 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24146 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24147
24148 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24149 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24150 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24151 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24152 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24153 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24154 packet).
24155
24156 @end table
24157
24158 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24159 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24160 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24161 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24162 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24163 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24164 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24165 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24166
24167 Replies:
24168 @table @samp
24169 @item OK
24170 The packet was understood and carried out.
24171 @item
24172 The packet was not recognized.
24173 @end table
24174
24175 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24176 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24177 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24178 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24179
24180 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24181 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24182 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24183 one of the following forms:
24184
24185 @table @samp
24186 @item F @var{f}
24187 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24188 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24189 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24190
24191 @item T @var{t}
24192 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24193 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24194
24195 @end table
24196
24197 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24198 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24199 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24200 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24201
24202 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24203 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24204 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24205 is a hexadecimal number.
24206
24207 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24208 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24209 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24210 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24211 numbers.
24212
24213 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24214 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24215 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24216
24217 @item QTStart
24218 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24219 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24220
24221 @item QTStop
24222 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24223
24224 @item QTinit
24225 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24226
24227 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24228 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24229 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24230 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24231
24232 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24233 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24234 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24235 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24236
24237 @item qTStatus
24238 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24239
24240 Replies:
24241 @table @samp
24242 @item T0
24243 There is no trace experiment running.
24244 @item T1
24245 There is a trace experiment running.
24246 @end table
24247
24248 @end table
24249
24250
24251 @node Interrupts
24252 @section Interrupts
24253 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24254
24255 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24256 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24257 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24258 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24259
24260 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24261 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24262 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24263 interfaces.
24264
24265 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24266 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24267 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24268 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24269 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24270 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24271 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24272 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24273
24274 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24275 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24276 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24277 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24278 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24279 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24280 program is stopped will be discarded.
24281
24282 @node Examples
24283 @section Examples
24284
24285 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24286 does not get any direct output:
24287
24288 @smallexample
24289 -> @code{R00}
24290 <- @code{+}
24291 @emph{target restarts}
24292 -> @code{?}
24293 <- @code{+}
24294 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24295 -> @code{+}
24296 @end smallexample
24297
24298 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24299
24300 @smallexample
24301 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24302 <- @code{+}
24303 -> @code{s}
24304 <- @code{+}
24305 @emph{time passes}
24306 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24307 -> @code{+}
24308 -> @code{g}
24309 <- @code{+}
24310 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
24311 -> @code{+}
24312 @end smallexample
24313
24314 @node File-I/O remote protocol extension
24315 @section File-I/O remote protocol extension
24316 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24317
24318 @menu
24319 * File-I/O Overview::
24320 * Protocol basics::
24321 * The F request packet::
24322 * The F reply packet::
24323 * The Ctrl-C message::
24324 * Console I/O::
24325 * List of supported calls::
24326 * Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
24327 * Constants::
24328 * File-I/O Examples::
24329 @end menu
24330
24331 @node File-I/O Overview
24332 @subsection File-I/O Overview
24333 @cindex file-i/o overview
24334
24335 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24336 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24337 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24338 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24339 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24340 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24341
24342 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24343 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24344 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24345 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24346 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24347
24348 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24349 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24350 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24351 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24352 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24353 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24354 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
24355
24356 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
24357 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
24358 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
24359 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
24360 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
24361
24362 @smallexample
24363 (@value{GDBP}) continue
24364 <- target requests 'system call X'
24365 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
24366 -> GDB returns result
24367 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
24368 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
24369 @end smallexample
24370
24371 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
24372 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
24373 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
24374 system are not supported by this protocol.
24375
24376 @node Protocol basics
24377 @subsection Protocol basics
24378 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
24379
24380 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
24381 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
24382 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
24383 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
24384 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
24385 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
24386 to call the appropriate host system call:
24387
24388 @itemize @bullet
24389 @item
24390 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
24391
24392 @item
24393 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
24394 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
24395 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
24396 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol specific representation.
24397
24398 @end itemize
24399
24400 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
24401
24402 @itemize @bullet
24403 @item
24404 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
24405 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
24406 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
24407 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
24408 packet.
24409
24410 @item
24411 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
24412 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
24413
24414 @item
24415 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
24416
24417 @item
24418 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
24419
24420 @item
24421 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
24422 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
24423 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
24424 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
24425 packet.
24426
24427 @end itemize
24428
24429 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
24430 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
24431
24432 @itemize @bullet
24433 @item
24434 Return value.
24435
24436 @item
24437 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
24438
24439 @item
24440 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
24441
24442 @end itemize
24443
24444 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
24445 the latest continue or step action.
24446
24447 @node The F request packet
24448 @subsection The @code{F} request packet
24449 @cindex file-i/o request packet
24450 @cindex @code{F} request packet
24451
24452 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
24453
24454 @table @samp
24455 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
24456
24457 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
24458 This is just the name of the function.
24459
24460 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
24461 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
24462 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
24463 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
24464 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
24465 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
24466 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
24467
24468 @end table
24469
24470
24471
24472 @node The F reply packet
24473 @subsection The @code{F} reply packet
24474 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
24475 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
24476
24477 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
24478
24479 @table @samp
24480
24481 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call specific attachment}
24482
24483 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
24484
24485 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
24486 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
24487
24488 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
24489 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
24490 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
24491
24492 @smallexample
24493 F0,0,C
24494 @end smallexample
24495
24496 @noindent
24497 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
24498
24499 @smallexample
24500 F-1,4,C
24501 @end smallexample
24502
24503 @noindent
24504 assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
24505
24506 @end table
24507
24508
24509 @node The Ctrl-C message
24510 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} message
24511 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
24512
24513 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
24514 reply packet (@pxref{The F reply packet}),
24515 the target should behave as if it had
24516 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
24517 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
24518 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
24519 packet.
24520
24521 It's important for the target to know in which
24522 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
24523
24524 @itemize @bullet
24525 @item
24526 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
24527
24528 @item
24529 The system call on the host has been finished.
24530
24531 @end itemize
24532
24533 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
24534 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
24535 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
24536 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
24537 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
24538 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
24539
24540 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
24541 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
24542 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
24543 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
24544 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
24545 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
24546 or the full action has been completed.
24547
24548 @node Console I/O
24549 @subsection Console I/O
24550 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
24551
24552 By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
24553 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
24554 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
24555 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
24556 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
24557 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
24558 conditions is met:
24559
24560 @itemize @bullet
24561 @item
24562 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
24563 @code{read}
24564 system call is treated as finished.
24565
24566 @item
24567 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
24568 newline.
24569
24570 @item
24571 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
24572 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
24573
24574 @end itemize
24575
24576 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
24577 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
24578 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
24579 is stopped at the user's request.
24580
24581
24582 @node List of supported calls
24583 @subsection List of supported calls
24584 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
24585
24586 @menu
24587 * open::
24588 * close::
24589 * read::
24590 * write::
24591 * lseek::
24592 * rename::
24593 * unlink::
24594 * stat/fstat::
24595 * gettimeofday::
24596 * isatty::
24597 * system::
24598 @end menu
24599
24600 @node open
24601 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
24602 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
24603
24604 @table @asis
24605 @item Synopsis:
24606 @smallexample
24607 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
24608 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
24609 @end smallexample
24610
24611 @item Request:
24612 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
24613
24614 @noindent
24615 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24616
24617 @table @code
24618 @item O_CREAT
24619 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
24620 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
24621 are concerned.
24622
24623 @item O_EXCL
24624 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
24625 an error and open() fails.
24626
24627 @item O_TRUNC
24628 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
24629 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
24630 truncated to zero length.
24631
24632 @item O_APPEND
24633 The file is opened in append mode.
24634
24635 @item O_RDONLY
24636 The file is opened for reading only.
24637
24638 @item O_WRONLY
24639 The file is opened for writing only.
24640
24641 @item O_RDWR
24642 The file is opened for reading and writing.
24643 @end table
24644
24645 @noindent
24646 Other bits are silently ignored.
24647
24648
24649 @noindent
24650 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24651
24652 @table @code
24653 @item S_IRUSR
24654 User has read permission.
24655
24656 @item S_IWUSR
24657 User has write permission.
24658
24659 @item S_IRGRP
24660 Group has read permission.
24661
24662 @item S_IWGRP
24663 Group has write permission.
24664
24665 @item S_IROTH
24666 Others have read permission.
24667
24668 @item S_IWOTH
24669 Others have write permission.
24670 @end table
24671
24672 @noindent
24673 Other bits are silently ignored.
24674
24675
24676 @item Return value:
24677 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
24678 occurred.
24679
24680 @item Errors:
24681
24682 @table @code
24683 @item EEXIST
24684 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
24685
24686 @item EISDIR
24687 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
24688
24689 @item EACCES
24690 The requested access is not allowed.
24691
24692 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24693 @var{pathname} was too long.
24694
24695 @item ENOENT
24696 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24697
24698 @item ENODEV
24699 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
24700
24701 @item EROFS
24702 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
24703 write access was requested.
24704
24705 @item EFAULT
24706 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
24707
24708 @item ENOSPC
24709 No space on device to create the file.
24710
24711 @item EMFILE
24712 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
24713
24714 @item ENFILE
24715 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
24716 has been reached.
24717
24718 @item EINTR
24719 The call was interrupted by the user.
24720 @end table
24721
24722 @end table
24723
24724 @node close
24725 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
24726 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
24727
24728 @table @asis
24729 @item Synopsis:
24730 @smallexample
24731 int close(int fd);
24732 @end smallexample
24733
24734 @item Request:
24735 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
24736
24737 @item Return value:
24738 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
24739
24740 @item Errors:
24741
24742 @table @code
24743 @item EBADF
24744 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
24745
24746 @item EINTR
24747 The call was interrupted by the user.
24748 @end table
24749
24750 @end table
24751
24752 @node read
24753 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
24754 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
24755
24756 @table @asis
24757 @item Synopsis:
24758 @smallexample
24759 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
24760 @end smallexample
24761
24762 @item Request:
24763 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24764
24765 @item Return value:
24766 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
24767 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
24768 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
24769
24770 @item Errors:
24771
24772 @table @code
24773 @item EBADF
24774 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24775 reading.
24776
24777 @item EFAULT
24778 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24779
24780 @item EINTR
24781 The call was interrupted by the user.
24782 @end table
24783
24784 @end table
24785
24786 @node write
24787 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
24788 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
24789
24790 @table @asis
24791 @item Synopsis:
24792 @smallexample
24793 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
24794 @end smallexample
24795
24796 @item Request:
24797 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24798
24799 @item Return value:
24800 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
24801 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
24802 is returned.
24803
24804 @item Errors:
24805
24806 @table @code
24807 @item EBADF
24808 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24809 writing.
24810
24811 @item EFAULT
24812 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24813
24814 @item EFBIG
24815 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
24816 host specific maximum file size allowed.
24817
24818 @item ENOSPC
24819 No space on device to write the data.
24820
24821 @item EINTR
24822 The call was interrupted by the user.
24823 @end table
24824
24825 @end table
24826
24827 @node lseek
24828 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
24829 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
24830
24831 @table @asis
24832 @item Synopsis:
24833 @smallexample
24834 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
24835 @end smallexample
24836
24837 @item Request:
24838 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
24839
24840 @var{flag} is one of:
24841
24842 @table @code
24843 @item SEEK_SET
24844 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
24845
24846 @item SEEK_CUR
24847 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
24848 bytes.
24849
24850 @item SEEK_END
24851 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
24852 bytes.
24853 @end table
24854
24855 @item Return value:
24856 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
24857 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
24858 value of -1 is returned.
24859
24860 @item Errors:
24861
24862 @table @code
24863 @item EBADF
24864 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
24865
24866 @item ESPIPE
24867 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
24868
24869 @item EINVAL
24870 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
24871
24872 @item EINTR
24873 The call was interrupted by the user.
24874 @end table
24875
24876 @end table
24877
24878 @node rename
24879 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
24880 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
24881
24882 @table @asis
24883 @item Synopsis:
24884 @smallexample
24885 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
24886 @end smallexample
24887
24888 @item Request:
24889 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
24890
24891 @item Return value:
24892 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24893
24894 @item Errors:
24895
24896 @table @code
24897 @item EISDIR
24898 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
24899 directory.
24900
24901 @item EEXIST
24902 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
24903
24904 @item EBUSY
24905 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
24906 process.
24907
24908 @item EINVAL
24909 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
24910 of itself.
24911
24912 @item ENOTDIR
24913 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
24914 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
24915 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
24916
24917 @item EFAULT
24918 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
24919
24920 @item EACCES
24921 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24922
24923 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24924
24925 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
24926
24927 @item ENOENT
24928 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
24929
24930 @item EROFS
24931 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24932
24933 @item ENOSPC
24934 The device containing the file has no room for the new
24935 directory entry.
24936
24937 @item EINTR
24938 The call was interrupted by the user.
24939 @end table
24940
24941 @end table
24942
24943 @node unlink
24944 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
24945 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
24946
24947 @table @asis
24948 @item Synopsis:
24949 @smallexample
24950 int unlink(const char *pathname);
24951 @end smallexample
24952
24953 @item Request:
24954 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
24955
24956 @item Return value:
24957 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24958
24959 @item Errors:
24960
24961 @table @code
24962 @item EACCES
24963 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24964
24965 @item EPERM
24966 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
24967
24968 @item EBUSY
24969 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
24970 being used by another process.
24971
24972 @item EFAULT
24973 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24974
24975 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24976 @var{pathname} was too long.
24977
24978 @item ENOENT
24979 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24980
24981 @item ENOTDIR
24982 A component of the path is not a directory.
24983
24984 @item EROFS
24985 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24986
24987 @item EINTR
24988 The call was interrupted by the user.
24989 @end table
24990
24991 @end table
24992
24993 @node stat/fstat
24994 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
24995 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
24996 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
24997
24998 @table @asis
24999 @item Synopsis:
25000 @smallexample
25001 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
25002 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
25003 @end smallexample
25004
25005 @item Request:
25006 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
25007 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
25008
25009 @item Return value:
25010 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25011
25012 @item Errors:
25013
25014 @table @code
25015 @item EBADF
25016 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
25017
25018 @item ENOENT
25019 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
25020 path is an empty string.
25021
25022 @item ENOTDIR
25023 A component of the path is not a directory.
25024
25025 @item EFAULT
25026 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25027
25028 @item EACCES
25029 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25030
25031 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25032 @var{pathname} was too long.
25033
25034 @item EINTR
25035 The call was interrupted by the user.
25036 @end table
25037
25038 @end table
25039
25040 @node gettimeofday
25041 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
25042 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
25043
25044 @table @asis
25045 @item Synopsis:
25046 @smallexample
25047 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
25048 @end smallexample
25049
25050 @item Request:
25051 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
25052
25053 @item Return value:
25054 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
25055
25056 @item Errors:
25057
25058 @table @code
25059 @item EINVAL
25060 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
25061
25062 @item EFAULT
25063 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25064 @end table
25065
25066 @end table
25067
25068 @node isatty
25069 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
25070 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
25071
25072 @table @asis
25073 @item Synopsis:
25074 @smallexample
25075 int isatty(int fd);
25076 @end smallexample
25077
25078 @item Request:
25079 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
25080
25081 @item Return value:
25082 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
25083
25084 @item Errors:
25085
25086 @table @code
25087 @item EINTR
25088 The call was interrupted by the user.
25089 @end table
25090
25091 @end table
25092
25093 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
25094 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
25095 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
25096 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
25097 needed.
25098
25099
25100 @node system
25101 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
25102 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
25103
25104 @table @asis
25105 @item Synopsis:
25106 @smallexample
25107 int system(const char *command);
25108 @end smallexample
25109
25110 @item Request:
25111 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25112
25113 @item Return value:
25114 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25115 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25116 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25117 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25118 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25119 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25120 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25121
25122 @item Errors:
25123
25124 @table @code
25125 @item EINTR
25126 The call was interrupted by the user.
25127 @end table
25128
25129 @end table
25130
25131 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25132 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25133 the host is simplified before it's returned
25134 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25135 is discarded, and the return value consists
25136 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25137
25138 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25139 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25140 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25141
25142 @table @code
25143 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25144 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25145 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25146 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25147
25148 @item show remote system-call-allowed
25149 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25150 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25151 protocol.
25152 @end table
25153
25154 @node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
25155 @subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
25156 @cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25157
25158 @menu
25159 * Integral datatypes::
25160 * Pointer values::
25161 * Memory transfer::
25162 * struct stat::
25163 * struct timeval::
25164 @end menu
25165
25166 @node Integral datatypes
25167 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
25168 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25169
25170 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25171 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25172 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25173
25174 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25175 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25176
25177 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25178
25179 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25180 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25181
25182 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25183
25184 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25185 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25186 byte order.
25187
25188 @node Pointer values
25189 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
25190 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25191
25192 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25193 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25194 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25195 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25196
25197 @smallexample
25198 @code{1aaf/12}
25199 @end smallexample
25200
25201 @noindent
25202 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25203 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25204 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25205 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25206
25207 @smallexample
25208 @code{123456/d}
25209 @end smallexample
25210
25211 @node Memory transfer
25212 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory transfer
25213 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25214
25215 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25216 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol specific format
25217 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25218 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25219 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25220 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25221 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25222
25223
25224 @node struct stat
25225 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25226 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25227
25228 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25229 is defined as follows:
25230
25231 @smallexample
25232 struct stat @{
25233 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25234 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25235 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25236 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25237 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25238 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25239 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25240 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25241 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25242 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
25243 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
25244 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
25245 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
25246 @};
25247 @end smallexample
25248
25249 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25250 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
25251 structure is of size 64 bytes.
25252
25253 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25254 range of values.
25255
25256 @table @code
25257
25258 @item st_dev
25259 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25260
25261 @item st_ino
25262 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25263
25264 @item st_mode
25265 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25266 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25267
25268 @item st_uid
25269 @itemx st_gid
25270 @itemx st_rdev
25271 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25272
25273 @item st_atime
25274 @itemx st_mtime
25275 @itemx st_ctime
25276 These values have a host and file system dependent
25277 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25278 support exact timing values.
25279 @end table
25280
25281 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25282 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25283 continuing.
25284
25285 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25286 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25287 get truncated on the target.
25288
25289 @node struct timeval
25290 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25291 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25292
25293 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25294 is defined as follows:
25295
25296 @smallexample
25297 struct timeval @{
25298 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25299 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25300 @};
25301 @end smallexample
25302
25303 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25304 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
25305 structure is of size 8 bytes.
25306
25307 @node Constants
25308 @subsection Constants
25309 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25310
25311 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25312 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25313 values before and after the call as needed.
25314
25315 @menu
25316 * Open flags::
25317 * mode_t values::
25318 * Errno values::
25319 * Lseek flags::
25320 * Limits::
25321 @end menu
25322
25323 @node Open flags
25324 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
25325 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25326
25327 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25328
25329 @smallexample
25330 O_RDONLY 0x0
25331 O_WRONLY 0x1
25332 O_RDWR 0x2
25333 O_APPEND 0x8
25334 O_CREAT 0x200
25335 O_TRUNC 0x400
25336 O_EXCL 0x800
25337 @end smallexample
25338
25339 @node mode_t values
25340 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
25341 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25342
25343 All values are given in octal representation.
25344
25345 @smallexample
25346 S_IFREG 0100000
25347 S_IFDIR 040000
25348 S_IRUSR 0400
25349 S_IWUSR 0200
25350 S_IXUSR 0100
25351 S_IRGRP 040
25352 S_IWGRP 020
25353 S_IXGRP 010
25354 S_IROTH 04
25355 S_IWOTH 02
25356 S_IXOTH 01
25357 @end smallexample
25358
25359 @node Errno values
25360 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
25361 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
25362
25363 All values are given in decimal representation.
25364
25365 @smallexample
25366 EPERM 1
25367 ENOENT 2
25368 EINTR 4
25369 EBADF 9
25370 EACCES 13
25371 EFAULT 14
25372 EBUSY 16
25373 EEXIST 17
25374 ENODEV 19
25375 ENOTDIR 20
25376 EISDIR 21
25377 EINVAL 22
25378 ENFILE 23
25379 EMFILE 24
25380 EFBIG 27
25381 ENOSPC 28
25382 ESPIPE 29
25383 EROFS 30
25384 ENAMETOOLONG 91
25385 EUNKNOWN 9999
25386 @end smallexample
25387
25388 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
25389 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
25390
25391 @node Lseek flags
25392 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
25393 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
25394
25395 @smallexample
25396 SEEK_SET 0
25397 SEEK_CUR 1
25398 SEEK_END 2
25399 @end smallexample
25400
25401 @node Limits
25402 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
25403 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
25404
25405 All values are given in decimal representation.
25406
25407 @smallexample
25408 INT_MIN -2147483648
25409 INT_MAX 2147483647
25410 UINT_MAX 4294967295
25411 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
25412 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
25413 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
25414 @end smallexample
25415
25416 @node File-I/O Examples
25417 @subsection File-I/O Examples
25418 @cindex file-i/o examples
25419
25420 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25421 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
25422
25423 @smallexample
25424 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
25425 @emph{request memory read from target}
25426 -> @code{m1234,6}
25427 <- XXXXXX
25428 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
25429 -> @code{F6}
25430 @end smallexample
25431
25432 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25433 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
25434
25435 @smallexample
25436 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25437 @emph{request memory write to target}
25438 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25439 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
25440 -> @code{F6}
25441 @end smallexample
25442
25443 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
25444 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
25445
25446 @smallexample
25447 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25448 -> @code{F-1,9}
25449 @end smallexample
25450
25451 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
25452 host is called:
25453
25454 @smallexample
25455 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25456 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
25457 <- @code{T02}
25458 @end smallexample
25459
25460 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
25461 host is called:
25462
25463 @smallexample
25464 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25465 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25466 <- @code{T02}
25467 @end smallexample
25468
25469 @node Memory map format
25470 @section Memory map format
25471 @cindex memory map format
25472
25473 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
25474 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
25475 memory map.
25476
25477 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25478 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
25479 lists memory regions. The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
25480
25481 @smallexample
25482 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25483 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
25484 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
25485 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
25486 <memory-map>
25487 region...
25488 </memory-map>
25489 @end smallexample
25490
25491 Each region can be either:
25492
25493 @itemize
25494
25495 @item
25496 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
25497 bytes from there:
25498
25499 @smallexample
25500 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25501 @end smallexample
25502
25503
25504 @item
25505 A region of read-only memory:
25506
25507 @smallexample
25508 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25509 @end smallexample
25510
25511
25512 @item
25513 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
25514 bytes in length:
25515
25516 @smallexample
25517 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
25518 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
25519 </memory>
25520 @end smallexample
25521
25522 @end itemize
25523
25524 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
25525 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
25526 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
25527
25528 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
25529
25530 @smallexample
25531 <!-- ................................................... -->
25532 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
25533 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
25534 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
25535 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
25536 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
25537 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
25538 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
25539 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
25540 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
25541 and its type, or device. -->
25542 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
25543 start CDATA #REQUIRED
25544 length CDATA #REQUIRED
25545 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
25546 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
25547 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
25548 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25549 @end smallexample
25550
25551 @include agentexpr.texi
25552
25553 @include gpl.texi
25554
25555 @raisesections
25556 @include fdl.texi
25557 @lowersections
25558
25559 @node Index
25560 @unnumbered Index
25561
25562 @printindex cp
25563
25564 @tex
25565 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
25566 % meantime:
25567 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
25568 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
25569 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
25570 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
25571 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
25572 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
25573 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
25574 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
25575 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
25576 \page\colophon
25577 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
25578 @end tex
25579
25580 @bye
This page took 0.702624 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.